Yamaha Musical Instrument CVP 59S User Manual

IMPORTANT  
WICHTIG  
IMPORTANT  
IMPORTANTE  
Check Your Power Supply  
Netzspannung überprüfen  
Vérifiez la source d’alimentation  
Compruebe la alimentación de su área  
Make sure that your local AC mains Vergewissern Sie sich vor dem An- Vérifiez que la tension spécifiée sur Asegúrese de que tensión de alimen-  
voltage matches the voltage speci- schließen an das Stromnetz, daß die le panneau arrière correspond à la tación de CA de su área correspon-  
fied on the name plate on the bottom örtliche Netzspannung den Betriebs- tension du secteur. Dans certaines de con la tensión especificada en la  
panel. In some areas a voltage se- spannungswerten auf dem Typenschild régions, l’instrument peut être équipé placa de características del panel  
lectormaybeprovidedonthebottom an der Unterseite des Instruments ent- d’un sélecteur de tension situé sur inferior de la unidad del teclado prin-  
panel of the main keyboard unit near spricht. In bestimmten Verkaufs- le panneau inférieur du clavier à cipal, cerca del cable de alimenta-  
the power cord. Make sure that the gebieten ist das Instrument mit einem proximité du cordon d’alimentation. ción. Asegúrese de que el selector  
voltage selector is set for the voltage Spannungswähler an der Unterseite Vérifiez que ce sélecteur est bien de tensión esté ajustado a la tensión  
in your area. The voltage selector is neben der Netzkabeldurchführung aus- réglé en fonction de la tension sec- de su área. El selector de tensión  
set at 240V when the unit is initially gestattet. Falls vorhanden, muß der teur de votre région. Le sélecteur de se ajusta a 240V cuando la unidad  
shipped. To change the setting use a Spannungswähler auf die örtliche Netz- tension est réglé sur 240 V au dé- sale de fábrica. Para cambiar el ajus-  
“minus” screwdriver to rotate the se- spannung eingestellt werden. Der part d’usine. Pour modifier ce ré- te, emplee un destornillador de ca-  
lector dial so that the correct voltage Spannungswähler wurde werkseitig auf glage, utilisez un tournevis à lame beza “recta” para girar el selector de  
appears next to the pointer on the 240 V voreingestellt. Zum Verstellen plate pour tourner le sélecteur afin modo que aparezca la tensión co-  
panel.  
drehen Sie den Spannungsregler mit  
de mettre l’indication correspondant rrecta al lado del indicador del pa-  
einem Schlitzschraubendreher, bis der à la tension de votre région vis à vis nel.  
Zeiger auf den korrekten Spannungs-  
wert weist  
du repère triangulaire situé sur le  
panneau.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Thank you for choosing a Yamaha Clavinova. Your Clavinova is a fine musical instrument  
that employs advanced Yamaha music technology. With the proper care, your Clavinova will  
give you many years of musical pleasure.  
G Large LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) panel and a consistent control interface make  
operation easy and efficient.  
G AWM (Advanced Wave Memory) tone generator system offers an extensive range  
of rich, realistic voices.  
G A maximum of 32-note polyphony (64-note polyphony on the CVP-79A) permits use  
of sophisticated playing techniques.  
G Piano-like touch response provides extensive expressive control and outstanding  
playability.  
G Dual and split play modes allow 2 voices to be played simultaneously or individually  
with the left and right hands.  
G 100 exciting accompaniment styles can be used to provide rhythm-only accompa-  
niment or fully-orchestrated rhythm, bass, and chord accompaniment. Optional  
Style File disks provide additional accompaniment styles.  
G Custom Style lets you create original accompaniment patterns that can be recalled  
and played in the same way as the presets.  
G Full-keyboard ABC (Auto Bass Chord) provides accompaniment as you play across  
the entire keyboard.  
G 16 Harmony variations make it simple to produce rich, complex harmonies.  
G One-touch Setting Feature automatically sets the ideal voices and other param-  
eters for the selected accompaniment style.  
G 16-track built-in sequencer records and plays back your keyboard performances.  
G Digital reverb and effects add extra ambiance and depth to your sound.  
G Registration Memory memorizes 25 (15 in the case of the CVP-59S) complete  
control-panel setups that you can recall whenever needed.  
G Internal 3.5" floppy disk drive provides extended Song Record capacity and Disk  
Orchestra Collection disk playback capability.  
Disk Orchestra Collection playback capability lets you practice complete songs with  
full accompaniment — while keyboard guide lamps help beginners find the right  
keys.  
G MIDI compatibility, GM voices, and a range of MIDI functions make the Clavinova  
useful in a range of advanced MIDI music systems.  
In order to make the most of your Clavinova’s performance potential and features, we urge  
you to read this Owner’s Manual thoroughly, and keep it in a safe place for later reference.  
The LCD displays as illustrated in this manual are for instructional purposes only, and may appear some-  
what different from yours.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Taking Care of Your Clavinova ............... 2  
Other Song Recording Functions ........ 83  
Track Mix .............................................. 83  
Track Delete ......................................... 84  
Track Quantize ..................................... 84  
Initial Edit .............................................. 85  
Renaming Song Files ........................... 87  
Recording Without a Disk..................... 89  
Playback............................................... 89  
Accompaniment  
28  
Style Selection ..................................... 28  
Tempo Control ..................................... 29  
Starting the Accompaniment ................ 30  
Fill-ins ................................................... 32  
Left-pedal Break ................................... 32  
Stopping the Accompaniment .............. 32  
Metronome ........................................... 33  
Preparation  
3
The Music Stand .................................... 3  
The Key Cover (CVP-79A/69/69A) ........ 3  
The Power Switch .................................. 3  
Headphones ........................................... 3  
The Panel Controls  
The Volume Controls  
4
The Utility Functions  
90  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
Single-Finger, Fingered Chord, and  
34  
6
Keyboard .............................................. 91  
Sound ................................................... 92  
Pedal .................................................... 92  
MIDI 1................................................... 94  
MIDI 2................................................... 95  
MIDI 3................................................... 97  
Format .................................................. 98  
Registration .......................................... 99  
Transform ........................................... 101  
Song Copy ......................................... 102  
Song Delete ....................................... 104  
Micro Tuning ...................................... 104  
Backup ............................................... 107  
Recall ................................................. 108  
Popup Time ........................................ 109  
Song List Priority ................................ 109  
Alert Sound ........................................ 109  
Master Volume ....................................... 6  
ABC/Song Volume ................................. 6  
Other Volume Controls ........................... 7  
Expression Control (CVP-79A only) ....... 7  
Full Keyboard Accompaniment ............ 34  
Overall Accompaniment Volume  
Control.................................................. 37  
Individual Part Volume Control ............. 38  
Small ABC ............................................ 39  
Changing the ABC Split Point .............. 39  
Chord Assist ......................................... 40  
Harmony............................................... 41  
One Touch Setting ............................... 44  
General Operation: The Display &  
Related Controls  
8
The Display & LCD Buttons ................... 8  
The [DISPLAY HOLD] Button ................ 9  
The PAGE [<] and [>] Buttons ........... 10  
The [MIXER] Button ............................. 10  
The [EXIT] Button................................. 10  
The [CONTRAST] Button ..................... 11  
The Help Function ................................ 11  
Memory Backup ................................... 12  
Custom Style  
Other Custom Style Functions ............. 50  
Playing Back Your Custom Styles........ 52  
Custom Style Alert & Error Displays .... 53  
45  
Style File Load  
Loading Disk Styles.............................. 55  
55  
Demonstration Playback  
Voice Selection  
13  
Using Loaded Style Files ..................... 57  
Messages  
110  
113  
114  
114  
15  
Keyboard Percussion ............................ 16  
Registration Memory  
Recall the Registered Panel  
58  
The Connectors  
Troubleshooting  
Options  
The Keyboard & Polyphony.............. 16  
Settings ................................................ 60  
Dual Mode  
Engaging the Dual Mode &  
17  
The ABC Freeze Function.................... 60  
Selecting the 2nd Voice ....................... 17  
Dual-mode Voice Balance.................... 18  
Detune Depth ....................................... 18  
Disk Orchestra Collection &  
Song Playback  
61  
Index ...................................................... 115  
Straight Playback ................................. 61  
Playing Back Specific Parts ................. 63  
Split Mode  
19  
Part Assignment for Original Song  
Playback............................................... 65  
Engaging the Split Mode ...................... 19  
Changing the Split Voices .................... 19  
Split-mode Voice Balance .................... 20  
Changing the Split Point....................... 21  
Overall Song Playback Volume  
Control.................................................. 65  
Individual Part Volume Control &  
Voice Selection .................................... 66  
Digital Reverb  
Selecting a Reverb Type ...................... 22  
Total Depth Control .............................. 23  
Individual Part Depth Control ............... 23  
22  
Guided Right- and Left-hand  
Practice ................................................ 67  
Repeat Functions ................................. 69  
Other Playback Controls ...................... 70  
Playing Other Types of Music Data ...... 71  
Voice List .............................................. 116  
Style List ............................................... 120  
Drum/key Assignment List .................. 121  
Backed Up Parameters ........................ 122  
Fingering Chart .................................... 123  
MIDI Data Format ................................. 124  
Specifications ....................................... 135  
CVP-79A: Assembly ............................. 136  
CVP-69/69A: Assembly ........................ 142  
CVP-59S: Assembly ............................. 150  
MIDI Implementation Chart ................. 156  
Voice Effects  
Selecting a Voice Effect ....................... 24  
Effect Depth Control ............................. 25  
One-touch Preset Recall ...................... 25  
24  
Song Recording  
72  
Quick Recording .................................... 72  
Multi-track Recording & Playback ........ 75  
Adding New Tracks .............................. 77  
Punch-in/out Recording........................ 78  
The Chord Sequence Function ............. 80  
The Pedals  
Right Pedal (Damper Pedal) ................ 26  
26  
Center Pedal (Sostenuto Pedal —  
CVP-79A/69/69A only) ......................... 26  
Chord Sequence Page 2 & 3  
Functions .............................................. 81  
Left Pedal (Multi-function) .................... 27  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Taking Care of Your Clavinova  
Your Clavinova will give you years of playing pleasure if you observe the simple rules given below:  
• To eject a floppy disk, press the eject button slowly as far as it will  
1. Avoid Humidity & Heat  
go. Then when the disk Is fully ejected, remove it by hand.  
Avoid placing the Clavinova in areas that are subject to excessive  
humidity or heat. Do not leave the instrument near heaters or in a  
car exposed to direct sunlight, for example.  
• The disk may not be ejected properly if the eject button is pressed  
too quickly or if it is not pressed in far enough. (The eject button  
may become stuck halfway with the disk extending from the slot  
by only a few millimeters). If this is the case, do not attempt to pull  
out the partially ejected disk. Doing so may damage the disk drive  
mechanism and/or the floppy disk. To remove a partially ejected  
disk, try pressing the eject button once again or push the disk  
back into the slot, then repeat the eject procedure carefully.  
2. Avoid Dust & Moisture  
Avoid locations in which the instrument is likely to be exposed to  
excessive dust or moisture.  
3. Power-off Before Connecting  
G Never open or close the key cover while a disk is extending  
from the drive (i.e. in the ejected position). The key cover  
may contact the disk, possibly damaging the disk or even  
the disk drive.  
Connections between the Clavinova and any other device must  
be made with both pieces of equipment turned off.  
4. Handle With Care  
Never apply excessive force to the controls, connectors or other  
parts of your Clavinova, and avoid scratching or bumping it with  
hard objects. Further, always turn the POWER switch off after  
use, and close the key cover to protect the keyboard (CVP-79A/  
69/69A), or cover the instrument with the dust cover provided  
(CVP-59S).  
G Do not insert anything but floppy disks into the disk drive.  
Other objects may cause damage to the disk drive or floppy  
disk.  
G Use the 3.5-inch 2DD or 2HD floppy disks with the  
Clavinova.  
5. Clean Carefully  
Clean the cabinet and keys of your Clavinova only with a clean,  
slightly damp cloth. A neutral cleanser may be used if desired.  
Never use abrasive cleansers, waxes, solvents or chemical dust  
cloths since these can dull or damage the finish.  
6. Never Tamper With the Internal Circuitry  
Precautions Regarding Floppy Disk Use  
G Never open the disk’s shutter. Dirt or dust on the Internal  
magnetic surface will cause data errors.  
Never open the Clavinova cabinet and touch or tamper with the  
internal circuitry. Tampering with the circuitry can result in electri-  
cal shock!  
G Never leave disks near a speaker, TV, or other device that  
emits a strong magnetic field.  
7. Electric Interference  
Since the Clavinova contains digital circuitry, it may cause inter-  
ference if placed too close to radio or television receivers. If this  
occurs, move the instrument further away from the affected  
equipment.  
G Do not store disks in places exposed to direct sunlight or  
sources of high temperature.  
G Do not place heavy objects such as books on top of a disk.  
G Avoid getting the disks wet.  
8. Check Your Power Supply  
Make sure that your local AC mains voltage matches the voltage  
specified on the name plate on the bottom panel. In some areas  
a voltage selector may be provided on the bottom panel of the  
main keyboard unit near the power cord. Make sure that the  
voltage selector is set for the voltage in your area. The voltage  
selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped. To  
change the setting use a “minus” screwdriver to rotate the selec-  
tor dial so that the correct voltage appears next to the pointer on  
the panel.  
G Be sure to store the disks in environmental conditions as  
specified below:  
• Storage temperature: 4° to 53°C (39° to 127°F).  
• Storage humidity: 8 to 90% relative humidity.  
• Store in an area free from dust, sand, smoke, etc.  
G Be sure to apply the disk label at the proper position. When  
changing the label never cover the old label with a new  
label; always remove the old label first.  
Head Cleaning  
9. Name Plate Location  
The head of the disk drive unit will get dirty as you use it even-  
tually causing data errors. If this occurs, clean the head with a  
3.5 inch head cleaning disk (available from most computer  
supply stores).  
The Clavinova name plate, including the unit’s serial number, is  
located on the bottom panel of the main unit.  
10.Handling Floppy Disks  
Yamaha Disk Orchestra Collection disks are write-protected and  
therefore cannot be used to save songs. To save your recorded  
songs a blank floppy disk should be used (one blank disk is sup-  
plied with the Clavinova).  
Data Backup  
It is recommended that you copy your recorded songs to  
another disk for backup (see page 102). If the original disk is  
damaged or your song is deleted, the backup disk can be  
used instead of the original.  
Taking Care of Your Floppy Disks  
G Do NOT eject the disk during recording or playback, or at any  
time when the disk drive lamp is lit. Doing so may damage both  
the disk and the FDD.  
Protecting Your Data (Write Protect Tab)  
G Do NOT turn the Clavinova on or off while the disk is in the  
drive.  
G Always eject the disk before turning the Clavinova off.  
G When ejecting a floppy disk from the disk drive:  
Write protect tab  
open (locked —  
write protected)  
Write protect tab  
closed (unlocked  
— write enabled)  
Disk drive lamp  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preparation  
The Music Stand  
If you will be using sheet music with your Clavinova, raise the mu-  
sic stand built into it’s top panel by lifting the rear edge of the music  
stand. Flip down the braces on either side of the rear of the music stand  
so that they catch inside the protrusions on the top panel. Reverse this  
operation o lower the stand.  
The Key Cover (CVP-79A/69/69A)  
To open the CVP-79A/69/69A key cover lift it just enough to clear  
the keys (do not lift excessively) then slide the cover back into the main  
unit. To close the cover slide it forward all the way and then lower it  
gently until it closes completely.  
CVP-79A  
The Power Switch  
POWER  
After making sure that the Clavinova’s AC cord is properly plugged  
into the Clavinova itself and plugged into a convenient AC wall outlet  
(a power-plug adaptor may be provided in some areas), press the  
[POWER] switch located to the left of the keyboard once to turn the  
power on. Press the [POWER] switch again to turn the power off.  
When the power is initially turned on, the PIANO voice selector  
indicator will light, the POP style selector indicator will light, and the  
display will appear as shown to the left.  
Headphones  
One or two standard pairs of stereo headphones can be plugged in  
here for private practice or late-night playing. The internal speaker sys-  
tem is automatically shut off when a pair of headphones is plugged into  
either or both of the PHONES jacks.  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
PHONES  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Panel Controls  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
CVP-59S  
L / L + R  
R
L / L + R  
N I  
R
P E D E A X L P  
L / L + R  
R
L / L + R  
N I  
R
L / L + R  
R
L / L + R  
N I  
R
T U O X A U  
X
A U  
T U O X A U  
X
A U  
O X U U T A  
X
A U  
T H R U  
O U T  
I N  
T H R U  
O U T  
I N  
O U T  
I N  
M I D I  
M I D I  
M I D I  
D
F
G
H
D
F
H
D
F
H
2
3
q
^
u
i
6STYLE  
VOLUME  
CONTRAST  
4
7
&
DANCE  
POP  
POP  
16BEAT  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
MASTER  
VOLUME  
ABC/SONG  
VOLUME  
DEMO/HELP  
BEAT  
w
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
DISK  
SETTING 8  
FUNCTION MIXER  
e
r
DISPLAY HOLD  
CUSTOM  
5
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
SYNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO  
SMALL  
ABC  
REVERB  
A
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
START/STOP  
PAGE  
MIN  
MIN  
9 0 ! @ # $ %  
* ( )  
CANCEL  
t
y
1
POWER  
j
A-1 B-1 C0 D0 E0 F0 G0 A0 B0 C1 D1 E1 F1 G1 A1 B1 C2 D2 E2 F2 G2 A2 B2 C3 D3 E3  
AUTO BASS CHORD Section  
PHONES  
9 [INTRO A/FILL TO A] Button................ page 30, 32  
S
0 [INTRO B/FILL TO B] Button................ page 30, 32  
S
! [MAIN A] Button.................................... page 30, 31  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
@ [MAIN B] Button.................................... page 30, 31  
# [ENDING] Button .........................................page 32  
$ [SMALL ABC] Button...................................page 39  
% [ABC ON] Button .........................................page 35  
^ [METRONOME] Button ...............................page 33  
& TEMPO [G] and [G] Buttons ......................page 29  
1 POWER Switch .............................................page 3  
START/STOP Section  
VOLUME Section  
* [TAP] Button.................................................page 31  
( [SYNCHRO] Button .....................................page 31  
) [START/STOP] Button .................... page 14, 30, 32  
2 MASTER VOLUME Control...........................page 6  
3 ABC/SONG VOLUME Control ......... page 6, 37, 65  
4 [DEMO/HELP] Button........................... page 11, 13  
5 [REVERB] Button ........................................page 22  
Display Control Section  
q [CONTRAST] Button ...................................page 11  
w BEAT Display ...............................................page 31  
e [FUNCTION] Button ....................................page 90  
r [MIXER] Button....................................... page 7, 10  
t PAGE [<] and [>] Buttons ..........................page 10  
STYLE Section  
6 STYLE Selectors ............................ page 13, 28, 45  
7 [HARMONY] Button ....................................page 41  
8 [ONE TOUCH SETTING] Button.................page 44  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Panel Controls  
CVP-59S  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
l
l
l
;
;
A
A
A
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
I
O a  
CLAVI. TONE/  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
DUAL  
EFFECT  
SYNTH  
h
STRINGS/  
CHOIR  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
o
ORGAN  
BASS  
SPLIT  
W E R  
P
SONG CONTROL  
REGISTRATION  
EXIT  
+
1
2
3
4
5
MEMORY  
BANK  
ABC FREEZE  
REW  
FF  
PAUSE  
s d  
f
g
p
Q
T Y U  
k
F3 G3 A3 B3 C4 D4 E4 F4 G4 A4 B4 C5 D5 E5 F5 G5 A5 B5 C6 D6 E6 F6 G6 A6 B6 C7  
y [DISPLAY HOLD] Button ...............................page 9  
u Display ...........................................................page 8  
i LCD Buttons ..................................................page 8  
o Data dial ........................................................page 8  
p [EXIT] Button ...............................................page 10  
Q [+] and [–] Buttons .........................................page 8  
REGISTRATION Section  
s [MEMORY] Button .......................................page 59  
d [BANK] Button .............................................page 59  
f [REGISTRATION 1~5] Button .............. page 59, 60  
g [ABC FREEZE] Button ................................page 60  
h 3.5" Floppy Disk Drive.............. page 55, 61, 72, 98  
SONG Section  
j Keyboard......................................................page 16  
k Keyboard Guide Lamps...............................page 67  
W [PLAY] Button ..............................................page 61  
E [RECORD] Button .......................................page 73  
R [GUIDE] Button............................................page 67  
l Soft Pedal ....................................................page 27  
; Sostenuto Pedal (CVP-79A/69/69A)...........page 26  
A Damper Pedal..............................................page 26  
SONG CONTROL Section  
T [REW] Button........................................ page 70, 78  
Y [FF] Button ............................................ page 70, 78  
U [PAUSE] Button .................................... page 70, 78  
S PHONES Jacks .............................................page 3  
D AUX OUT R and L/L+R Jacks...................page 113  
F AUX IN R and L/L+R Jacks.......................page 113  
G EXP PEDAL Jack (CVP-79A) .............. page 7, 113  
H MIDI Connectors .......................................page 113  
VOICE Section  
I VOICE Selectors .................................. page 13, 15  
O [DUAL] Button..............................................page 17  
P [SPLIT] Button .............................................page 19  
a [EFFECT] Button .........................................page 24  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Volume Controls  
The Clavinova has two volume controls on the control panel in  
addition to several programmable volume levels that give you extra  
versatility in creating the required sound.  
VOLUME  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
ABC/SONG  
VOLUME  
MAX  
MAX  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
MIN  
MIN  
Master Volume  
The MASTER VOLUME control adjusts the overall volume of  
sound produced by the Clavinova. It also adjusts headphone volume  
when one or two pairs of headphones are plugged into the PHONES  
jacks.  
The output signal levels from the AUX  
OUT jacks are also adjusted by the  
MASTER VOLUME control.  
Initially set the MASTER VOLUME control about half way between  
the “MIN” and “MAX” settings. Then, when you start playing, adjust the  
control for the most comfortable listening level.  
VOLUME  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
ABC/SONG  
VOLUME  
MAX  
MAX  
MIN  
MIN  
ABC/Song Volume  
This control adjusts the volume of the Clavinova’s auto-accompani-  
ment and song playback sound. The volume of notes played on the key-  
board is not affected.  
VOLUME  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
ABC/SONG  
VOLUME  
MAX  
MAX  
MIN  
MIN  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Volume Controls  
Other Volume Controls  
The [MIXER] button provides access to individual volume param-  
eters for the rhythm, bass, chord, pad, and phrase parts of the auto ac-  
companiment sound, a keyboard volume parameter, and a volume param-  
eter for the Clavinova’s harmony function — see page 41 for details.  
When the Clavinova’s Disk Orchestra Collection playback function is in  
use the [MIXER] button accesses individual volume parameters for each  
Disk Orchestra Collection part.  
FUNCTION MIXER  
Expression Control (CVP-79A only)  
An optional Yamaha FC7 Foot Controller can be plugged into the  
CVP-79A EXP PEDAL jack for foot volume (expression) control of the  
keyboard sound only (i.e. expression doesn’t affect the auto-accompani-  
ment sound). Press the pedal forward to increase volume, and backward  
to decrease volume.  
EXP PEDAL  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Operation:  
The Display & Related Controls  
In addition to a range of direct-operation buttons, the CVP-79A/69/  
69A/59S features a large LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) panel and  
several related controls that comprise a consistent interface that,  
once understood, can make operation and programming easier  
than ever.  
CONTRAST  
BEAT  
FUNCTION MIXER  
PAGE  
DISPLAY HOLD  
EXIT  
+
The Display & LCD Buttons  
The 5 buttons below the display — we’ll call them “LCD buttons”  
throughout this text — select or edit the parameter indicated by the adja-  
cent section of the display.  
In the example display shown here, for example, the two buttons im-  
mediately below the VOICEsection of the display can be used to select  
the voice to be played via the keyboard. When either of the VOICEbut-  
tons is pressed the VOICEsection of the display will be highlighted (as  
in the example), indicating that the data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can also  
be used to select voices. The LCD buttons can be pressed briefly to “sin-  
gle-step” the corresponding parameter, or held to scroll continuously  
through the parameter’s values. The panel [+]/[–] buttons allow single-  
step operation only.  
+
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Operation: The Display & Related Controls  
In many cases where G and G or <and >LCD buttons appear, both  
buttons can be pressed simultaneously to recall the default setting for that  
parameter. The panel [+] and [–] buttons can be used in the same way.  
This applies to most parameters that have a range of possible settings.  
Parameters of this type are enclosed in a rounded frame in the display.  
Parameters which are directly executed or simply switched on or off  
via the corresponding LCD button appear in a square frame and are not  
editable via the data dial and [+]/[–] buttons.  
The [DISPLAY HOLD] Button  
When selecting voices (page 15) or accompaniment styles (page 28),  
for example, the voice or style list that appears when a VOICE or  
STYLE button is pressed will automatically disappear after a few sec-  
onds if no selections are made. When this type of temporary “pop-up”  
display is selected, the [DISPLAY HOLD] button will flash indicating  
that the display will disappear in a few seconds. Pop-up displays can be  
kept on the LCD for as long as required by pressing the [DISPLAY  
HOLD] button so that its indicator lights continuously. Press [DISPLAY  
HOLD] a second time (the indicator will go out) to disengage the dis-  
play hold function.  
If the [DISPLAY HOLD] button is en-  
gaged when a normal display is show-  
ing, no pop-up displays will appear  
even when a button that normally calls  
a pop-up display is pressed.  
The length of time pop-up displays  
remain on the LCD can be set via the  
Pop-up Timefunction described on  
page 109.  
DISPLAY HOLD  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Operation: The Display & Related Controls  
The PAGE [<] and [>] Buttons  
Many functions have several display “pages” that can be selected by  
using the PAGE [<] and [>] buttons. When more than one page is pro-  
vided for the selected function or group of functions, a corresponding  
number of overlapping page icons will appear in the upper right-hand  
corner of the display, and the number of the currently selected page will  
appear in the top page icon.  
PAGE  
DISPLAY HOLD  
The [MIXER] Button  
This button calls the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S mixer display which in-  
cludes individual volume parameters for the auto-accompaniment  
RHYTHM, BASS, CHORD, PAD, and PHRASE parts. These param-  
eters can be used to the achieve the best overall balance for your musical  
needs (see page 38 for details). The mixer parameters will disappear  
when the [MIXER] button is pressed a second time (or the [EXIT] but-  
ton is pressed).  
FUNCTION MIXER  
The [EXIT] Button  
The [EXIT] button will usually take you out of the current mode,  
back to the previous display — often the initial play mode display.  
EXIT  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Operation: The Display & Related Controls  
The [CONTRAST] Button  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S display panel is a liquid-crystal type  
which can be adjusted for optimum legibility. Press the [CONTRAST]  
button and use the DARKand LIGHTLCD buttons (or data dial or [+]/  
[–] buttons) to set the display contrast for optimum legibility. The con-  
trast setting retained in memory even when the Clavinova power is  
turned off.  
CONTRAST  
Press the [CONTRAST] button again or [EXIT] button to exit from  
the LCD CONTRAST display.  
The Help Function  
If you’re ever in doubt about a function, the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S  
HELP function is always available. Press the [DEMO/HELP] button  
and then the HELPLCD button at any time to enter the help mode.  
DEMO/HELP  
If necessary use the first LCD button to select the language (ENG-  
LISH, GERMAN, FRENCH or JAPANESE) you want help in. The lan-  
guage setting is retained in memory even when the Clavinova power is  
turned off. Use the SELECTGGG buttons to select a topic, then press the  
ENTERbutton to view the first page of help text on the selected topic.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Operation: The Display & Related Controls  
Use the PAGE [<] and [>] buttons, the [+] and [–] buttons, or the  
data dial to “flip” through the available pages.  
PAGE  
DISPLAY HOLD  
The [EXIT] or [DEMO/HELP] button will take you back to the  
topic list if pressed while the help text is showing, or back to the initial  
play mode display if pressed while the topic list is showing.  
Memory Backup  
In addition to the contrast and language settings introduced in this  
section, the Clavinova has a range of parameters that can be retained in  
memory even while the power is off, so you don’t have to reset all your  
favorite settings every time you want to play. The “Backup” function  
described on page 107 lets you select which parameters will be backed  
up (retained in memory), and which will be reset to their default values  
whenever the power is turned off.  
Parameters that are backed up will be retained in memory for about a  
week if the Clavinova is not turned on during this time. All parameters  
will be reset to their default values if the power remains off for longer  
than about a week. To ensure that your backed-up settings are main-  
tained, turn the power on for a few minutes at least once a week.  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Demonstration Playback  
The Clavinova features 25 demonstration tunes that effectively  
demonstrate its sound and accompaniment capabilities. Here’s  
how you can select and play the demo tunes.  
DEMO/HELP  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
ZTurn Power On and Set an Initial Volume Level...............  
Press the [POWER] button to turn the power ON, and set the [MAS-  
TER VOLUME] control about half way between the “MIN” and  
“MAX” settings.  
XPress the [DEMO/HELP] button ........................................................  
DEMO/HELP  
CSelect a Play Mode..........................................................................................  
Use the fourth LCD button to select a play mode:  
ALL  
All 25 demo tunes will repeatedly play back in sequence, start-  
ing with the tune you initially select.  
RANDOM  
SINGLE  
All 25 demo tunes will continuously play back in random order,  
starting with the tune you initially select.  
The selected tune will play through once, then demo playback  
will stop.  
VSelect a Demo Tune........................................................................................  
Demo tune playback data is not trans-  
mitted via the MIDI OUT terminal.  
The demo tunes are selected via the first two LCD buttons, and the  
VOICE and STYLE selectors. The VOICE and STYLE indicators flash  
in sequence when the [DEMO/HELP] button is pressed.  
STYLE  
VOICE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
DANCE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
SYNTH  
POP  
16BEAT  
POP  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
STRINGS/  
CHOIR  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Demonstration Playback  
Press an LCD button or selector to start playback of the correspond-  
ing tune. You can also start playback from the first LCD tune by pressing  
the [START/STOP] button when the ALLor SINGLEplay mode is  
selected. The corresponding LCD section will be highlighted during  
LCD tune playback, and the VOICE or STYLE indicator will flash dur-  
ing voice or style tune playback.  
During voice or style tune playback,  
the currently playing voice or style  
name will be shown on the display.  
BAdjust the Volume ............................................................................................  
Use the MASTER VOLUME control to adjust the volume.  
NStop Playback ......................................................................................................  
The tempo cannot be adjusted during  
demo playback.  
Demo playback can be stopped temporarily by pressing the LCD but-  
ton, VOICE button, or STYLE button corresponding to the demo tune  
which is currently playing, or by pressing the [START/STOP] button.  
Press the [DEMO/HELP] or [EXIT] button when you want to stop  
demo playback and return to the normal mode.  
The Demo Tunes  
Title  
Composers  
Peter Ilyich Tchaikovsky  
Song Demo  
1
Piano Concerto No.1 op.23 1st movement  
2
A Whole New World from the motion picture “Aladdin”  
Alan Menken  
Voice Demo  
Piano  
Polonaise No.6 op.53 “Heroique”  
Sonata in C major K.159 (L.104)  
Wonderland  
Frédéric François Chopin  
Domenico Scarlatti  
Hiroaki Fujita  
Harpsi.  
Vibes  
Guitar  
Concierto de Aranjuez 2nd movement  
No, Only He Who Has Known  
Joaquin Rodrigo  
Clavi. Tone/Synth  
Organ  
Peter Ilyich Tchaikovsky  
Johann Sebastian Bach  
Ludwig van Beethoven  
Georg Friedrich Händel  
George Cory  
Toccata and Fuga in D minor  
Strings/Choir  
Brass  
Symphony No. 5 op.67 1st movement  
“La Réjouissance” from Music For The Royal Fireworks  
I Left My Heart In San Francisco  
Sax/Flute  
Style Demo  
Pop  
My Way  
J. Revaux, C. François & G. Thibaut  
Alvaro Carrillo  
Latin  
Sabor A Mi  
Latin Pop  
Traditional  
Waltz  
The Girl From Ipanema  
I Could Have Danced All Night  
Tennessee Waltz  
Antonio Carlos Jobin  
Frederic Loewe  
Pee Wee King & Redd Stewart  
Some of the demonstration pieces listed above are specially-arranged excerpts from the original compositions listed above.  
All other songs are original (©1995 by Yamaha Corporation).  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Selection  
The CVP-69/69A/59S has a total of 172 different voices and the CVP-  
79A has 192 that can be selected and played via the keyboard.  
There’s also a “Keyboard Percussion” mode that let’s you play a range  
of drums and percussion instruments on the keyboard.  
VOICE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
SYNTH  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
STRINGS/  
CHOIR  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
ABC FREEZE  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
ORGAN  
BASS  
ZSelect a Voice ........................................................................................................  
The display will automatically revert to  
the main play mode display after a few  
seconds if the [DISPLAY HOLD] button  
is not engaged (page 9).  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S voices are organized in 12 voice groups  
(see page 116 for a complete voice list). Use the voice group buttons to  
select the group from which you want to select a voice. The correspond-  
ing voice display will appear.  
The last voice selected within each  
group will automatically be recalled  
whenever a VOICE button is pressed  
(as long as the power remains on).  
The last-selected voice in each group  
can be backed up, even after the  
power is turned off, via the Backup”  
function page 107.  
VOICE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
SYNTH  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
STRINGS/  
CHOIR  
DRUM
PERC.  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
ORGAN  
BASS  
The Grand Piano 1 voice is automati-  
cally selected when the power is ini-  
tially turned on.  
However the last-selected voice can  
be recalled when the power is turned  
off and on via the Backupfunction —  
page 107.  
Use the PAGE buttons to select the page containing the voice you  
want if more than one page is available, then press the LCD button corre-  
sponding to the desired voice. You can also use the data dial or [+]/[–]  
buttons to select any of the voices within the selected group.  
PAGE  
DISPLAY HOLD  
Voices within the current group can still be selected via the VOICEG  
and G LCD buttons, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons, once the VOICE  
section of the display has been highlighted, from the main play mode  
display.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Selection  
XPlay & Adjust Volume...................................................................................  
You can now play the selected voice on the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S  
keyboard. Use the [MASTER VOLUME] control to adjust the overall  
volume level.  
Keyboard Percussion  
The Clavinova has 8 Drum Kits in the [DRUMS/PERC.] voice group  
which includes a range of drum and percussion voices as well as sound  
effects. When one of the Drum Kit voices is selected, you can play 72  
different drums and percussion instruments on the keyboard. The drums  
and percussion instruments played by the various keys when the Stand-  
ard Kit is selected are marked by symbols above the keys.  
When a Drum Kit voice is selected only  
the keys with drum or percussion  
symbols printed above them will  
sound.  
The TRANSPOSE, TUNE, and OC-  
TAVE SHIFT functions described on  
pages 91 and 92 do not affect the  
Drum Kit voices.  
See page 121 for a complete list of the instruments in each Drum Kit.  
VOICE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
SYNTH  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
STRINGS/  
CHOIR  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
ORGAN  
BASS  
The Keyboard & Polyphony  
The CVP-69/69A/59S can play up to 32 notes at once while the CVP-79A can play up to 64. This number  
includes all notes being played at the same time in any single or combination use of dual, split, accompani-  
ment, and disk functions. Further variation occurs with “1-element” and “2-element” voices: the polyphony is  
halved with 2-element voices. The same applies to stereo voices. The voice list on page 116 shows all stereo,  
2-element, and 1-element voices in the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S.  
The Clavinova also offers keyboard touch response, so the volume and timbre of notes played can be con-  
trolled according to how “hard” you play the keys. The amount of variation available depends on the selected  
voice and the setting of the TOUCH SENSITIVITY parameter (page 91).  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dual Mode  
The DUAL mode makes it possible to play two voices simultane-  
ously across the entire range of the keyboard. This makes it easy  
to create exceptionally rich, thick tonal textures.  
DUAL  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
Engaging the Dual Mode & Selecting the 2nd Voice  
After selecting the main voice in the normal way, press the [DUAL]  
Please note that only the VOICE  
button so that its indicator lights to engage the DUAL mode (by pressing  
again, its indicator goes out and the DUAL mode is disengaged).  
group button indicator of the 2nd voice  
group lights while the DUAL mode  
pop-up display is showing, and that  
only the main voice group indicator  
lights after the DUAL mode pop-up  
display disappears.  
VOICE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
SYNTH  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
STRINGS/  
CHOIR  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
The default DUAL mode 2nd voice is  
ORGAN  
BASS  
Strings Slow.  
Use the 2nd VOICE LCD buttons in the DUAL mode pop-up dis-  
play, that appears when the [DUAL] button is turned on, to select the  
2nd dual-mode voice (all voice groups are available). The data dial and  
[+]/[–] buttons can also be used once the 2nd VOICE section of the  
display has been highlighted.  
The VOICE selector indicator of the group containing the 2nd voice  
lights while the DUAL mode pop-up display is showing, and the 2nd  
voice group can be selected via the VOICE selectors. The names of both  
the main and 2nd dual-mode voices appear separated by a “+” symbol in  
the normal play mode display even after the DUAL mode pop-up display  
disappears. A different main voice can be selected in the normal way  
once the normal play mode display reappears.  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dual Mode  
The DUAL mode pop-up display can be recalled at any time in order  
to change the 2nd voice or other settings (see below) by pressing a  
VOICE selector (either the current voice or another voice to select the  
2nd voice) while holding the [DUAL] button.  
Dual-mode Voice Balance  
The volume balance between the two voices combined in the DUAL  
mode can be adjusted by pressing the BAL(balance) LCD button to  
highlight the BAL section of the display, and then by using the data dial  
and [+]/[–] buttons. The BAL LCD button can be held to increase the  
level of the 2nd voice only. The balance bar in the BAL section of the  
display graphically shows the volume balance between the main (1st)  
and 2nd voices. Equal balance can be instantly recalled by pressing the  
[+] and [–] buttons simultaneously while the BAL parameter is selected.  
+
Detune Depth  
In many cases an even “thicker” sound can be produced by slightly  
detuning the dual-mode main and 2nd voices. The DETUNE DEPTH  
LCD buttons can be used to set the detune depth value between 0 and 10.  
The data dial and [+]/[–] can also be used once the DETUNE DEPTH  
parameter is selected. The higher the value the greater the amount of  
detuning. The “normal” setting of “5” can be instantly recalled by press-  
ing both the DETUNE DEPTH LCD buttons simultaneously.  
The dual and split modes cannot be  
used at the same time.  
The OCTAVE SHIFT function page  
91 can be used to shift the pitch of  
the main and/or 2nd voice in the DUAL  
mode up or down one octave.  
The DUAL mode balance and depth  
settings affect all voice combinations.  
The DUAL mode settings are retained  
even if the DUAL mode is turned off  
and on while the power remains on.  
The DUAL mode settings can also be  
backed up even after the power is  
turned off via the Backupfunction —  
page 107.  
The DUAL mode can be turned off by pressing the [DUAL] button so  
that its indicator goes out.  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Split Mode  
The split mode lets you play different voices with the left and right  
hands — bass with the left and piano with the right, for example.  
You can assign any of the Clavinova’s voices to the left and right-  
hand sections of the keyboard.  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
SPLIT  
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
Engaging the Split Mode  
When the [SPLIT] button is pressed and its indicator lights, the key-  
board is split into left- and right-hand sections and different voices can  
be assigned to each. (The Split mode can be turned off by pressing the  
[SPLIT] button again so that its indicator goes out.) The split point is  
initially set at the F#2 key when the power is turned on, and the Acoustic  
Bass 1 voice is initially assigned to the left-hand section of the keyboard  
(all keys up to and including F#2). The voice that was selected when the  
SPLIT mode was engaged is assigned to the right-hand section of the  
keyboard.  
VOICE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
SYNTH  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
STRINGS/  
CHOIR  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
ORGAN  
BASS  
F 2  
Left-hand section  
C0  
C1  
C2  
C3  
C4  
C5  
C6  
C7  
Right-hand section  
Changing the Split Voices  
Use the LEFT VOICELCD buttons in the SPLIT mode pop-up dis-  
play, that appears when the [SPLIT] button is turned on, to select the  
left-hand voice (all voice groups are available). The data dial and [+]/[–]  
buttons can also be used once the LEFT VOICEsection of the display  
has been highlighted.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Split Mode  
The VOICE selector indicator of the group containing the left-hand  
voice lights while the SPLIT mode pop-up display is showing, and the  
left-hand voice group can be selected via the VOICE selectors. The  
names of both the left- and right-hand voices appear separated by a “/”  
symbol in the normal play mode display even after the SPLIT mode pop-  
up display disappears. A different right-hand voice can be selected in the  
normal way once the normal play mode display reappears.  
Please note that only the VOICE  
group button indicator of the left-hand  
voice group lights while the SPLIT  
mode pop-up display is showing, and  
that only the right-hand voice group  
indicator lights after the SPLIT mode  
pop-up display disappears.  
The SPLIT mode pop-up display can be recalled at any time in order  
to change the left-hand voice or other settings (see below) by pressing a  
VOICE selector (either the current voice or another voice to select the  
left-hand voice) while holding the [SPLIT] button.  
Split-mode Voice Balance  
The volume balance between the left- and right-hand voices can be  
adjusted by pressing the BAL(balance) LCD button to highlight the BAL  
section of the display, and then by using the data dial and [+]/[–] buttons.  
The BALLCD button can be held to increase the level of the right-hand  
voice only. The balance bar in the BALsection of the display graphically  
shows the volume balance between the left- and right-hand voices. Equal  
balance can be instantly recalled by pressing the [+] and [–] buttons si-  
multaneously while the BALparameter is selected.  
+
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Split Mode  
Changing the Split Point  
The split point can be set at any key by pressing the desired key while  
holding the [SPLIT] button. The split point key name will appear in the  
SPLIT POINTsection of the display.  
The dual and split modes cannot be  
used at the same time.  
Whether the damper pedal affects the  
left voice only, the right voice only, or  
both voices is determined by the  
DAMPER RANGEfunction described  
on page 93 (the default is right-hand  
voice only).  
CLAVI. TONE/  
UITAR  
BASS  
SYNTH  
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
The OCTAVE SHIFT function page  
91 can be used to shift the pitch of  
the left- and/or right-hand voice in the  
SPLIT mode up or down one octave.  
The split point can also be set by using the SPLIT POINTLCD but-  
tons, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons once the SPLIT POINTsection  
of the display has been highlighted. The keyboard guide lamp corre-  
sponding to the selected split point will light.  
When the ABC Single Finger or Fin-  
gered mode (page 35) and the split  
mode are used simultaneously, the  
left-hand voice will be accompanied by  
the appropriate ABC chord voices.  
The SPLIT mode balance and split  
point settings affect all voice combina-  
tions.  
The SPLIT mode settings are retained  
even if the SPLIT mode is turned off  
and on while the power remains on.  
The SPLIT mode settings can also be  
backed up even after the power is  
turned off via the Backupfunction —  
page 107.  
The default split point — F#2 — can be recalled by simultaneously  
pressing the SPLIT POINTLCD buttons or [+] and [–] buttons.  
The SPLIT mode can be turned off by pressing the [SPLIT] button so  
that its indicator goes out.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Digital Reverb  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S provides a number of digital reverb  
types that you can use for extra “ambiance” and expressive power.  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
REVERB  
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
Selecting a Reverb Type  
Press the [REVERB] button so that its indicator lights to turn the  
currently selected reverb effect on (since the REVERB indicator is auto-  
matically on when the power is initially turned on, you may have to turn  
it off and then on again). —The reverb effect is alternately turned on and  
Reverb is turned on and the HALL 1  
effect is automatically selected when  
the POWER switch is turned on.  
However, the last setting can be re-  
called when the power is turned off  
and on via the Backupfunction —  
page 107.  
off every time the [REVERB] button is pressed.  
REVERB  
Different reverb types and depth settings can be selected via the pop-  
up display that appears when the [REVERB] button is turned on. Use  
the TYPELCD buttons to select the desired reverb type, or use the data  
dial or [+]/[–] buttons when the TYPEparameter is highlighted.  
Reverb Type List  
HALL1  
Concert hall reverb.  
HALL2  
• “OFFmay appear if the reverb type  
offmessage is received via MIDI.  
ROOM1  
ROOM2  
Small room reverb.  
ROOM3  
STAGE1  
STAGE2  
PLATE  
Reverb for solo instruments.  
Simulated steel plate reverb.  
WHITE ROOM  
TUNNEL  
Distinctive short reverb with initial delay.  
Simulation of long tunnel-like space.  
CANYON  
Long, cavernous reverb.  
(CVP-79A only)  
BASEMENT  
Small, highly reflective room reverb.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Digital Reverb  
Total Depth Control  
The overall depth of the selected reverb type can be increased or de-  
creased by using the TOTAL DEPTHLCD buttons, or the data dial or [+]/  
[–] buttons when the TOTAL DEPTHparameter is highlighted. The total  
depth range is from “0” (no reverb) through “100” (maximum reverb).  
The default TOTAL DEPTH value of “50” can be instantly recalled by  
pressing both the TOTAL DEPTHLCD buttons or [+] and [–] buttons  
simultaneously.  
Individual Part Depth Control  
The depth of the reverb effect applied to the accompaniment rhythm,  
bass, chord, and keyboard parts can be individually adjusted via the pa-  
rameters provided in page 2 of the reverb display. These values are rela-  
tive to the total depth value. Use the PAGE buttons to select page 2,  
press the LCD button corresponding to the part for which you want to  
adjust the reverb depth, then use the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons to adjust  
the reverb depth as required. The LCD buttons can be held to increase  
the depth for the corresponding part only. The individual part reverb  
depth range is from “0” (no reverb) to “100” (maximum reverb). The  
default setting of “50” can be instantly recalled for any part by simulta-  
neously pressing the [+] and [–] buttons while the depth parameter for  
the desired part is selected.  
The TOTAL DEPTH setting applies to  
all parts.  
The actual reverb depth for each part  
is determined by the product of the  
TOTAL DEPTH and individual part  
depth settings. For example, if one is  
0, no reverb will be produced even if  
the other is 100.  
Both total and individual part depth can  
be adjusted in five steps.  
+
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Effects  
Each CVP-79A/69/69A/59S voice has individual effect type and depth  
settings that can be programmed as required. A range of 20 (17 in the  
case of the CVP-69/69A/59S) effects provides extensive musical  
versatility.  
EFFECT  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
Selecting a Voice Effect  
Press the [EFFECT] button so that its indicator lights to turn the cur-  
rently selected voice effect on (press again so that its indicator goes out  
to turn the effect off).  
VOICE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
SYNTH  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
STRINGS/  
CHOIR  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
ORGAN  
BASS  
Different effect types and depth settings can be selected via the pop-  
up display that appears when the [EFFECT] button is turned on. Use the  
TYPELCD buttons to select the desired effect type, or use the data dial  
or [+]/[–] buttons when the TYPEparameter is highlighted.  
The default effect type can be recalled by simultaneously pressing the  
TYPELCD buttons or [+]/[–] buttons.  
• “OTHERSor OFFmay appear if  
another effect type or off is set to a  
voice or received via MIDI.  
Effect Type List  
CHORUS1  
CHORUS2  
CHORUS3  
CELESTE  
DELAY L,C,R  
DELAY L,R  
Three independent delays, for the  
left, right and center stereo positions.  
Conventional chorus program with  
rich, warm chorusing.  
Initial delay for each stereo channel,  
and two separate feedback delays.  
Three-phase LFO for richer, more  
pronounced chorusing.  
ECHO  
Stereo delay.  
CROSS DELAY  
Complex effect that sends the de-  
layed repeats “bouncing” between  
the left and right channels.  
DETUNE  
Slight pitch change for each channel.  
(CVP-79A only)  
FLANGER  
Pronounced three-phase modulation  
with slight metallic sound.  
TREMOLO  
Rich Tremolo effect with both volume  
and pitch modulation.  
SYMPHONIC  
AUTO PAN  
Exceptionally rich & deep chorusing.  
ROTARY FAST  
Rotary speaker simulation.  
Several panning effects that auto-  
matically shift the sound position (left,  
right).  
ROTARY SLOW Rotary speaker simulation.  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice Effects  
PHASER  
Pronounced, metallic modulation with  
periodic phase change.  
COMPRESSOR  
(CVP-79A only)  
Affects the dynamics of the sound by  
smoothing out the high-volume  
peaks and soft-volume dips.  
AUTO WAH  
Repeating filter sweep “wah” effect.  
BOOST HL  
Equalizer to boost high and low  
frequencies.  
TOUCH WAH  
(CVP-79A only)  
Wah effect that varies filter sweep  
according to touch.  
Effect Depth Control  
When a single voice is selected only one depth parameter will appear.  
When the DUAL or SPLIT mode is engaged, separate depth parameters  
will appear for the main and 2nd (dual) or right- and left-hand (split)  
voices. The depth of the selected effect can be increased or decreased by  
The main or right-hand voice effect  
type is commonly used for the 2nd or  
left-hand voice.  
The depth can be adjusted in five step  
intervals.  
( )  
( )  
using the DEPTH1R and/or DEPTH2L LCD buttons, or the data dial  
( ) ( )  
or [+]/[–] buttons when the DEPTH1R or DEPTH2L parameter is  
The DEPTH1(R) and/or DEPTH2(L)  
value for some effect types may be  
fixed to 100 and/or 0 respectively and  
cannot be changed.  
( )  
( )  
highlighted. The DEPTH1R and DEPTH2L buttons can be held to  
only increase the depth of the corresponding voice. The depth range is  
from “0” (no effect) to “100” (maximum effect depth). The default  
DEPTH1(R) or DEPTH2(L) setting can be instantly recalled for either  
depth parameter by simultaneously pressing the [+] and [–] buttons while  
the desired depth parameter is selected — DEPTH2(L) is reset to “50”.  
+
One-touch Preset Recall  
Press the PRESETLCD button to instantly recall the preset effect  
type and DEPTH1(R) settings for the current voice. The DEPTH2(L)  
setting is not affected.  
Each voice has its own individual  
default effect on/off, type, and depth  
settings. Your own settings can be  
backed up via the Backup function  
described on page 107.  
The DEPTH2(L) setting affects all  
voices. Its default value is 50, but  
your own setting can be backed up via  
the Backup function described on page  
107.  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Pedals  
The CVP-79A/69/69A has three pedals and the CVP-59S has two  
pedals which offer a range of advanced expressive capabilities.  
Right Pedal (Damper Pedal)  
The damper pedal functions in the same way as a damper pedal on an  
acoustic piano. When the damper pedal is pressed notes played have a  
long sustain. Releasing the pedal immediately stops (damps) any sus-  
tained notes.  
The CVP-79A damper pedal can be  
set for continuous (default) or on/off  
type damping control via the  
DAMPER MODEfunction (page 94).  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
CVP-59S  
Damper Pedal  
Damper Pedal  
Damper Pedal  
Center Pedal (Sostenuto Pedal — CVP-79A/69/69A only)  
If you play a note or chord on the keyboard and press the sostenuto  
pedal while the note(s) are held, those notes will be sustained as long as  
the pedal is held (as if the damper pedal had been pressed) but all subse-  
quently played notes will not be sustained. This makes it possible to sus-  
tain a chord, for example, while other notes are played “staccato.”  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
Sostenuto Pedal  
Sostenuto Pedal  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Pedals  
Left Pedal (Multi-function)  
The left pedal has a number of functions which can be selected via  
the LEFT PEDAL function described on page 93.  
The damper and sostenuto pedal  
functions do not affect DRUMS/PERC.  
voices where inappropriate.  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
CVP-59S  
Left Pedal  
Left Pedal  
Left Pedal  
CVP-79A  
Soft  
Pressing the soft pedal subtly reduces the volume and  
slightly changes the timbre of notes played. The SOFT  
function is automatically selected when the POWER  
switch is initially turned on.  
Start/Stop  
The left pedal performs the same function as the accom-  
paniment section [START/STOP] button. For details on  
the START/STOP function, refer to the “Accompaniment”  
section, pages 30 and 32.  
Harmony On/Off Allows the Harmony function (page 41) to be turned on or  
off as required while playing so that harmony can be  
applied only to specific notes or phrases.  
Registration +  
Steps through the registration memory locations so a  
completely different set of panel settings can be recalled  
each time the pedal is pressed. See page 60 for details  
on the registration memory.  
Intro A/Fill to A  
Intro B/Fill to B  
Ending/rit.  
The left pedal performs the same function as the accom-  
paniment section [INTRO A/FILL TO A] button. See  
pages 30 and 32 for details.  
The left pedal performs the same function as the accom-  
paniment section [INTRO B/FILL TO B] button. See  
pages 30 and 32 for details.  
The left pedal performs the same function as the accom-  
paniment section [ENDING] button. See page 32 for  
details.  
Break  
Pressing the left pedal produces a break in the accompa-  
niment for as long as the pedal is held. For details on the  
BREAK function, refer to the “Accompaniment” section,  
page 32.  
Sostenuto  
(CVP-59S only)  
The left pedal functions in the same way as the CVP-  
79A/69/69A sostenuto pedal (see above).  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accompaniment  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S has 100 musical “styles” that can be used  
as a basis for rhythm accompaniment, or fully orchestrated rhythm,  
bass, and chord accompaniment (see “Auto Bass Chord” on page 34).  
Accompaniment playback data is not usually transmitted via the MIDI OUT connector. But it  
can be transmit-enabled via the MIDI 3 Sendfunction described on page 97.  
STYLE  
DANCE  
POP  
16BEAT  
POP  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
TEMPO  
+
PRESET  
METRONOME  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
DISK  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN A MAIN B ENDING  
START/STOP  
SYNCHRO  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
ABC ON  
TAP  
START/STOP  
Style Selection  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S’s 100 preset accompaniment styles are  
organized in 11 groups (see page 120 for a complete style list). Use the  
STYLE selectors to select the group from which you want to select a  
style. The corresponding style display will appear.  
The display will automatically revert to  
the main play mode display after a few  
seconds if the [DISPLAY HOLD] button  
is not engaged (page 9).  
The last style selected within each  
group will automatically be recalled  
whenever a STYLE button is pressed  
while the power remains on. The last  
selected style in each group can also  
be backed up even after the power is  
turned off via the Backupfunction on  
page 107.  
STYLE  
DANCE  
POP  
16BEAT  
POP  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
DISK  
CUSTOM  
The Pop Ballad 1 style is automatically  
selected when the power is turned on.  
However, the last-selected style can  
be recalled when the power is turned  
off and on via the Backupfunction on  
page 107.  
There is also a [DISK/CUSTOM] but-  
ton that can be used to select styles  
loaded from optional Style File floppy  
disks or disks containing custom styles  
you have created yourself. See the  
Style File Loadand Custom Style”  
sections on pages 55 and 45 for de-  
tails.  
Use the PAGE buttons to select the page containing the style you  
want if more than one page is available, then press the LCD button corre-  
sponding to the desired style. You can also use the data dial or [+]/[–]  
buttons to select any of the styles within the selected group.  
Use the [ABC/SONG VOLUME] control  
to adjust the volume of the accompani-  
ment sound.  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accompaniment  
PAGE  
DISPLAY HOLD  
Styles within the current group can still be selected via the STYLEG  
and G LCD buttons, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons once the STYLE  
section of the display has been highlighted, from the main play mode  
display.  
Tempo Control  
Whenever you select a different style, the preset tempo for that style  
is also selected, and the tempo is displayed on the display in number of  
beats per minute (unless the accompaniment is playing, in which case the  
same tempo is maintained).  
The preset tempo for the selected style  
can be recalled at any time by pressing  
both the TEMPO [+] and [] buttons  
simultaneously.  
Tempo  
You can change the tempo to any value between 32 and 280 beats per  
minute, however, by using the TEMPO [+] and [–] buttons. This can be  
done either before the accompaniment is started or while it is playing.  
Press either button briefly to decrement or increment the tempo value by  
one, or hold the button for continuous decrementing or incrementing.  
TEMPO  
+
PRESET  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accompaniment  
Starting the Accompaniment  
There are several ways to start the accompaniment:  
G Straight Start .........................................................................................................  
Press the [START/STOP] button.  
Each of the styles also has two main variations that can be selected by  
pressing the [MAIN A] button or [MAIN B] button before pressing the  
[START/STOP] button. Normally the [MAIN A] button LED will be lit  
(or you can select it if the other variation is selected), indicating that the  
MAIN A pattern is selected. You can also switch between the [MAIN A]  
and [MAIN B] variations during playback — the new variation begins  
from the top of the next measure if the button is pressed on or after the  
2nd beat of a measure.  
The [START/STOP] button indicator will be lit during accompani-  
ment playback and off when the accompaniment is stopped.  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
START/STOP  
SYNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B  
ENDING  
ABC ON  
TAP  
START/STOP  
G Start With an Introduction.......................................................................  
Press the [INTRO A/FILL TO A] or [INTRO B/FILL TO B] but-  
ton.  
In the first case the [INTRO A/FILL TO A] indicator will light con-  
tinuously and the [MAIN A] indicator will flash, indicating that the  
MAIN A variation will play after an appropriate introduction. In the lat-  
ter case the [INTRO B/FILL TO B] indicator will light continuously  
and the [MAIN B] indicator will flash, indicating that the MAIN B vari-  
ation will play after an appropriate introduction. Press the [START/  
STOP] button to actually start playback. The selected introduction can  
be disengaged before starting playback by pressing the [MAIN A],  
[MAIN B], or [ENDING] button.  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
START/STOP  
SYNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B  
ENDING  
ABC ON  
TAP  
START/STOP  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN A MAIN B ENDING  
START/STOP  
SYNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
ABC ON  
TAP  
START/STOP  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accompaniment  
G Synchronized Start .........................................................................................  
Any of the start types described above can be synchronized to the first  
note or chord played on the keyboard by first pressing the [SYNCHRO]  
button so that its indicator lights. When the keyboard is split or Auto  
Bass Chord Single Finger or Fingered mode is used, the first note played  
on the left-hand section of the keyboard will start the accompaniment  
(i.e. keys to the left of and including the split-point key — normally  
F#2). Use the [MAIN A], [MAIN B] and/or [INTRO A/FILL TO A] or  
[INTRO B/FILL TO B] buttons to select the type of start you want.  
START/STOP  
TAP  
SYNCHRO  
START/STOP  
The first (red) dot of the BEAT display will flash at the current tempo  
when a synchronized start mode has been selected. The synchronized  
start mode can be canceled by pressing the [SYNCHRO] button a sec-  
ond time so that its indicator goes out. The synchronized start mode is  
automatically canceled once playback has started.  
If the [SYNCHRO] button is pressed  
during playback, playback is stopped  
and the synchronized start mode is  
automatically engaged.  
G Tap start ......................................................................................................................  
The [TAP] button can also be used to  
change the tempo during rhythm play-  
back (tap twice). In this case the tap”  
click will not sound.  
This function lets you set the tempo and start the rhythm in one op-  
eration. Simply tap the [TAP] button at the required tempo — 3 times for  
a 3/4 style, 4 times for 2/4, 4/4, and 6-beat styles, and 5 times for 5-beat  
styles. The rhythm will start from the beginning of the next measure at  
the specified tempo.  
If you tap the [TAP] button less than  
the required number of times (i.e. 3, 4,  
or 5), the tap tempo function will be  
canceled after a few seconds.  
START/STOP  
TAP  
SYNCHRO  
START/STOP  
G The Beat Display ...............................................................................................  
The four LED dots of the BEAT display provide a visual indication of  
the selected tempo during accompaniment playback. The leftmost (red)  
dot flashes on the first beat of each measure, the second dot flashes on  
the second beat, and so on (all dots except the leftmost dot are green).  
The current measure number appears on the LCD during playback.  
Measure number  
BEAT  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accompaniment  
Fill-ins  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S provides four types of automatic “fill-ins.”  
G Fill To A: Press the [INTRO A/FILL TO A] button during play-  
back to produce a fill-in and go to the MAIN A rhythm  
pattern. Different fill-in patterns are produced when go-  
ing from A to A or B to A.  
G Fill To B: Press the [INTRO B/FILL TO B] button during play-  
back to produce a fill-in and go to the MAIN B pattern.  
Different fill-in patterns are produced when going from A  
to B or B to B.  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B  
ENDING  
ABC ON  
If you hold one of the FILL buttons, the fill-in will repeat until the  
end of the measure in which button is released. If you press a fill-in but-  
ton during the fill-in, the fill-in will stop and playback of the previous  
variation will resume.  
Left-pedal Break  
When the left-pedal function is set to “Break” as described on pages  
27 and 93, the left pedal can be used to create a break in the accompani-  
ment while playing. Press the left pedal to mute the accompaniment  
sound. Accompaniment sound will resume from the top of the next  
measure when the pedal is released. The break can be canceled before  
the beginning of the next measure by pressing the pedal a second time.  
CVP-79A  
Stopping the Accompaniment  
The accompaniment can be stopped at any time by pressing the  
[START/STOP] button. Press the [ENDING] button if you want to go  
to the ending pattern and then stop. Press [ENDING] a second time dur-  
ing ending playback to produce a ritardando (gradually slowing) ending.  
Different ending patterns are provided for the MAIN A and MAIN B  
Playback will start with the ending  
pattern if you press the [ENDING]  
button before starting playback. The  
ending can be disengaged before  
starting playback by pressing any other  
variation button.  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accompaniment  
variations (the [MAIN A] or [MAIN B] button indictor will flash during  
the ending). The ending will begin from the top of the next measure if  
the [ENDING] button is pressed on or after the 2nd beat of a measure.  
During playback the indicator of the  
currently-playing variation will be lit  
while that of the next variation to play  
flashes. (The only exception is: during  
playback of the ending, the flashing  
[MAIN A] or [MAIN B] button indicator  
indicates which ending variation is  
currently playing.)  
START/STOP  
TAP  
SYNCHRO  
START/STOP  
If the left pedal is switched to START/  
STOP operation (pages 27 and 93), it  
performs the same function as the  
panel [START/STOP] buttons (press to  
START, press again to STOP). The left  
pedal can also be assigned for INTRO  
A/FILL TO A, INTRO B/FILL TO B, and  
ENDING operation pages 30 and  
32.  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN A MAIN B ENDING  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
ABC ON  
Metronome  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S also offers a metronome function that is  
ideal for practice.  
To start the metronome, simply press the [METRONOME] button so  
that its indicator lights. The metronome will play at the currently selected  
tempo whether a style is playing or not. The metronome volume can be  
adjusted via the [ABC/SONG VOLUME] control.  
If a style is started by pressing the  
[START/STOP] button while the metro-  
nome is playing, the metronome will  
continue to sound along with the style.  
The metronome bell accent will not  
sound during accompaniment play-  
back.  
METRONOME  
The pop-up screen that appears when the [METRONOME] button is  
pressed also provides access to a range of other metronome settings.  
When “NORMAL” is selected the metronome click sounds continuously  
at the current tempo with no accented beats. The “4/4”, “3/4”, “2/4”, and  
“5/4” settings produce a bell accent on the first beat of each measure.  
Press the [METRONOME] button again to stop the metronome  
sound (the METRONOME indicator will go out). The metronome will  
also stop automatically if the [START/STOP] button is pressed to stop a  
style in progress.  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S includes a sophisticated auto-accompa-  
niment system (Auto Bass Chord — ABC) that can provide auto-  
mated rhythm, bass and chord backing in a number of ways.  
STYLE  
DANCE  
POP  
16BEAT  
POP  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
PRESET  
METRONOME  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
DISK  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
CUSTOM  
REW  
P
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN A MAIN B ENDING  
START/STOP  
SYNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
ABC ON  
TAP  
START/STOP  
Single-Finger, Fingered Chord, and  
Full Keyboard Accompaniment  
“Single Finger” accompaniment makes it simple to produce accompaniment using major,  
seventh, minor and minor-seventh chords by pressing a minimum number of keys in the ABC  
section of the keyboard. The automatic accompaniment consists of rhythm, bass and chords.  
“Fingered Chord” accompaniment is ideal if you already know how to play chords on a  
keyboard, since it allows you to supply your own chords for the auto accompaniment feature.  
When the “Full Keyboard” mode is selected the Clavinova will automatically create appro-  
priate accompaniment while you play just about anything, anywhere on the keyboard.  
ZSelect a Style.........................................................................................................  
Select an accompaniment style using the style selectors and STYLE  
pop-up screen (see “Style Selection” on page 28).  
XSet the Tempo .......................................................................................................  
Use the TEMPO [+] and [–] buttons to set the desired accompani-  
ment tempo if necessary (see “Tempo Control” on page 29 for more de-  
tails).  
TEMPO  
+
PRESET  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
CTurn ABC On..........................................................................................................  
Press the [ABC ON] button so that its indicator lights and the ABC  
MODE pop-up screen appears. — The ABC mode is alternately turned  
on and off each time the [ABC ON] button is pressed.  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B  
ENDING  
ABC ON  
VSelect an ABC Mode......................................................................................  
Before the ABC MODE pop-up screen disappears use the LCD but-  
tons to select the SINGLE FINGER, FINGERED CHORD, or FULL  
KEYBOARDABC mode. The default mode is SINGLE FINGER, but  
the mode you select is backed up even after the [POWER] switch is  
turned off. Backup can be turned off via the Backup function — page  
107.  
BStart & Play..............................................................................................................  
Start playback by pressing the [START/STOP] button or by using the  
[SYNCHRO] start mode.  
G Single-finger Accompaniment  
Pressing any key on the ABC section of the keyboard (up to the split  
point — normally the F#2 key) will cause the automatic chord and  
bass accompaniment to begin. If you press a “C” key, for example, a  
C-major accompaniment will be played. Press another key in the  
ABC section of the keyboard to select a new chord. The key you press  
will always determine the “root” of the chord played (i.e. “C” for a C  
chord). The name of the detected chord will appear on the display.  
Detected chord  
name  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
Single-finger minor, seventh, and minor-seventh chords can be played  
as follows:  
Cm  
• For a minor chord, press the root key and a black  
key to its left.  
C
7
• For a seventh chord, press the root key and a  
white key to its left.  
Cm  
7
• For a minor-seventh chord, press the root key and  
both a white and black key to its left.  
G Fingered Accompaniment  
As soon as you play any chord on the lower keyboard (up to the split  
point — normally the F#2 key), the Clavinova will automatically be-  
gin to play the chord along with the rhythm and an appropriate bass  
line. The name of the detected chord will appear on the display. “*”  
will appear if the chord is not recognizable by the CVP-79A/69/69A/  
59S.  
The automatic accompaniment will  
sometimes not change when related  
chords are played in sequence (e.g.  
some minor chords followed by the  
minor seventh).  
The Clavinova will accept the following chord types in the Fingered  
Accompaniment mode:  
• Major  
• Minor seventh ninth [m7(9)]  
• Sixth [6]  
• Minor seventh eleventh [m7(11)]  
• Minor major seventh flatted fifth [mM7(b5)]  
• Minor major seventh [mM7]  
• Minor major seventh ninth [mM7(9)]  
• Minor flatted fifth [m(b5)]  
• Major seventh [M7]  
• Major seventh flatted fifth [M7(b5)]  
• Major seventh sharp eleventh [M7(#11)]  
• Added ninth [add9]  
• Major seventh ninth [M7(9)]  
• Six ninth [6(9)]  
• Diminished seventh [dim7]  
• Seventh [7]  
• Flatted fifth [(b5)]  
• Seventh suspended fourth [7sus4]  
• Seventh ninth [7(9)]  
• Augmented [aug]  
• Seventh augmented [7(#5)]  
• Major seventh augmented [M7(#5)]  
• Minor [m]  
• Seventh sharp eleventh [7(#11)]  
• Seventh added thirteenth [7(13)]  
• Seventh flatted fifth [7(b5)]  
• Seventh flatted ninth [7(b9)]  
• Seventh added flatted thirteenth [7(b13)]  
• Seventh sharp ninth [7(#9)]  
• Suspended fourth [sus4]  
• Minor sixth [m6]  
• Minor seventh [m7]  
• Minor seventh flatted fifth [m7(b5)]  
• Minor added ninth [madd9]  
* A Fingering Chart is provided on page 123.  
“On-bass” chords are also recognized. Two-note fingerings will pro-  
duce a chord based on the previous chord.  
“No chord” (i.e. rhythm only accompaniment) can be produced by  
pressing any three consecutive keys (ex. C,C#,D) simultaneously.  
“- - -” will appear instead of a chord name.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
G Full-keyboard ABC  
When this advanced auto-accompaniment mode is engaged the  
Clavinova will automatically create appropriate accompaniment while  
you play just about anything, anywhere on the keyboard: chords, a  
bass line, arpeggiated chords, a melody line. The name of the detected  
chord will appear on the display. You don’t have to worry about speci-  
fying the accompaniment chords. Although Full-keyboard ABC is  
designed to work with many songs, some arrangements may not be  
suitable for use with this feature. Try playing a few simple songs in  
the Full-keyboard ABC mode to get a feel for its capabilities.  
Chord detection occurs at approxi-  
mately 8th-note intervals. Extremely  
short chords less than an 8th note  
in length may therefore not be  
detected.  
The DUAL or SPLIT mode can be  
used with ABC.  
NStop the Accompaniment ........................................................................  
The [INTRO A/FILL TO A], [INTRO B/  
FILL TO B], [MAIN A], [MAIN B], and  
[ENDING] buttons can be used in the  
ABC mode to create pattern variations  
(refer to the Accompanimentsection  
on pages 30 and 32 for details).  
Press the [START/STOP] or [ENDING] button to stop the accompa-  
niment.  
START/STOP  
TAP  
SYNCHRO  
START/STOP  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN A MAIN B ENDING  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
ABC ON  
Press the [ABC ON] button so that its indicator goes out when you  
want to exit from the ABC mode.  
Overall Accompaniment Volume Control  
Use the ABC/SONG VOLUME control to adjust the volume of the  
accompaniment sound in relation to the keyboard sound. No accompani-  
ment sound will be produced if the MASTER VOLUME control is set  
to its “MIN” position.  
VOLUME  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
ABC/SONG  
VOLUME  
MAX  
MAX  
MIN  
MIN  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
Individual Part Volume Control  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S has five accompaniment parts — RHYTHM,  
BASS, CHORD, PAD, and PHRASE. — that function as follows:  
Some styles may not use all five  
parts.  
RHYTHM  
BASS  
This is the main rhythm part. The RHYTHM part usually plays one  
of the drum kits.  
The BASS part always plays a bass line, but the voice will change  
to fit the selected style … acoustic bass, synth bass, tuba, etc.  
CHORD  
This part provides the rhythmic chordal accompaniment required  
by each style. You’ll find guitar, piano, and other chordal instru-  
ments here.  
PAD  
This part plays long chords where necessary, using sustained  
instruments such as strings, organ, choir.  
PHRASE  
This is where the musical embellishments reside. The PHRASE  
part is used for punchy brass stabs, arpeggiated chords, and other  
extras that make the accompaniment more interesting.  
The volume of the RHYTHM, BASS, CHORD, PAD, and PHRASE ac-  
companiment parts can be individually adjusted via the volume parameters  
accessed by the [MIXER] button. Select the part you want to control by first  
pressing the appropriate LCD button, then use the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons  
to set the volume as required. The normal volume level for any part (“90”)  
can be instantly recalled by simultaneously pressing the [+] and [–] buttons  
while the desired part is selected. Several parts can be selected at once by  
pressing their buttons at the same time. The volume of all selected parts can  
then be adjusted simultaneously. The mixer parameters will disappear when  
the [MIXER] button is pressed a second time (or the [EXIT] button is  
pressed).  
The volume level can be adjusted  
in two steps intervals.  
FUNCTION MIXER  
The second page of the MIXER display (accessed via the PAGE buttons)  
includes individual volume parameters for the keyboard (manually played  
sound) and harmony function sound — see page 41 for details on the Har-  
mony function. There’s also a PRESETLCD button in this page which in-  
stantly resets all MIXER volume parameters to their default values (100 for  
KBD part, and 90 for all other parts).  
Part volume relation:  
ABC/SONG volume is relative to  
the MASTER VOLUME.  
Each RHYTHM, BASS, CHORD,  
PAD or PHRASE part volume is  
relative to ABC/SONG volume.  
KBD part volume is relative to  
MASTER volume.  
HARMONY part volume is relative  
to KBD part volume.  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
Small ABC  
A simple form of “orchestration” control is provided by the [SMALL  
ABC] button. When this button is pressed so that its indicator lights  
some of the accompaniment parts are turned off to create a simpler,  
“smaller” accompaniment sound.  
ABC will not sound when the [ABC  
ON] button is turned off, even if the  
[SMALL ABC] button is turned on.  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
INTRO A/  
FILL TO A  
INTRO B/  
FILL TO B  
SMALL  
ABC  
MAIN A  
MAIN B  
ENDING  
ABC ON  
Press the [SMALL ABC] button a second time so that its indicator  
goes out to turn the SMALL ABC function off.  
Changing the ABC Split Point  
The ABC split point can be set at any key by pressing the desired key  
while holding the [ABC ON] button. The split point can also be set by  
using the SPLIT POINTLCD button in the ABC MODE pop-up dis-  
play, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons. The default split point — F#2 —  
can be recalled by simultaneously pressing the [+] and [–] buttons.  
The split point is indicated by the key-  
board guide lamp above the split point  
key.  
SMALL  
ABC  
ENDING  
ABC ON  
+
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
Chord Assist  
The Chord Assist function is essentially an electronic “chord book” that will show you appropriate  
fingerings for chords you enter via the display. The fingerings are indicated via the keyboard guide lamps,  
and correspond to those recognized in the ABC Fingered mode. You can also play chords on the keyboard  
in the same way as in the ABC Fingered mode.  
ZSelect the Chord Assist Function...................................................  
Press the CHORD ASSISTLCD button in the ABC MODE pop-up  
display.  
XStart the Accompaniment .......................................................................  
Start the accompaniment by using any of the methods described on  
pages 30 and 31.  
CEnter the Chord Root ...................................................................................  
Press the ROOTLCD button to select the desired chord root, or use  
the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons once the ROOTparameter is selected.  
VEnter the Chord Type....................................................................................  
Use the TYPEG and G LCD buttons to select the chord type. The  
data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can also be used once the TYPEparameter  
is selected.  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
BEnter the Chord ..................................................................................................  
The chord name entered via the LCD  
will appear in the TYPE and ROOT  
parameter locations, while the actually  
recognized chord name will appear  
next to the keyboard symbol above the  
parameters.  
The fingering for the chord selected via the LCD buttons will appear  
on the keyboard guide lamps. At this point you can either play the indi-  
cated chord on the keyboard or press the ENTERLCD button to actually  
enter the specified chord — i.e. the specified chord accompaniment will  
sound.  
A flashing keyboard guide lamp indi-  
cates a note which may be omitted.  
NRotate the Fingering as Necessary ..............................................  
Press the ROTATELCD button to shift the fingering down the key-  
board. Each time the ROTATEbutton is pressed the next viable fingering  
(inversion) appears on the guide lamps. The inversion number appears in  
the ROTATEsection of the display.  
MStop the Accompaniment........................................................................  
The following chord types can be  
specified via the Chord Assist display:  
Maj, 7, m, m7, m7(b5), 6, m6, M7,  
sus4, aug, m(b5), 7sus4, 7(#5), dim7,  
(b5), 7(b5), mM7. All fingered-mode  
chords (page 36) can be entered via  
the keyboard.  
Press the [START/STOP] or [ENDING] button to stop the accompa-  
niment.  
<Exit When Done ..................................................................................................  
The split point is not shown on the  
guide lamps when the Chord Assist  
function is engaged.  
Press the panel [ABC ON] button, so that its indicator goes out, to  
exit from the Chord Assist function and ABC mode when done.  
If the split point is set below F#2 it will  
automatically be set at F#2.  
Harmony  
This feature automatically adds appropriate harmony notes or delayed decorative notes (up to three  
notes) to a melody or chords you play on the keyboard. The harmony notes are produced to match chords  
played via the ABC auto-accompaniment system.  
ZTurn Harmony On .............................................................................................  
The Harmony feature cannot be turned  
Press the [HARMONY] button so that its indicator lights to turn the  
on when the Full Keyboard ABC mode  
HARMONY feature on.  
is selected.  
STYLE  
DANCE  
POP  
16BEAT  
POP  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
ONE TO
SETTING  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
DISK  
CUSTOM  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
XSelect a Harmony Type ...............................................................................  
With some harmony types the voice  
used for the harmony will be different  
from the currently selected voice.  
While the HARMONY pop-up display is showing, use the data dial  
or [+]/[–] buttons to select the desired harmony type. 16 harmony types  
are available.  
+
Harmony Type List  
Duet  
Tremolo Oct  
Strumming  
Trio Delay  
Trio  
4 Part  
4 Part Jazz  
Country  
Octave  
Vibes & J.Gtr  
Add Trp & Sax  
Backing Vocal  
Add Strings  
Forest  
Tremolo  
Tremolo Duet  
CSet Up ABC As Required..........................................................................  
The Harmony feature can be used  
while ABC is off, but only octaves will  
be produced.  
Select an accompaniment style, tempo, and ABC mode (except Full  
Keyboard).  
VStart ABC Playback........................................................................................  
Start accompaniment playback using any of the methods described on  
pages 30 and 31.  
BPlay ..................................................................................................................................  
Play the required chords (single-finger or fingered chord) on the ABC  
section of the keyboard while playing a melody line or chords on the  
right-hand section of the keyboard. When chords are played on the right-  
hand section of the keyboard, the harmony will be applied to the last note  
played.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
NStop the Accompaniment........................................................................  
Press [START/STOP] or [ENDING] button to stop the accompani-  
ment.  
MTurn Harmony Off .............................................................................................  
Harmony can be turned on and off  
while playing.  
Press the [HARMONY] button again, so that its indicator goes out,  
to turn the function off.  
STYLE  
DANCE  
POP  
16BEAT  
POP  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
ONE TO
SETTING  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
DISK  
CUSTOM  
G The Left Pedal & Harmony......................................................................  
The Left Pedal HARMONY ON/OFF  
function is not effective when the HAR-  
MONY feature is off (i.e. the [HAR-  
MONY] buttons indicator is not lit).  
If the Left Pedal Function is set to HARMONY ON/OFF (pages 27  
and 93), harmonization of notes played on the right-hand section of the  
keyboard only occurs while the left pedal is pressed. This allows you to  
combine normal ABC type performance with harmony as required.  
CVP-79A  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Bass Chord (ABC)  
One Touch Setting  
The CVP-79A internal styles each have 4 different preset “panel setups” that can be recalled via the  
[ONE TOUCH SETTING] button to create different musical textures. The CVP-69/69A styles have 3,  
and the CVP-59S styles have 1. The ONE TOUCH SETTING setups include settings for all of the follow-  
ing parameters:  
One Touch Setting Parameter List  
Accompaniment Parameters  
Voice Parameters  
• Voice  
• Effect Depth (Main  
Voice, Dual Voice,  
Split Voice)  
• ABC On  
• Rhythm Volume  
• Dual Detune Depth  
• Reverb On/Off  
• Reverb Type  
• Keyboard Volume  
• Dual Mode  
• Small ABC On/Off  
• Harmony On/Off  
• Harmony Type  
• Bass Volume  
• Chord Volume  
• Pad Volume  
• Right/1 Octave Shift  
• Left Octave Shift  
• 2nd Octave Shift  
• Right/1 Pan  
• Split Mode  
• Reverb Depth (Total,  
Rhythm, Bass, Chord,  
Keyboard)  
• Dual Voice  
• ABC/Song Volume • Phrase Volume  
• Split Voice  
• Main A/B  
• Tempo  
• Harmony Volume  
• Effect On/Off  
• Effect Type  
• Dual Balance  
• Split Balance  
• Left Pan  
• 2nd Pan  
ZEngage the One Touch Setting Feature...................................  
The ONE TOUCH SETTING feature can be used either while an  
accompaniment is playing or prior to starting an accompaniment by sim-  
ply pressing the [ONE TOUCH SETTING] button. The corresponding  
panel setup is recalled immediately. On the CVP-79A and CVP-69/69A  
other ONE TOUCH SETTING setups can also be recalled in the ONE  
TOUCH SETTING pop-up display by using the SELECTG and GGLCD  
buttons.  
To return to the settings that were  
active prior to engaging the One Touch  
Setting feature, re-select the style after  
selecting a different style (ABC will  
remain on however).  
The One Touch Setting feature cannot  
be used when a [DISK/CUSTOM] style  
is selected.  
ABC is automatically turned ON when  
the One Touch Setting feature is en-  
gaged.  
STYLE  
DANCE  
POP  
POP  
16BEAT  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
The synchronized start mode is auto-  
matically turned ON if the One Touch  
Setting feature is engaged before  
starting the accompaniment.  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
CUSTOM  
If the STYLE SETTING parameter in  
the BACKUP function (page 107) is set  
to on, the One Touch Setting setup  
selection for each style will be retained  
in memory even when the power is  
turned off. This way the desired setup  
can be recalled immediately when the  
[ONE TOUCH SETTING] button is  
pressed. (CVP-79A/69/69A)  
CVP-79A  
Harmony will not be turned on if the  
ABC Full Keyboard mode is selected,  
even if the selected One Touch Setting  
setup includes Harmony ON.  
XAdjust The Settings If Necessary ...................................................  
Any of the parameters set by the ONE TOUCH SETTING feature can  
be adjusted to create the desired sound after a ONE TOUCH SETTING  
setup has been selected.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S Custom Style feature allows you to  
create original accompaniment styles that can be later recalled and  
played at any time, just like the presets. Up to 8 custom styles can  
be maintained in internal memory at the same time, and any number  
can be saved to disk for later reloading and use.  
The basic custom style recording procedure is outlined below.  
Custom style data is not retained in memory when the power is turned off, so be sure to  
save your custom styles to disk before turning the power off.  
• One pre-programmed temporary style is automatically loaded into the [DISK/CUSTOM]  
memory whenever the power is turned on. (Memory is common to the Custom Styles and  
the loaded styles from the optional Style File disks — page 55.)  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
DISK  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
A
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
CUSTOM  
ZEngage the Custom Style Feature .................................................  
Press the [DISK/CUSTOM] style selector so that its indicator lights,  
then press the CUSTOM STYLELCD button. The “Please select a  
source STYLE.” message will appear on the display for a few seconds  
before going to the CUSTOM STYLE page 1 display and the current  
[DISK/ CUSTOM] style will begin playing.  
STYLE  
DANCE  
POP  
16BEAT  
POP  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
DISK  
CUSTOM  
XSelect a Source Style ...................................................................................  
Select a preset style that is close to the style you want to create. Preset  
style selection is carried out in the normal way (page 28).  
If you want to select a [DISK/CUSTOM] style, press the [DISK/  
CUSTOM] style selector once again and use the STYLEG and G but-  
tons, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons to select a [DISK/CUSTOM]  
style.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
CSelect the Section You Want to Record ...................................  
In the CUSTOM STYLE, MAIN A,  
MAIN B, INTRO, FILL IN or ENDING  
are referred to as section, and  
RHYTHM 1/2, BASS, CHORD 1/2,  
PAD or PHRASE 1/2 are referred to as  
part.  
In the CUSTOM STYLE page 1 display, press the first LCD button as  
many times as necessary to select the section you want to program first:  
MAIN A, MAIN B, INTRO, FILL IN, or ENDING. The MAIN A sec-  
tion is initially selected.  
Total measure number of  
the selected section  
Only one pattern can be created for  
each INTRO, FILL IN and ENDING  
section.  
Current measure number of  
the selected section  
Beat of the selected style  
Whether the Aor Bvariations of the  
INTRO, FILL IN and ENDING sections  
are used as the source pattern de-  
pends on whether the MAIN A or MAIN  
B section was selected when the Cus-  
tom Style function was engaged. (As  
for FILL IN, FILL IN from A to A, or  
FILL IN from B to Bis used.)  
VChange the Time Signature & Number Of Measures,  
If Required................................................................................................................  
If you want to create a style in a different time signature than the cur-  
rent style, or change the number of measures in the selected section,  
Press the PAGE [>] button to go to CUSTOM STYLE page 2.  
Current recording section and part  
Use the BEATLCD button to select a different time signature, or the  
data dial or [+]/[–] buttons once the BEATparameter has been selected.  
As soon as you choose to change the beat value, the “Clear STYLE ?”  
prompt will appear, since you will have to completely clear all sections  
and parts of the style and start recording from scratch if you change the  
time signature. Press OKto clear the style, or CANCELto abort. Once  
the style has been cleared you can select a new time signature as re-  
quired: 2/4, 3/4, 4/4, or 5/4.  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
Use the MEAS.LCD button to select a different number of measures  
for the selected section, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons once the  
MEAS.parameter has been selected. As soon as you choose to change  
the number of measures in the section, the “Clear SECTION ?”  
prompt will appear, since you will have to clear all parts of the currently  
selected section and start recording from scratch if you change the  
number of measures. Press OKto clear the section, or CANCELto abort.  
Once the section has been cleared you can select a new number of meas-  
ures as required: 1 through 8. The FILL IN section has only 1 measure  
and the number of measures cannot be changed although the FILL IN  
section can be cleared using this operation.  
Once the BEATand/or MEAS.parameters have been set as required,  
press the PAGE [<] button to go back to the first custom style page.  
BSelect the Part & Voice You Want to Record ......................  
Use the PARTLCD button, the data dial, or [+]/[–] buttons to select  
the part you want to record:  
R1  
R2  
Bs  
C1  
Rhythm 1  
Rhythm 2  
Bass  
Chord 1  
C2  
Pd  
P1  
P2  
Chord 2  
Pad  
Phrase 1  
Phrase 2  
The R1 part is initially selected and set to the record mode.  
Any part you select can be set to the record mode by using the rightmost  
LCD button to select “REC” after selecting the part ( the part number  
will appear white in a black box). Since parts other than R1 and R2 must  
be cleared before they can be recorded (if the source style is a preset  
style or a style loaded from the optional Style File disk) the “Clear  
Part ?” confirmation will appear if you select a part that contains data:  
press OKto clear the part and continue, or CANCELto abort. Only one  
part can be set to the record mode. All other parts will be set to “PLAY”  
(part number surrounded by box) or turned “OFF” (part number only —  
no box). Parts that contain no data are indicated by a dot in place of the  
part number.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
At this point you can also select the voice you want to record with  
(the preset voice for that part will initially be selected). Only [DRUMS/  
PERC.] voices can be used for the R1 part and only Drum Kit voices can  
be used for the R2 part, while any other voices can be selected for the  
remaining parts.  
NRecord the Selected part..........................................................................  
Playback can be started and stopped  
via the [START/STOP] button as re-  
quired while in the Custom Style mode  
data cannot be recorded while  
playback is stopped.  
You can now add new parts to the selected part by playing the key-  
board at the appropriate timing (play in C Major seventh since the Cus-  
tom Style is recorded as a C Major seventh pattern). If you want to create  
a totally new part from scratch, press the CLEARLCD button to clear  
the selected part before beginning to record. If both the R1 and R2 parts  
are cleared the metronome will sound to provide a timing guide (the met-  
ronome sound is not recorded). When a drum kit voice is used, a single  
drum instrument sound can be cleared from the R1 or R2 part by press-  
ing the key corresponding to the instrument to be cleared while holding  
the keyboard “CANCEL” (C1) key. The metronome timing guide can  
also be cleared in this way.  
The timing guide will stop as soon as  
the Custom Style is stored.  
The sound of all parts is automatically  
stopped at the end of the style i.e.  
at the point between repeats when  
recording. It is therefore not advisable  
to record over this point.  
Another useful recording aid is the SOLOLCD button: when this  
button is pressed and highlighted, only the selected part will sound. Press  
the SOLObutton again to turn the solo function off and hear the entire  
style.  
MQuantize the Recorded Part, if Necessary ............................  
You can “tighten up” the timing of a recorded part by aligning all  
notes to specified beats via the PART QUANTIZE function in CUSTOM  
STYLE page 2 (press the PAGE [>] button). Press the LCD button be-  
low the note symbol to select “quantize size” — i.e. the beats to which  
the notes in the current part will be aligned:  
32nd notes  
8th notes  
3
3
16th note triplets  
16th notes  
quarter-note triplets  
quarter notes  
3
8th note triplets  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
Quantization can only be applied to the  
current recording part. Quantization  
cannot be executed if no part is set to  
the record mode.  
Once the required quantize size has been selected press the START  
LCD button to actually quantize the current part. Playback will stop for  
an instant while the data is being quantized, then the STARTLCD button  
will change to UNDO, allowing you to undo the quantize operation and  
return to the pre-quantized data if the results are not as you expected.  
You will not be able to UNDO once another button has been pressed.  
<Repeat Until the Custom Style is Complete ........................  
During Custom Style recording, no  
MIXER display is available.  
Repeat steps 3 through 7 until all parts or all sections have been re-  
corded as required.  
>Name the Custom Style .............................................................................  
When your custom style is complete, use the PAGE buttons to select  
CUSTOM STYLE page 3, and press the STYLE NAMELCD button to  
go to the style naming page.  
The current style name appears in the upper right corner of the dis-  
play. Use the >LCD button to position the underline cursor at the char-  
acter you want to change (style names can be up to 12 characters in  
length). Use the data dial and/or the [+]/[–] buttons to select the charac-  
ter you want to enter from the list in the center of the display, then press  
the c.setLCD button to enter the character at the current cursor posi-  
tion. Repeat this procedure until your name is complete. The c.delLCD  
button can be used to back up one space and delete a character.  
When the name is complete press the OKLCD button to register the  
name for the current custom style, or CANCELto abort.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
?Store the Custom Style ..............................................................................  
The tempo setting at the time the  
Custom Style is stored becomes the  
preset tempo for that style.  
Press the STORELCD button in CUSTOM STYLE page 3 to store  
the current custom style in the internal memory. The “Store  
XXXXXXXX?” confirmation prompt and MEMORY No. parameter  
will appear (“XXXXXXXX” is the style name). Use the MEMORY No.  
G and G LCD buttons to select the memory number — 1 through 8 —  
to which you want to store the custom style, then press OKto store or  
CANCELto abort.  
If the selected memory number already  
contains a style, the style name will  
appear next to the memory number.  
The existing style will be overwritten  
when a new style is stored.  
[Exit When Done ..................................................................................................  
Custom style data is not retained in  
memory when the power is turned off,  
so be sure to save your custom style  
before turning the power off see  
Save to diskon page 52.  
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Custom Style mode and re-  
turn to the normal play mode.  
EXIT  
Other Custom Style Functions  
In addition to the various functions described in the basic custom style recording procedure, above, the  
CUSTOM STYLE display pages include several other functions that you may find useful when creating  
custom styles.  
G Recall Section ......................................................................................................  
This function makes it possible to recall the last-stored version of the  
currently selected section (all parts of the section are recalled). Simply  
press the RECALL SECTIONLCD button in CUSTOM STYLE page 2.  
If the recall operation can’t be carried out (i.e. The time signature has  
been changed), the “Can’t recall!” alert display will appear. If this  
happens press OKto return to the previous display.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
G Style Clear ................................................................................................................  
Press the STYLE CLEARLCD button in CUSTOM STYLE page 3 to  
entirely clear the current custom style. The “Are you sure?” confir-  
mation prompt will appear. Press YESto clear the style or NOto abort.  
G Volume & Effects...............................................................................................  
CUSTOM STYLE page 4 includes a range of parameters that let you  
individually set the volume, reverb, effect, and pan for each part of each  
custom style section. Use the SECT.parameter to select the section (or  
“ALL” sections), and the PARTparameter to select the part (or “ALL”  
parts). The third LCD button selects VOLUME, REVERB, EFFECT or  
PAN, and the VALUE(or DEPTH) parameter sets the amount or depth.  
When VOLUME is selected the SECT.parameter is fixed at “ALL” and  
the VALUErange is from –50 to +50, relative to the preset volume of the  
source style. The REVERB and EFFECT DEPTHranges are from 0 to  
100. The PAN VALUEsettings are L10 (full left) … C (center) … R10  
(full right). When EFFECT is selected the TYPEparameter appears and  
you can also select the effect type via the TYPELCD button. The avail-  
able effect types are listed below.  
Normally the preset VALUE and EF-  
FECT TYPE are initially selected. If  
PART is set to ALL, the R1 part  
preset values are displayed. If SECT.  
is set to ALL, the MAIN A preset  
values are displayed.  
Effect Type List  
Effect type OTHERSmay appear if  
the preset effect type is other than that  
of what is in the list.  
• CHORUS 1  
• CHORUS 2  
• CHORUS 3  
• CELESTE 1  
• CELESTE 2  
• CELESTE 3  
• FLANGER 1  
• FLANGER 2  
• SYMPHONIC (CVP-79A only)  
• PHASER (CVP-79A only)  
• OFF  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
G Save to Disk............................................................................................................  
A complete set of 8 custom styles or individual custom styles can be  
saved to disk via CUSTOM STYLE page 5.  
After making sure that a properly formatted disk is inserted in the  
Clavinova disk drive (page 98), use the MEMORY No.G and G but-  
tons to select the memory number of the custom style you want to save  
to disk, or “ALL” if you want to save a complete set of 8 custom styles.  
When this is done, press the SAVELCD button to start saving the data to  
disk. At this point the name entry display will appear and you can enter a  
name for the Custom Style disk file in the same way as you entered a  
name for the Custom Style itself (page 49). Press SAVEwhen the name  
has been entered. If a file with the same name already exists the “Same  
name! Overwrite?” confirmation prompt will appear. Press OKto  
overwrite the existing file or CANCELto abort.  
Saved Custom Style files can be  
loaded via the STYLE FILE LOAD”  
function described in the Style File  
Loadsection (page 55).  
A single floppy disk can hold up to 60  
song files (page 72) and 60 style files  
(the total number of files however, is  
approximately 110 files).  
Your custom styles must be stored to internal memory before they can  
be saved to disk (see step 10 of the basic custom style recording proce-  
dure). If a custom style has not been stored and you attempt to save it to  
disk, the “Please store before saving” alert display will appear.  
If this happens press OKto return to the previous display (CUSTOM  
STYLE page 3), store the custom style, then try saving again.  
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Custom Style mode and re-  
turn to the normal play mode.  
Playing Back Your Custom Styles  
Once created, your original custom styles can be selected for play-  
back by pressing the [DISK/CUSTOM] button (its LED will light), and  
then using the STYLEG and G LCD buttons — or the data dial or [+]/  
[–] buttons — to select the custom style you want to play. The selected  
style can then be played and used with ABC auto accompaniment in ex-  
actly the same way as the preset styles (page 28).  
Since only one type of INTRO, FILL IN,  
and ENDING section can be recorded  
for each Custom Style, no A/Bvaria-  
tions are produced during playback.  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
Custom Style Alert & Error Displays  
The following alert and error displays may appear in the corresponding situations.  
G Insufficient Memory To Store ..............................................................  
This alert message will appear if there is not enough memory to per-  
form a store operation.  
In this case it will be necessary to either delete a style you don’t need  
or simplify the style you are currently recording. Press CANCELto re-  
turn to CUSTOM STYLE page 1, at which point you can simplify the  
current style (by clearing a part, etc.), or DELETEto go to the “Delete  
STYLE ?” display:  
Use the MEMORY No.G and G buttons to select the number of the  
style you want to delete, then press OKto delete the style, or CANCEL  
to abort.  
The amount of memory being used for  
the selected style is also shown on the  
display (in approximate kilobytes) so  
as to set up the approximate standard  
which style to delete in relation to the  
total 160 KB memory space.  
G Memory Full During Recording.........................................................  
This alert message will appear if the memory becomes full during  
recording or editing.  
Press OKto return to CUSTOM STYLE page 1 and simplify the style  
by clearing a part, etc.  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Custom Style  
G Exit Before Store........................................................................................................  
If you press [EXIT] button to exit from the Custom Style function before  
storing the style the following display will appear.  
Select a memory number and press YESto store the style and then exit,  
press NOto exit without storing the style, or press CANCELto return to the  
Custom Style mode.  
G Style Change Before Store..............................................................................  
If you attempt to select a different source style before storing the current  
style you recorded, the following display will appear.  
If you want to select a different  
source style without storing the  
current style, exit from the CUS-  
TOM STYLE mode without storing  
the style (see Exit Before Store”  
above), and then re-enter the  
CUSTOM STYLE mode.  
Select a memory number and press OKto store the style and then select  
the new source style, or press CANCELto return to the Custom Style mode.  
G Too Many Files..............................................................................................................  
A single floppy disk can hold up to 60 style files. If you attempt to save  
more the following display will appear.  
Press OKto clear the display, then prepare a new disk and save the file(s).  
G Disk Full...............................................................................................................................  
If the current disk becomes full during a save operation the following  
display will appear.  
Style files cannot be deleted from  
the disk.  
Press OKto clear the display, then either delete any unwanted song files  
or other files from the disk, or prepare a new disk.  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Style File Load  
Style files from optionalYamaha “Style File” disks, or disks containing  
custom style files you’ve created yourself, can be loaded into the  
CVP-79A/69/69A/59S and played as required.  
Loaded disk styles will be retained in memory only until the power is turned off.  
One pre-programmed temporary style is automatically loaded into the [DISK/CUSTOM]  
memory whenever the power is turned on.  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
DISK  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
CUSTOM  
Loading Disk Styles  
ZInsert the Style Disk ......................................................................................  
The No disk!alert will appear if no  
Insert the Style File Disk into the disk drive with the sliding door on  
the disk facing the drive slot and the label side facing upward. The disk  
should click into place and the disk lamp will light briefly while the  
Clavinova reads and identifies the disk. When an appropriate Style File  
disk is inserted, the STYLE FILE LOAD display (see step 2 below) will  
appear automatically. If the disk is already inserted and the STYLE FILE  
LOAD display is not showing, press the [DISK/CUSTOM] selector to  
call the DISK/CUSTOM STYLE display and press the LOAD SINGLE  
button.  
disk is currently inserted.  
The No file!alert will appear if the  
currently inserted disk contains no  
style files.  
If a disk containing both song and style  
files is loaded, the SONG PLAY mode  
will automatically be selected. In this  
case press the SONG [PLAY] button  
so that its indicator goes out to exit  
from the SONG PLAY mode, then  
press the [DISK/CUSTOM] button.  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Style File Load  
A set of 8 files saved by using the Custom Style save “ALL” function  
(page 45) can be loaded by pressing the ALLLOAD LCD button rather  
than the LOAD SINGLEbutton. The rest of the ALL LOAD procedure is  
essentially the same as the LOAD SINGLE procedure, as follows.  
XSelect a Style File.............................................................................................  
If a tempo is set prior to loading the  
style, that tempo becomes the default  
for the loaded style.  
Use the STYLE FILEG and G LCD buttons — or the data dial or  
[+]/[-] buttons — to select the desired style file.  
You can “preview” the selected style by pressing the LISTENLCD  
button (the “LISTEN” function is not available in the ALL LOAD dis-  
play).  
Some styles are too large for the LIS-  
TEN function. In this case the Too  
much data for listen! Please [LOAD].”  
alert display will appear. In this case  
load the style directly as in step 3.  
ABC is automatically turned on when  
the LOAD SINGLE button is pressed  
and the style is played back automati-  
cally with the ABC accompaniment in  
C Major when the LISTEN LCD button  
is pressed. You can also change the  
chord or try playing on the keyboard if  
you like.  
Press the LISTENLCD button again or the [START/STOP] button  
to stop listening.  
CSelect a Memory Number & Load the Style .........................  
If the selected memory number already  
contains a style, the style name will  
appear on the display. The existing  
style will be overwritten when a new  
style is loaded.  
Use the MEMORYLCD button to select the memory number to  
which the selected style file is to be loaded (1 through 8), then press the  
LOADLCD button to load the style file.  
Repeat Step 2 and 3 to select and load more style files as you like.  
It is not necessary to select a memory number when ALL LOAD is  
selected in step 1. Simply press OKto load or CANCELto abort.  
If there is not enough memory to load the specified file the “Not  
enough memory! Delete an unneeded STYLE ?” alert dis-  
play will appear. In this case it will be necessary to delete a style you  
don’t need before loading the new style. Use the MEMORY No.G and  
G buttons to select the number of the style you want to delete, then press  
DELETEto delete the style, or CANCELto abort.  
The ALL LOAD display is as follows:  
When ALL LOAD is executed, all data  
in the eight memories will be replaced  
by new data.  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Style File Load  
The amount of memory being used for  
the selected style is also shown on the  
display (in approximate kilobytes) so  
as to set up the approximate standard  
which style to delete in relation to the  
total 160 KB memory space.  
VEject the Disk When Done ......................................................................  
The disk drive lamp will light while the  
style is being loaded. NEVER attempt  
to remove a disk while the drive lamp  
is lit.  
When you’ve finished with the Style File disk, press the disk drive  
EJECT button to remove it and return to the normal play mode display.  
You can return to the normal play mode without removing the disk by  
pressing the [EXIT] button or a STYLE selector.  
The LISTEN, LOAD, [EXIT] and style  
buttons will not function while the style  
data is being loaded (i.e. while the disk  
drive lamp is lit).  
Using Loaded Style Files  
Once loaded, style files can be selected for playback by pressing the  
[DISK/CUSTOM] button (its LED will light), and then using the  
STYLEG and G LCD buttons — or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons — to  
select the style you want to play. The selected style can then be played  
and used with ABC auto accompaniment in exactly the same way as the  
preset styles (page 28).  
STYLE  
DANCE  
POP  
16BEAT  
POP  
ROCK  
BALLAD  
WALTZ  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
DISK  
CUSTOM  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registration Memory  
The Registration Memory feature can be used to memorize a  
number of complete control-panel setups that you can recall when-  
ever needed. 25 in the CVP-79A and CVP-69/69A (5 banks x 5  
memories), and 15 in the CVP-59S (3 banks x 5 memories).  
REGISTRATION  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
1
2
3
4
5
MEMORY  
BANK  
ABC FREEZE  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
ZSet Up the Controls as Required.....................................................  
Make the desired control settings. The following settings are memo-  
rized by the Registration Memory function:  
Data Stored By the Registration Memory  
Voice parameters  
• Effect Type  
• Voice  
• Effect Depth (Main Voice, Dual  
Voice, Split Voice)  
• Keyboard Volume  
• Split Point  
• Touch Sensitivity  
• Left Pedal Function  
• Right/1 Octave Shift  
• Left Octave Shift  
• 2nd Octave Shift  
• Right/1 Pan  
• Dual Mode  
• Split Mode  
• Dual Voice  
• Split Voice  
• Dual Balance  
• Split Balance  
• Dual Detune Depth  
• Reverb On/Off  
• Reverb Type  
• Left Pan  
• 2nd Pan  
• Transpose  
• Damper Range  
• Damper Mode (CVP-79A only)  
• Reverb Depth (Total, Rhythm,  
Bass, Chord, Keyboard)  
• Effect On/Off  
Accompaniment parameters  
• ABC Mode  
• Tempo  
• ABC On/Off  
• Rhythm Volume  
• Bass Volume  
• Chord Volume  
• Pad Volume  
• Phrase Volume  
• Harmony Volume  
• Small ABC On/Off  
• Harmony On/Off  
• Harmony Type  
• ABC/Song Volume  
• Style  
• Main A/B  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registration Memory  
XSelect a Registration Bank (if necessary) .............................  
Any of the 5 or 3 Registration Memory banks can be selected by  
pressing the [BANK] button and selecting the desired bank via the pop-  
up display LCD buttons (Athrough Ein the CVP-79A/69/69A, and A  
through Cin the CVP-59S).  
REGISTRATION  
1
2
3
4
5
MEMORY  
BANK  
ABC FREEZE  
CVP-79A/69/69A  
CRegister the Settings....................................................................................  
Registration backup is normally ena-  
bled, so the registration data is re-  
tained in memory even when the  
power is turned off. If registration  
backup is turned off via the Backup”  
function described on page 107, all  
registration data will be initialized to  
the factory-preset settings when the  
power is turned off.  
While holding the [MEMORY] button, press one of the [REGIS-  
TRATION] buttons. Any data that was previously in the selected loca-  
tion is erased and replaced by the new settings. The corresponding Regis-  
tration Memory number will appear next to the “R” symbol in the dis-  
play.  
REGISTRATION  
1
2
3
4
5
MEMORY  
BANK  
ABC FREEZE  
Factory-preset data is provided for all  
registration banks and memory loca-  
tions.  
Complete sets of registration data can  
be saved to and loaded from disk as  
described on page 99.  
Registration Memory number  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registration Memory  
Recall the Registered Panel Settings  
Simply select the appropriate bank as described above, then press the  
desired [REGISTRATION] button at any time to recall the memorized  
settings. The corresponding Registration Memory number will appear  
next to the “R” symbol in the display.  
A pencil (edit) symbol will appear next to the registration number in  
the display as soon as any change is made to the panel settings. In other  
words, if the pencil symbol is showing, the current panel settings are  
different from those stored in the memory.  
Selecting only a different bank will not  
change the registration settings. The  
registration settings are recalled only  
when the [REGISTRATION] button is  
pressed.  
If the Left Pedal function is set to Reg-  
istration+(pages 27 and 93), the left  
pedal can be used to step through the  
registration memory locations so a  
completely different set of panel set-  
tings can be recalled each time the  
pedal is pressed.  
REGISTRATION  
1
2
3
4
5
MEMORY  
BANK  
ABC FREEZE  
Registration Memory number  
edit symbol  
The ABC Freeze Function  
When the ABC FREEZE function is engaged, the accompaniment  
parameters listed above will not be changed when a registration memory  
is recalled. This allows you to recall different registration memory set-  
tings while using Auto Accompaniment, without suddenly disturbing the  
flow of the accompaniment. The ABC FREEZE function is turned on  
and off by pressing the [ABC FREEZE] button. The [ABC FREEZE]  
indicator lights when it is turned on.  
ABC Freeze remains on even if a  
different registration bank is selected.  
REGISTRATION  
1
2
3
4
5
MEMORY  
BANK  
ABC FREEZE  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection &  
Song Playback  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S can play back songs you’ve recorded yourself using  
the song recorder function described in the next section, and songs on optional  
Yamaha Disk Orchestra Collection disks (one is supplied with the Clavinova).  
With Disk Orchestra Collection (“DOC”) disks the Clavinova will let you enjoy  
listening to automated performances, or function as your “private music tutor,”  
allowing you to practice various parts of a piece while the others are played  
automatically.The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S also shows you which keys to play with  
keyboard guide lamps that light up above each key. You can also play “in  
ensemble” with the complete Disk Orchestra Collection arrangement.  
Different displays will appear depending on the type of data being played. But any type of data can be  
played back by following the operation procedure described below. Also refer to the “Playing Other  
Types of Music Data” section on page 71.  
Playback data is not transmitted via the MIDI OUT connector.  
SONG  
PLAY  
RECORD  
GUIDE  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
PLI
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATION  
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
SONG CONTROL  
FF  
REW  
PAUSE  
Straight Playback  
ZEngage the Song Play Mode ................................................................  
The Song Play mode is engaged automatically when a song disk is  
inserted in the disk drive. Insert a disk containing songs you’ve recorded  
yourself or a DOC disk into the disk drive with the sliding door facing  
the drive slot and the label side facing upward. The disk should click into  
place and the disk lamp will light briefly while the Clavinova reads and  
identifies the disk. Once the disk has been identified the SONG PLAY  
[MAIN] display will appear and the [PLAY] button indicator will light.  
If a song disk is already inserted but the Song Play mode is not en-  
gaged, press the [PLAY] button so that its indicator lights and the SONG  
PLAY [MAIN] display (SONG PLAY page 1) appears.  
SONG  
PLAY  
RECORD  
GUIDE  
DOC  
Original song  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
XSelect a Song Number ................................................................................  
If you first select ALLin display page  
1, and then select a song in display  
page 4, all songs will be repeatedly  
played back starting from the selected  
song.  
The current song number and name will be shown on the display  
along with the currently selected tempo. Use the SONGLCD button to  
select the desired song number, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons. Select  
“ALL” if you want all songs on the disk to be played in order and re-  
peated until playback is stopped, or “RANDOM” to play back all songs  
on the disk in random order until playback is stopped.  
If you select a song in display page 1  
or 4, and then select 1 SONG repeat  
mode in page 2, only the selected  
song will be played back repeatedly  
until stopped.  
Selected song  
number and name  
Keyboard voice  
DOC  
Original song  
During Disk Orchestra Collection play-  
back the left- and right-hand voice can  
be changed by using the normal voice  
selection procedure (page 15). In this  
case the selected voice also becomes  
the keyboard voice. The selected  
voice is shown in the SONG PLAY  
page 1 display.  
Another convenient way to select a song for playback is to use the  
PAGE buttons to go to page 4 — SONG PLAY [LIST] — and use the  
data dial or [+]/[–] buttons to select a song from the list that appears on  
the display. Up to 8 song titles are shown on the LCD at a time. If more  
songs are on the disk, the next 8 titles will appear when you scroll past  
the last title shown on the LCD.  
When playing back a song recorded on  
the Clavinova, only the keyboard voice  
can be changed. The keyboard voice  
name is shown in the SONG PLAY  
page 1 display.  
Please note that playback may not  
immediately start while the Clavinova  
is searching the disk for a selected  
song after the START LCD button or  
the panel [START/STOP] button is  
pressed.  
With some songs the displayed meas-  
ure numbers may not match those  
marked on the score.  
Some songs start after a click count-in.  
CStart/Stop Playback .......................................................................................  
The playback tempo can be changed  
freely as required. The preset tempo  
for the selected song can be recalled  
at any time by pressing the TEMPO [+]  
and [] buttons simultaneously.  
Start playback of the selected song by pressing either the START  
LCD button or the panel [START/STOP] button. Unless “ALL” or  
“RANDOM” is selected, the selected song will play through to the end  
and playback will stop automatically. The current measure number and  
tempo will be shown on the display during playback.  
Playback can be stopped at any time by pressing the STOPLCD but-  
ton (the STARTLCD button changes to a STOPbutton once the play-  
back has started) or the panel [START/STOP] button.  
Some Disk Orchestra software does  
not produce a tempo display (e.g. free-  
tempo phrases, etc.). In this case,  
- - -will appear in place of the tempo  
on the display, and the measure num-  
bers shown on the display will not  
match the actual measure numbers of  
the song.  
You can exit from the song play mode by pressing the [PLAY] button  
so that its indicator goes out, or by pressing the [EXIT] button.  
The keyboard guide lamps corre-  
sponding to the keys being played by  
the RIGHT and LEFT part (or PART 1  
and PART 2) will light in real time. The  
keyboard guide lamps can be turned  
off via the LAMP LCD button in SONG  
PLAY display page 3.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
DOC  
Original song  
VEject the Disk When Done.......................................................................  
NEVER eject a disk or turn the power  
off while:  
When you’ve finished with the currently loaded disk, simply press the  
disk drive EJECT button to remove it.  
1. The disk drive lamp is on.  
2. A song is playing.  
Playing Back Specific Parts  
The RIGHT, LEFT, and ORCHLCD buttons (PART 1, PART 2, and OTHERSwhen an original song  
disk is being played) can be used to turn playback of the corresponding parts on or off. The buttons are  
highlighted when the parts are turned on. Use these buttons to select the parts you want to play back. You  
can, for example, turn off the right and/or left-hand parts so you can practice them on the keyboard. When  
an original song disk is being played, the tracks turned on and off by the PART 1and PART 2buttons can  
be specified via the SONG PLAY [PART ASSIGN] display (SONG PLAY page 6), described below. The  
default settings are: PART 1 = Track 1, PART 2 = Track – – (off).  
G Turning Individual Orchestra Parts On or Off  
Normally the ORCH(or OTHERS) LCD button turns all the orchestra  
parts (tracks 3 through 10 and the rhythm tracks), or all parts other  
than parts 1 and 2 on or off at once. You can, however, turn these parts  
When playing back Disklavier  
PianoSoft disks (see Playing Other  
Types of Music Data, page 71) only  
the RIGHT or RIGHT and LEFT LCD  
buttons will appear.  
on or off individually via the SONG PLAY [TRACK PLAY] display  
(SONG PLAY page 5).  
DOC  
Original song  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
ZSelect the TRACK PLAY Page..............................................................  
All track numbers appear whether the  
tracks contain data or not when a  
Standard MIDI file song (see Playing  
Other Types of Music Data, page 71)  
other than the original song is se-  
lected.  
Use the PAGE buttons to select page 5 — the SONG PLAY [TRACK  
PLAY] display. The numbers of tracks which contain data are shown  
above the TRACKLCD buttons. Tracks which are enabled for playback  
are indicated by a box surrounding the track number. Tracks which do  
not contain data appear as dots.  
XMute, Play-enable, or Solo Tracks as Required ...............  
Use the TRACK<and >buttons to select a track (an underline cur-  
sor appears under the selected track). The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons  
can also be used to select tracks. Use the PLAY/OFFbutton to mute  
(turn off) or play-enable the selected track. The track number box disap-  
pears when the track is muted. Any number of tracks can be muted at the  
same time to leave on the tracks you want to hear play-enabled. The  
voice used by the currently selected track is shown above the PLAY/  
OFFbutton.  
Select a track and press and highlight the SOLOLCD button to hear  
only the selected track. Press the SOLOLCD button again to disengage  
the solo function.  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
Part Assignment for Original Song Playback  
Before an original song disk is played, specify the tracks to be turned on and off by the PART 1and  
PART 2LCD buttons via the SONG PLAY [PART ASSIGN] display.  
Use the PAGE buttons to select the SONG PLAY [PART ASSIGN]  
display (SONG PLAY page 6), then use the PART 1and PART 2pa-  
rameters to assign the desired tracks to the corresponding parts. For  
either part the corresponding G and G buttons can be used to select a  
The [PART ASSIGN] display will not  
appear when Disk Orchestra Collection  
or Disklavier data (see Playing Other  
Types of Music Data, page 71) is  
being played.  
track, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons can be used once the parameter is  
selected.  
The default settings are: PART 1 = Track 1, PART 2 = Track – – (off).  
Tracks 1 through 16 can be selected for both parts 1 and 2, and part 2 can  
additionally be turned off. The same track cannot be assigned to both  
parts.  
Overall Song Playback Volume Control  
The ABC/SONG VOLUME control can be used to control the over-  
all volume of song playback. Whenever a song is first selected, however,  
the maximum volume setting (=standard volume level setting) is recalled  
regardless of the position of the ABC/SONG VOLUME control. The  
If ABC is turned on during the playback  
of an original song that was recorded  
without ABC, the ABC/SONG VOL-  
UME control will affect the ABC sound  
rather than the song playback sound.  
song playback volume can then be adjusted as required.  
ABC cannot be used during playback  
of a song recorded with ABC or Disk  
VOLUME  
Orchestra Collection playback.  
MASTER  
VOLUME  
ABC/SONG  
VOLUME  
MAX  
MAX  
MIN  
MIN  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
Individual Part Volume Control & Voice Selection  
Press the [MIXER] button while in the Song Play mode to access the song playback volume param-  
eters, and the voice selection parameter for the left- and right-hand voice when a Disk Orchestra Collection  
disk is being played. The MIXER display will disappear when the [MIXER] button is pressed a second  
time, or when the [EXIT] button is pressed.  
G Disk Orchestra Collection Disk Playback ..............................  
When playing back Disklavier  
PianoSoft disks (see Playing Other  
Types of Music Data, page 71) only  
During Disk Orchestra Collection playback the MIXER display has  
two pages. Page 1 includes the L&Rvolume and L&R VOICEparam-  
the L&R VOICE LCD buttons will ap-  
pear.  
eters. Use the L&RLCD button — or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons  
once the L&Rparameter has been selected — to set the volume of the  
left- and right-hand voice. Use the L&R VOICEG and G LCD buttons  
The voice change for the left- and  
right-hand parts by this operation does  
or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons once the L&R VOICEparameter has  
been selected to select the voice used for the left- and right-hand parts.  
not affect the keyboard voice. But if  
you press the panel [VOICE] button,  
the result will be both the keyboard  
voice and the left- and right-hand part  
voice being changed simultaneously.  
Page 2 of the MIXER display includes independent volume parameters  
for the RHYTHM, BASS, ORCH(orchestra), and KBD(keyboard) parts,  
and a PRESETLCD button that resets all volume parameters to “100”.  
Any of the volume parameters can be selected and incremented by using  
the corresponding LCD button, or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons can be  
used to increment or decrement the currently selected volume parameter.  
Press the [+] and [–] buttons simultaneously to recall the default (“100”)  
volume setting. Several parts can be selected at once by pressing the cor-  
responding LCD buttons at the same time. The volume of all selected  
parts can then be adjusted simultaneously.  
When a different song is selected the  
voice and volume settings will be reset  
to the default settings.  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
G Original Song Disk Playback ...............................................................  
If ABC is turned on during the playback  
of an original song that was recorded  
without ABC, the MIXER display will  
function as the ABC part volume con-  
trol rather than the song part volume  
control.  
During original song disk playback the MIXER display has 5 pages.  
The first four pages include independent volume parameters for each of  
the 16 song tracks. Page five includes the KBD(keyboard) volume pa-  
rameter and a PRESETLCD button. The volume parameters are adjusted  
in the same way as described above.  
Guided Right- and Left-hand Practice  
With this feature, the Clavinova indicates the notes to play via the keyboard guide lamps and waits for  
you to play the appropriate keys before playing ahead, so you can learn to play the piece at your own pace.  
The guide lamps can be turned on or off as required. Two guide modes are provided:  
When playing back the internal RAM  
G Next Note:  
data (see Recording Without a Disk,  
page 89) or the Standard MIDI File  
format 1 data (see Playing Other  
Types of Music Data, below) - - -will  
In this mode the guide lamps of the Clavinova indicate in advance,  
which note(s) you will have to play next. If you miss the correct tim-  
appear in the GUIDE MODE param-  
eter location and only the current notes  
you play the correct keys. Only then the guide lamp(s) for the next  
to be played will be shown on the  
ing, the lamp(s) will start to flash while the Clavinova will wait until  
note(s) will light up and you can quickly move your hands to the cor-  
responding area on the keyboard. This is the default guide mode.  
keyboard guide lamps i.e. the next  
noteswill not appear.  
The GUIDE MODE cannot be changed  
during playback.  
G Sound:  
When the DOC song recorded for the  
special guide mode is selected, the  
proper notes. In the Sound mode the Clavinova will play ahead for  
special guide mode for that song will  
Both the keyboard guide lamps and sound are used to guide you to the  
approximately one phrase and then wait until the appropriate notes, as  
indicated by the keyboard guide lamps, are played. If the appropriate  
notes are not played for a few seconds, the Clavinova will automati-  
be automatically engaged in this  
case neither of the NEXT NOTE or  
SOUND sections will be highlighted.  
But you can re-select the NEXT NOTE  
or SOUND mode by pressing the  
cally play and repeat the phrase until it is played properly. This is an  
corresponding LCD button. (The NEXT  
excellent way to learn to associate the keys with the notes they pro-  
NOTE or SOUND mode cannot be re-  
duce.  
selected when not at the beginning of  
a song or when the PHRASE REPEAT  
or A-B REPEAT mode (page 69) is  
engaged.)  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
The GUIDE display appears automatically when the [GUIDE] button  
is pressed to turn the guide function on. If the guide function is already  
on, the PAGE buttons can be used to select the SONG PLAY [GUIDE]  
display (SONG PLAY page 3). Use the GUIDE MODE NEXT NOTEor  
SOUNDLCD button to select the desired guide mode. The settings of  
the RIGHTand LEFTLCD buttons (or PART 1and PART 2) in the  
SONG PLAY [MAIN] display (SONG PLAY page 1) will then deter-  
mine whether the guide function operates for the left-hand part (part 2)  
only, the right-hand part (part 1) only, or both parts, as shown below.  
When the guide function is turned off  
(i.e. the [GUIDE] button indicator is off)  
and the SOUND mode is selected, the  
guide lamps light in real time corre-  
sponding to the notes played by the  
left- and right-hand parts, when both  
the left- and right-hand parts are either  
on or off.  
If one or the other of the parts is off,  
the guide lamps correspond only to the  
part that is turned off.  
When the guide function is turned off  
and the NEXT NOTE mode is se-  
lected, both the current (flashing) and  
next notes (continuously-lit) are shown  
by the guide lamps if either or both  
parts are turned off. (If both parts are  
turned on, only the current notes are  
shown by the guide lamps.)  
SONG  
PLAY  
RECORD  
GUIDE  
The guide part can be selected, the  
guide LAMP can be turned on and off,  
and the guide function itself can be  
turned on and off during playback.  
Left- and right-hand guide  
Right-hand guide only  
Left-hand guide only  
Playback tempo can be set to any  
desired value after a song has been  
selected by using the TEMPO [+] and  
[] buttons.  
The positions of the guide lamps do  
not change if the transpose function is  
used to transpose the pitch of the  
keyboard.  
When you press the [START/STOP] button or the STARTLCD but-  
ton in the SONG PLAY [MAIN] display (SONG PLAY page 1) to begin  
playback, the introduction will play automatically but then the Clavinova  
will stop and wait for you to play the correct note(s). The CVP-79A/69/  
69A/59S indicates the key(s) to be played via the guide lamps above the  
keyboard. As you play the appropriate notes, the piece will continue,  
pausing until you play the right notes each time.  
The [oPAUSE], [rREW] and [fFF]  
buttons will not operate during play-  
back when the guide function is in use.  
The guide function may not work prop-  
erly with software which was not pro-  
duced for independent left- and right-  
hand playback.  
Since the guide phrasesused in the  
SOUND mode are automatically deter-  
mined by the Clavinova, they may not  
precisely match the actual musical  
phrases. Also, the phrases may be-  
come shorter when the guide function  
is used for both the left- and right-hand  
parts.  
If the guide lamps flashing above the keyboard distract you, or you  
want to try playing along without them, simply press the LAMPLCD  
button in the SONG PLAY [GUIDE] display to turn the lamps “OFF”.  
Repeat to turn the guide lamps back on.  
As with regular playback, the song will stop automatically when the  
end is reached, or it can be stopped at any time by pressing the STOP  
LCD button in the SONG PLAY [MAIN] display (SONG PLAY page 1)  
or the panel [START/STOP] button.  
Press the [GUIDE] button so that its indicator goes out when you  
want to turn the guide function off.  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
Repeat Functions  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S has a range of repeat functions that can be useful aids for learning to play diffi-  
cult passages. The repeat modes are all accessible via the SONG PLAY [REPEAT] display (SONG PLAY  
page 2). Use the REPEAT MODEG and G LCD buttons, the data dial, or the [+]/[–] buttons to select the  
desired repeat mode: OFF, PHRASE, 1 SONG, or A-B REPEAT.  
G Phrase Repeat (Disk Orchestra Collection only) ...........  
The ALL or RANDOM playback mode  
(SONG PLAY [MAIN] display) will be  
Use this function if you want to practice a specific phrase within a  
disengaged when any of the repeat  
modes is selected.  
song, as indicated by the phrase marks on the Disk Orchestra Collection  
score.  
Any previously set repeat mode will be  
reset to OFF when a different song  
When the PHRASE repeat mode is selected the PHRASEparameter  
will appear on the display. Use the PHRASEG and G LCD buttons, or  
the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons once the PHRASEparameter is selected,  
to select the desired phrase number (refer to the Disk Orchestra Collec-  
tion book that comes with the Disk Orchestra Collection disk). Playback  
can be started and stopped as described above.  
number is selected.  
G 1 Song Repeat......................................................................................................  
When the 1 SONG mode is selected, any song selected and played as  
described above will play repeatedly until stopped by pressing either the  
STOPLCD button in the SONG PLAY [MAIN] display or the panel  
[START/STOP] button.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
G A-B Repeat...............................................................................................................  
The specified A-B repeat points will be  
erased when a new song number or  
another repeat mode is selected.  
This function allows you to specify any section of a song for continu-  
ous repeat playback.  
When the A-B REPEAT mode is selected, A— and Bpoint entry but-  
>
A 1-measure count-in will normally be  
produced when phrase or A-B repeat  
playback is started. A count-in will not  
be produced for songs that do not  
contain a rhythm track.  
tons will appear on the display. While the song is playing, press the A—  
>
button once at the beginning of the section to be repeated and then press  
the Bbutton at the end of the section to be repeated. Repeat playback  
will begin automatically from the A point as soon as the B point has been  
specified. The programmed A and B points are retained until a different  
song number or a different repeat mode is selected, and the A-B repeat  
playback can be started and stopped again by using the [START/STOP]  
button.  
A count-in will not be produced in the 1  
SONG repeat playback mode.  
When both the A and B points are  
specified, pressing the B button clears  
the B point only resulting in repeat  
playback between the A point and the  
end of the song. Pressing the A button  
clears both the A and B points.  
Other Playback Controls  
G Pause .............................................................................................................................  
Press the [oPAUSE] button to temporarily stop song playback. Press  
the [oPAUSE] button again (or the [START/STOP] button or START  
LCD button in page 1) to resume playback from the same point.  
SONG CONTROL  
REW  
FF  
PAUSE  
G Rewind and fast Forward .........................................................................  
During song playback the [rREW] and [fFF] buttons function  
as follows:  
SONG CONTROL  
REW  
FF  
PAUSE  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback  
G While playback is stopped or paused the [rREW] and [fFF]  
buttons can be used to step backward or forward through the song a  
measure at a time. Either button can also be held for continuous step-  
ping in the specified direction.  
The [r REW], [f FF], and [o  
PAUSE] buttons do not function when  
playing with the guide function.  
Using the [r REW] button may cause  
the voice, tempo, and/or volume to  
change.  
G During playback the [rREW] and [fFF] buttons allow you to  
move rapidly in the specified direction for as long as the button is  
held. No sound is produced during [rREW] operation.  
Playing Other Types of Music Data  
In addition to original songs and Disk Orchestra Collection disks, the  
Clavinova can also play back Yamaha Disklavier PianoSoft™ disks,  
disks containing Yamaha ESEQ format sequence data, and disks contain-  
ing songs recorded in Standard MIDI File format (SMF formats 0 and  
1).  
The Clavinova’s internal tone generator is compatible with the GM  
System Level 1 voice allocation as well as the Yamaha DOC voice allo-  
cation.  
The [r REW] and [f FF] buttons do  
not function with SMF format 1 data.  
Yamaha ESEQ data recorded on other  
Clavinovas (CVP- 55/65/75/83S/85A/  
87A/89) will normally be played back  
with the correct voices. It may be  
necessary, however, to change the  
voice numbers of the data to conform  
to the CVP 79A/69/69A/59S voice  
allocation when other types of data are  
played back.  
Regardless of the type of software,  
only the following disk formats can be  
used: 3.5" 2DD 720 kilobyte format;  
3.5" 2HD 1.44 megabyte format.  
The SONG PLAY [MAIN] (page 1),  
[TRACK PLAY] (page 5), and MIXER  
displays differ depending on the type  
of data being played. The [PART AS-  
SIGN] display (page 6) will not appear  
when Disk Orchestra Collection or  
Disklavier data is being played.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S features a built-in “sequencer” which can be used to  
independently record up to 16 separate parts of a single musical composition.  
Each part is recorded on a separate song “track”.The music data that you record  
is stored on a 3.5" floppy disk loaded into the Clavinova’s disk drive unit. Up to  
approximately 60 songs can be recorded on a single disk, depending on the  
amount of data contained in each song. Before you can record, however, you  
must “format” a new disk, as described on page 98.  
A number of confirmation, information, prompt, alert, and error displays may appear during operation.  
See the “MESSAGES” on page 110 if you need more details on any of these messages.  
The Clavinova records data using the SMF format 0 and the Clavinovas internal voices which include GM  
system level 1 compatible voice assignments.  
SONG  
PLAY  
RECORD  
GUIDE  
VOLUME  
MASTER ABC/SONG  
STYLE  
ROCK  
SONG  
RECORD  
VOICE  
CONTRAST  
D
ANCE  
CLAVI. TONE/  
YNTH  
PLAY  
GUIDE  
PIANO  
E. PIANO  
HARPSI.  
BRASS  
VIBES  
GUITAR  
S
DUAL  
SPLIT  
EFFECT  
DEMO/HELP  
POP  
1
6BEA  
T
POP  
BALLAD  
JAZZ  
HARMONY  
TEMPO  
+
V
O
L
U
M
E
V
O
L
U
M
E
BEAT  
METRONOME  
PRESET  
MAX  
MAX  
ONE TOUCH  
SETTING  
S
TRINGS/  
SAX/  
FLUTE  
DRUMS/  
PERC.  
LATIN  
POP  
TRADI-  
TIONAL  
ORGAN  
CHOIR  
BASS  
LATIN  
COUNTRY  
WALTZ  
DISK  
FUNCTION MIXER  
CUSTOM  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
MAIN ENDING  
START/STOP  
YNCHRO  
INTRO A/  
INTRO B/  
SMALL  
ABC  
SONG CONTROL  
FF AUSE  
REGISTRATIO
REVERB  
FILL TO  
A
FILL  
TO  
B
MAIN  
A
B
ABC ON  
TAP  
S
START/STOP  
PAGE  
DISPLAY  
HOLD  
EXIT  
+
MEMORY  
BANK  
1
2
3
4
5
ABC FREEZE  
MIN  
MIN  
REW  
P
SONG CONTROL  
FF  
REW  
PAUSE  
Quick Recording  
ZInsert a Formatted Disk .............................................................................  
If you insert an unformatted disk, Start  
disk format?will appear on the dis-  
play. Press OK to format the disk or  
CANCEL to abort.  
If you haven’t already done so, make sure that a properly formatted  
disk is loaded into the Clavinova disk drive (see page 98), and that the  
disk’s write protect tab is set to the “write” position (tab closed).  
Protected disks (DOC, etc.) cannot be  
formatted.  
Write protect tab  
closed (unlocked  
— write enabled)  
XEngage the Record Mode ........................................................................  
Press the [RECORD] button so that its indicator lights and the  
QUICK RECORD display appears. If the [RECORD] indicator is lit but  
the QUICK RECORD display is not showing, use the PAGE buttons to  
locate it (RECORD display page 1).  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
SONG  
PLAY  
RECORD  
GUIDE  
CSelect a Song Number ................................................................................  
If a song name appears along with the  
song number, the selected song al-  
ready contains data.  
Use the SONGG and G buttons, the data dial, or the [+]/[–] buttons  
to select a SONG NUMBER between 1 and 60 for the piece you are  
about to record (up to 60 different songs, each with a different song  
number, can be recorded on a single disk). Make sure the song number  
you select has not already been used for a song previously recorded on  
the disk you are using.  
VSet the Track Modes as Required...................................................  
Two tracks (actually one track and a track group) are available for  
quick recording: KBD(keyboard) and ABC&RHY(ABC & rhythm).  
When the QUICK RECORD mode is first selected and a song that does  
not already contain data is selected, the KBD (keyboard) track will be set  
to REC and the ABC&RHY track will be set to OFF. In this state the  
Clavinova is ready to record the keyboard track only. If you also want to  
record rhythm and ABC accompaniment, use the ABC&RHYLCD but-  
ton to set the ABC&RHY track to REC, or press the panel [ABC ON]  
button.  
If ABC is already on when the record  
mode is engaged, the ABC&RHY track  
will automatically be set to REC.  
Harmony data can be recorded by  
turning the HARMONY mode on. Also,  
Dual or Split voices can be recorded  
by engaging the Dual or Split mode. (In  
this case the KBD part uses two  
tracks.)  
When the ABC&RHY track is set to  
REC, or when the KBD track is set to  
RECand the ABC&RHY track is set  
to PLAY, the metronome will sound  
to provide a timing guide in the syn-  
chronized start mode before recording  
is started  
When any track is set to REC, the  
amount of disk space available for  
recording will appear next to the tempo  
display (in approximate kilobytes). An  
empty 2DD/2HD disk should have  
about 696KB/1407KB (room enough  
for about 50,000/100,000 notes if no  
other data is recorded) respectively.  
When recording is started this display  
is replaced by the measure number  
display.  
If you select a song that already contains data, the track(s) which con-  
tains data can be set to PLAY. This lets you record a new track while  
listening to previously-recorded material. If you don’t want to hear a  
previously-recorded track while recording, simply use the corresponding  
LCD button to turn it OFF.  
REC mode cannot be selected if the  
current song position is not the begin-  
ning of the song e.g. the [r REW]  
and [fFF] buttons have been used to  
change the song position.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
BSelect a Voice ........................................................................................................  
Use the VOICE selectors and displays to select the voice you want to  
record with.  
If you will be recording the ABC&RHY tracks you can also select a  
style.  
If you want to try out the selected voice  
on the keyboard before proceeding —  
turn the synchro-start mode off so that  
recording doesnt start automatically as  
soon as you play on the keyboard.  
NStart Recording...................................................................................................  
Play on the keyboard. Recording will begin automatically as soon as  
you start playing (the synchro start mode is automatically selected when  
the QUICK RECORD mode is engaged — but it can be disengaged as  
required). You can also start recording by pressing the panel [START/  
STOP] button.  
The Clavinova may continue to write  
data to the disk for a short time after  
you stop recording. DO NOT eject the  
disk while the disk drive indicator is lit  
or flashing.  
MStop Recording...................................................................................................  
You can enter a name for the recorded  
song, as described on page 87. (When  
a song has been recorded, a tempo-  
rary name SONG_XXX.MID(XXX is  
the song number) will be given to the  
song automatically.)  
Stop recording by pressing the [START/STOP] button. When record-  
ing has finished and the recorded data has been written to disk, the mode  
of the recorded track will automatically switch to PLAY, indicating that  
the track is ready for playback.  
During recording the [ABC/SONG]  
volume control and the MIXER display  
will function as the recorded ABC and/  
or keyboard part volume control.  
New data cannot be recorded to songs  
recorded on other instruments, also  
any edit in the record mode is not  
possible.  
<Play Back the Recording ..........................................................................  
Press the [START/STOP] button to play back your recording. Play  
along on the keyboard if you like. During playback you can use the [o  
PAUSE], [rREW], and [f FF] buttons, as described on page 70.  
You can also change the playback tempo via the TEMPO [+] and [–]  
buttons.  
Playback will stop automatically when the end of the recording is  
reached, or you can press the [START/STOP] button to stop it at  
anytime.  
The guide lamps do not light during  
recording.  
[ABC ON] and/or [HARMONY] button  
indicator(s) automatically go out when  
the recording of these parts has fin-  
ished.  
When recording has finished, the  
[EFFECT] is automatically turned off  
(but the recorded effect remains ac-  
tive).  
Press the [RECORD] button so that its indicator goes out, or the  
[EXIT] button, to exit from the QUICK RECORD mode.  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
Multi-track Recording & Playback  
ZInsert a Formatted Disk, Engage the Record Mode &  
Select a Song ........................................................................................................  
The first three steps in the multi-track recording process are exactly  
the same as those for quick recording: insert a formatted disk, press the  
[RECORD] button to engage the record mode, and select a song number  
— see steps 1, 2, and 3, above.  
XSelect the TRACK RECORD Page ..................................................  
Use the PAGE buttons to select the TRACK RECORD page  
(RECORD display page 2). The status of each track is shown above the  
TRACKLCD buttons. Tracks which are enabled for playback are indi-  
cated by a box surrounding the track number, and tracks which are  
record-enabled are indicated by a filled box and inverse number. Tracks  
which do not contain data appear as dots.  
CSet The Track Modes as Required .................................................  
Use the TRACK<and >buttons to select a track (an underline cur-  
sor appears under the selected track). The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons  
can also be used to select tracks. Use the REC/PLAY/OFFLCD button  
to record-enable, play-enable, or turn off (mute) the selected track. Only  
tracks which contain data can be play-enabled. The track number box  
disappears when the track is muted.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
In the normal single-voice play mode only one track needs to be  
record-enabled at a time in order to record the keyboard part. If you in-  
tend to record using the DUAL or SPLIT mode, however, two tracks  
must be record-enabled — only one or two tracks can be record-enabled  
at a time to record the keyboard part. If ABC accompaniment is turned  
on tracks 9 through 16 are automatically record-enabled (these are the  
tracks on which the ABC data is recorded). If the HARMONY function  
is engaged tracks 6 through 8 are automatically record-enabled (tracks 6  
through 8 are used to record the harmony data).  
The TRACKfLCD button can also be used to select the RHYTHM  
tracks (9 and 10) if you only want to record the rhythm sound. The cur-  
sors appear under the 9 and 10 tracks, and the REC/PLAY/OFFLCD  
button can be used to set them to record-enabled.  
Two tracks can be record-enabled only  
when the DUAL or SPLIT mode is ON,  
otherwise only one track can be  
record-enabled.  
Track 10 (and 9 in some case) can  
only be used to record the internal  
rhythm sound and cannot be used to  
record the keyboard part. Also, the  
keyboard part should be recorded on a  
track other than those used for ABC,  
RHYTHM, and HARMONY.  
When the RHYTHM, ABC, and/or  
HARMONY tracks are set to record-  
enabled, the synchronized start mode  
is automatically turned on.  
When the RHYTHM tracks (9 and 10)  
are set to record-enabled, or set to  
play-enabled and other track(s) are set  
to record-enabled, the metronome will  
sound to provide a timing guide in the  
synchronized start mode before re-  
cording is started.  
VSet All Performance Features As Required .........................  
After setting the tracks to be recorded to the record-enable mode, set  
up all necessary performance features as required: voice, voice mode  
(normal, dual, or split), style, tempo, etc.  
BStart Recording...................................................................................................  
If ABC and/or HARMONY is already on  
when the multi-track recording mode is  
engaged, the corresponding tracks are  
automatically record-enabled and the  
synchronized start mode is automati-  
cally turned ON.  
Unlike the QUICK RECORD mode the synchronized start mode is  
automatically turned OFF when the multi-track recording mode is en-  
gaged. You can, however, engage the synchro start mode at this point so  
that recording will begin automatically as soon as any key on the key-  
board is pressed. Otherwise press the [START/STOP] button to start  
recording on the specified track(s). The current measure number is  
shown on the display as you record.  
The following parameters will be recorded in addition to notes you  
play:  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
Parameters recorded for Each Track  
Parameters Recorded for the Entire Song  
• Notes  
• Damper pedal  
• Soft pedal  
• Tempo  
• Style  
• Voice  
• Reverb type  
• Reverb depth  
• Effect type*  
• Main A/B  
• Intro  
• Volume (initially maximum)  
• Expression (CVP-79A only)  
• Pan  
• Sostenuto pedal  
• Reverb depth  
• Effect depth  
• Fill-in  
• Ending  
* The last recorded track effect takes priority.  
Other Recorded Parameters  
• Accompaniment data is distributed to the appropriate  
tracks. Accompaniment data which is recorded but  
not listed above includes:  
• Harmony data is distributed to the appropriate  
tracks.  
• DUAL mode voices are recorded on the two as-  
signed tracks.  
* Individual part volume  
* Modulation  
• SPLIT mode voices are recorded on the two as-  
signed tracks.  
* Pitch bend  
* Pitch bend sensitivity  
NStop Recording...................................................................................................  
If you have recorded using a preset  
style on RHYTHM tracks 9 and 10, a  
box symbol will appear next to the  
RHYTHMcharacter in the display.  
Press the [START/STOP] button to stop recording.  
Adding New Tracks  
Recorded tracks are automatically switched to the play mode when  
recording is stopped, so you can play back the recorded data simply by  
pressing the [START/STOP] button, or add a new track to your song by  
selecting a new record track(s) and voice(s) and recording as described  
above.  
If you record on a track that has al-  
ready been recorded, the previous  
material will be erased and the new  
material will be recorded in its place.  
Press the [RECORD] button so that its indicator goes out, or the  
[EXIT] button, to exit from the multi-track recording mode.  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
Punch-in/out Recording  
“Punch-in/out recording” allows you to start recording from any “punch-in” point within a previously-  
recorded track and stop recording at any “punch -out” point, leaving all recorded material up to the punch-  
in point and following the punch-out point intact. The punch-in recording controls are accessed via the  
RECORD [PUNCH IN/OUT] display (RECORD display page 3).  
ZPlay the Song........................................................................................................  
The Punch-in/out recording function  
cannot be used when no disk is in the  
drive.  
Play back the song in order to locate the point you want to punch-in  
from.  
START/STOP  
[f FF] or [r REW] buttons cannot  
be used while in the [PUNCH IN/OUT]  
display.  
TAP  
SYNCHRO  
START/STOP  
XPause Before the Punch-in Point....................................................  
Press the [oPAUSE] button to pause playback a bit before the point  
at which you want to start recording. Leave a measure or more before the  
punch-in point so you’ll be able to grasp the timing for the punch in.  
SONG CONTROL  
REW  
FF  
PAUSE  
CSelect a Track .......................................................................................................  
Only tracks which allow punch-in/out  
recording will appear and can be se-  
lected. The RHYTHM, ABC, HAR-  
MONY, and unrecorded tracks cannot  
be selected.  
Use the TRACKG and G LCD buttons or the data dial or [+]/[–]  
buttons to the select the track to be recorded on. The voice used in the  
selected track will be shown on the display.  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
VSelect a Punch-in Mode.............................................................................  
When the PEDAL punch-in mode is  
selected, the left pedal is used for this  
function only (the usual pedal function  
is canceled).  
Use the MODELCD button to select the 1ST KEY or PEDAL punch-  
in mode.  
1ST KEY  
PEDAL  
Recording will begin with the first key played after the PUNCH  
IN LCD button is pressed.  
Recording will begin when the left pedal is pressed after the  
PUNCH IN LCD button is pressed.  
BEngage the Punch-in Record Ready Mode ..........................  
Press the PUNCH INLCD button to engage the punch-in record  
ready mode — the PUNCH INbutton will be highlighted.  
When the PEDAL punch-in mode is  
selected:  
Recording can be started directly by  
pressing the left pedal while playback  
is paused (without first pressing the  
[START/STOP] or [PAUSE] button).  
Recording can also be stopped by  
pressing the left pedal. In this case the  
data following the punch-out point will  
be left active.  
If you start recording by pressing the  
left pedal while playback is paused,  
and stop by the [START/STOP] button,  
the result will be that all the data after  
the punch-in point will be erased. (If  
you stop by using the PUNCH OUT  
LCD button or the left pedal, only the  
data between the punch-in and punch-  
out points will be erased.)  
NStart Playback & Recording..................................................................  
Press the [START/STOP] or [oPAUSE] button to start playback  
from the current pause location, then, if the 1ST KEY mode is selected,  
begin playing at the point you want to record from. Recording will begin  
as soon as you begin playing on the keyboard. If the PEDAL mode is  
selected press the left pedal at the point you want to record from.  
MStop Recording...................................................................................................  
If you press the [START/STOP] button  
or [oPAUSE] button to start recording,  
and the [START/STOP] button or the  
PUNCH OUT LCD button to stop  
recording without actually recording  
anything in between, the original data  
will be left untouched.  
Press the PUNCH OUTLCD button to stop recording at the point at  
which you want to “punch out”, leaving all data following the punch-out  
point intact. Use the panel [START/STOP] button to stop recording if  
you want all data following the punch-out point to be erased.  
Press the [RECORD] button so that its indicator goes out, or the  
[EXIT] button, to exit from the punch-in/out record mode.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
The Chord Sequence Function  
The CHORD SEQUENCE function provides a convenient way to enter chord sequences and style  
changes one at a time.  
ZEngage the Chord Sequence Function ....................................  
The chord Sequence function cannot  
be used when no disk is in the disk  
drive.  
After engaging the QUICK RECORD mode (RECORD display page  
1) and selecting a song number, press the CHORD SEQ.LCD button.  
The CHORD SEQUENCE display will appear, ABC will be turned on,  
The chord sequence data will replace  
any previous data on the ABC and  
rhythm tracks that was recorded in the  
quick record or multi-track record  
and if the FULL KEYBOARD mode is currently selected the FIN-  
GERED CHORD mode will be selected instead.  
modes.  
Up to 999 measures can be recorded  
using the Chord Sequence function.  
The chord input resolution will be  
automatically selected according to the  
current style. For 3/4, 4/4, and 5/4 time  
styles, one chord can be entered on  
every 8th note or 8th-note triplet. For  
other time signatures one chord can be  
entered for each measure.  
One style change or section change  
(except Fill-in and Break) can be made  
at the beginning of each measure. —  
The Button not valid! Enter at top of  
measure.alert display will appear if  
you attempt to enter the change in any  
other place than the top of measure.  
XMove the Cursor To the Entry Point..............................................  
ABC cannot be turned off after the  
chord sequence function is engaged.  
But the ABC mode can be altered  
between FINGERED and SINGLE-  
As necessary, use the CURSOR<and >LCD buttons to move the  
triangular cursor to the point at which you want to enter a chord or style  
change.  
FINGER in the pop-up display by  
pressing the [ABC ON] button. The  
split point can also be altered.  
If you enter the ABC part volume data  
via the MIXER display and the SET  
LCD button, the volume event symbol  
will appear in the box on the right side  
of the LCD display. (The volume event  
is automatically entered at the begin-  
ning of a song.)  
CEnter and Set the Chords and/or Style Changes...........  
To enter a chord either play the chord on the ABC section of the key-  
board according to the current ABC mode, or use the ROOTand TYPE  
LCD buttons. The data dial or [+]/[–] buttons can be used to select the  
ROOT or TYPE once the corresponding parameter has been selected by  
pressing its LCD button. When a chord is entered via the keyboard the  
appropriate root and type appear in the corresponding parameter loca-  
tions. To enter a style change (style, section, and tempo) simply make the  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
appropriate selections in the normal way. Once the chord and/or style  
change has been entered, press the SET LCD button to actually input  
the chord and/or style change at the current cursor location. The loca-  
tion in the graphic measure symbol will become bold and the set data  
will be shown on the display: the time signature, the style name and  
section to the left, and the chord, tempo, and rhythm on/off status (see  
below) in the box to the right.  
Continue entering chords and style changes in this manner until  
your sequence is complete. The data recorded by the Chord Sequence  
function is listed below.  
The types of chords that can be entered are  
the same as those listed for the ABC fin-  
gered mode (see page 36). In addition - - -”  
(i.e. no chord) can be entered via the TYPE  
LCD button.  
On-bass chords can be entered via the  
keyboard.  
The number of each measure is shown to  
the left of the graphic measure symbols on  
the display.  
See Chord Sequence Page-2 Functions,  
below, for other useful editing features.  
If no chords are entered (i.e. chord type is  
set to - - -), the result will be a rhythm-only  
sequence.  
Data Recorded By the Chord Sequence Function  
• Style  
A Breakcan be produced by both setting  
the chord type to - - -and rhythm sound to  
OFF(see Rhythm OFF/ON, below).  
• Accompaniment Section (MAIN A & B/Intro/Ending/Fill-in/Break)  
• Chord  
The same chord, as set previously (i.e. the  
same chord shown in the box), cannot be  
entered even if the SET LCD button is  
pressed.  
• ABC part volume (MIXER settings)  
• Tempo  
• Rhythm on/off  
• ABC/SONG volume (as an initial setting only)  
Only data other than chord data can be  
entered by first moving the cursor and  
making the required changes without enter-  
ing any chord (the ROOT and TYPE LCD  
sections should be blank), and pressing the  
SET LCD button.  
If a different style with another time signa-  
ture is selected after chords have been  
entered, the timing of the chords will be  
changed accordingly.  
VStop Recording.............................................................................................  
When all the required chords and style changes have been entered,  
enter an END MARK(press END MARKin display page 2), then  
press the ENDbutton in display page 3. The “Are You Sure?”  
confirmation prompt will appear. Press YESto save the recorded data  
and finish recording or NOto abort. Once the data has been saved, the  
Chord Sequence function will automatically be exited.  
It is also possible to leave the Chord Sequence function during  
recording by pressing the [EXIT] button, or the [RECORD] button  
so that its indicator goes out. In this case, if any data is left unsaved,  
the “Save recorded data?” confirmation prompt will appear.  
Press YESto save the recorded data and then exit from the Chord  
Sequence function, NOto exit without saving the data, or CANCEL  
to return to the Chord Sequence function.  
The chord sequence data now resides in  
tracks 9 through 16, and can be played  
back in the normal way. Add other tracks as  
required by using the standard track selec-  
tion and recording procedure. You can also  
record over individual tracks of the se-  
quence and replace them with original  
material if you like by using the standard  
track selection and record procedure.  
The song recorded via the Chord Sequence  
function can be modified later by re-enter-  
ing the Chord Sequence mode and making  
the required changes. But please note that  
the track data recorded over by using the  
standard recording procedure will be re-  
turned back to the preset style data.  
Chord Sequence Page 2 & 3 Functions  
The CHORD SEQUENCE page-2 and page-3 displays contain a number of functions that can make the  
chord-entering process more efficient and versatile.  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
G Delete  
Press the DELETELCD button to delete the data at the current cursor  
location. The “Are you sure?” confirmation prompt will appear.  
Press YESto delete or CANCELto abort.  
G End Mark  
Press the END MARKLCD button to enter an “end mark” at the cur-  
rent cursor location. An END MARK signifies the end of the song,  
and should always be entered to properly end each song. The cursor  
can not be moved past an end mark. An end mark can be deleted us-  
ing the DELETELCD button, above.  
Unless the end mark is entered, the  
song will end at one measure after the  
last data, or at the end of the ending  
section if it is entered.  
The end mark symbol will appear in  
the box on the right side of the LCD  
display when it is entered.  
G Rhythm OFF/ON  
Pressing the RHYTHM OFFLCD button turns the rhythm sound off  
— i.e. the start of a rhythm break — from the current cursor location.  
This button has no effect if the rhythm is already off.  
The RHYTHM ONLCD button turns the rhythm back on after a  
rhythm break. This button has no effect if the rhythm is already on.  
The rhythm on/off status is shown in  
the box to the right on the LCD display.  
G All Delete  
When the ALL DELETELCD button is pressed the “Are you  
sure?” confirmation display will appear. Press YESto erase all  
chord and style change data, or NOto abort.  
G Check Play  
The CHECK PLAYLCD button starts playback of the programmed  
chord sequence. The sequence will play through until the end of the  
data is reached or until the CHECK PLAYLCD button is pressed a  
second time.  
G End  
Pressing the ENDLCD button initiates final processing of the se-  
quence data and saves it to the disk. The “Are you sure?” confir-  
mation prompt will appear: press YESto save it to disk and finish  
recording the chord sequence or NOto abort. Once the data has been  
processed and saved to disk the Chord Sequence mode is automati-  
cally exited.  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
Other Song Recording Functions  
Track Mix, Track Delete, Track Quantize, Initial Edit, and Rename functions,  
described below, cannot be used when no disk is in the disk drive.  
Track Mix  
The TRACK MIX function combines the data from two specified tracks and places the result in a third  
specified track. The TRACK MIX function is accessed via the RECORD [TRACK MIX] display  
(RECORD display page 4).  
ZSpecify the Tracks to be Mixed ..........................................................  
Only the data-containing tracks will  
Use the TRK Aand TRK BLCD buttons — or the data dial or [+]/[–]  
appear and can be selected for TRK A  
buttons once the TRK Aor TRK Bparameter has been selected — to  
specify the tracks you want to mix. The initial voices used for the A and  
B tracks are shown along with the track number.  
and B. In addition no track(- -) can  
also be selected for TRK B. In this  
case the result will be the copy of TRK  
A to TRK C.  
The initial data and all data other than  
note data is taken from that of track A.  
XSpecify the Destination Track.............................................................  
Use the TRK CLCD button — or the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons once  
the TRK Cparameter has been selected — to specify the track you want  
the mixed data to be placed in. Any previous data in the destination track  
(TRK C) will be erased.  
CExecute the Track Mix Operation ....................................................  
Press the MIXLCD button to begin execution of the track mix op-  
A bar graph indicating the progress of  
the track mix operation will appear  
eration. The “Are you sure?” confirmation prompt will appear. Press  
while the data is being processed.  
YESto mix the specified tracks or NOto cancel the operation.  
You can check if the results are as you  
When this is done the MIXLCD button will change to UNDO, al-  
expected or not, by starting and stop-  
ping playback by using the [START/  
STOP] button before the UNDO opera-  
tion.  
lowing you to undo the track mix operation and return to the pre-mixed  
data before selecting a different track or exiting from the Track Mix  
mode.  
Press the [EXIT] button, or the [RECORD] button so that its indica-  
tor goes out to exit from the Track Mix function.  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
Track Delete  
The TRACK DELETE function accessed via the RECORD [TRACK DELETE] display (RECORD  
display page 5) can be used to delete all data from any specified track.  
ZSpecify the Track to be Deleted........................................................  
Only the data-containing tracks will  
appear and can be selected.  
Use the TRACKG and G buttons, the data dial, or the [+]/[–] buttons  
to specify the track you want to delete.  
XExecute the Delete Operation .............................................................  
A bar graph indicating the progress of  
the track delete operation will appear  
while the data is being processed.  
Press the DELETELCD button to begin execution of the track delete  
operation. The “Are you sure?” confirmation prompt will appear.  
Press YESto delete the specified track or NOto cancel the operation.  
After processing the DELETELCD button changes to UNDO, which can  
be used to undo the delete operation before selecting a different track or  
exiting from the Track Delete mode.  
You can check if the results are as you  
expected or not, by starting and stop-  
ping playback by using the [START/  
STOP] button before the UNDO opera-  
tion.  
Press the [EXIT] button, or the [RECORD] button so that its indica-  
tor goes out to exit from the Track Delete function.  
Track Quantize  
You can “tighten up” the timing of a recorded part by aligning all notes to specified beats via the  
TRACK QUANTIZE function accessed via the RECORD [TRACK QUANTIZE] display (RECORD dis-  
play page 6).  
ZSpecify the Track to be Quantized.................................................  
Only the data-containing tracks will  
appear and can be selected.  
Use the TRACKG and G buttons, the data dial, or the [+]/[–] buttons  
to specify the track you want to quantize.  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
XSpecify the “Quantize Size..................................................................  
Use the LCD button below the note symbol to select “quantize size”  
— i.e. the beats to which the notes in the selected track will be aligned:  
32nd notes  
3
16th note triplets  
16th notes  
3
8th note triplets  
8th notes  
3
quarter-note triplets  
quarter notes  
CExecute the Quantize Operation......................................................  
Only note and voice data is quantized.  
Once the required quantize size has been selected press the  
QUANTIZELCD button to quantize the selected track. The “Are you  
sure?” confirmation prompt will appear. Press YESto quantize the  
data or NOto abort. When this is done the QUANTIZELCD button will  
change to UNDO, allowing you to undo the quantize operation and return  
to the pre-quantized data before selecting a different track or exiting  
from the Track Quantize mode.  
A bar graph indicating the progress of  
the quantize operation will appear  
while the data is being processed.  
You can check if the results are as you  
expected or not, by starting and stop-  
ping playback by using the [START/  
STOP] button before the UNDO opera-  
tion.  
Press the [EXIT] button, or the [RECORD] button so that its indica-  
tor goes out to exit from the Track Quantize function.  
Initial Edit  
The values of the initial data can be changed for each track or the entire song by using the INITIAL  
EDIT parameters accessible via the RECORD [INITIAL EDIT] display (RECORD display page 8).  
ZSelect a Song & Engage the Edit Mode....................................  
Use the SONGG and G buttons, the data dial, or the [+]/[–] buttons  
to specify the song you want to edit, then press the EDITLCD button to  
go to the INITIAL EDIT pages.  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
XEdit the Parameters .......................................................................................  
Three INITIAL EDIT display pages are available. Use the PAGE [<]  
and [>] buttons to select the various pages and edit the parameters each  
contains. It is possible to start and stop playback by using the [START/  
STOP] button while editing the parameters in order to hear how the  
changes affect the sound.  
The data may not be played back  
accurately if you use the [r REW]  
and [fFF} buttons while editing the  
initial data.  
G Page 1: INITIAL EDIT [SONG]  
This page contains the REVERBTYPEand DEPTHparameters, the  
TEMPOparameter, and the WRITELCD button which is used to  
actually write all initial data changes once they have been made as  
required. The REVERBTYPEand DEPTHparameters and the  
TEMPOparameter affect the entire song and are edited by using the  
corresponding LCD buttons to select each parameter, and then the  
data dial or the [+]/[–] buttons to edit (see page 22 for information on  
the reverb types and depth settings, and page 29 for tempo informa-  
tion).  
In the Initial Edit mode the panel  
buttons relating to the editable param-  
eters cannot be used.  
G Page 2: INITIAL EDIT [TRACK]  
Page 2 includes VOICE, VOLUME, and PANparameters that can be  
set individually for each track. The VOICEparameter sets the initial  
voice for the track; the VOLUMEparameter sets the initial volume of  
the track, and the PANparameter sets the initial pan position of the  
track. Use the TRACKG and G buttons — or the data dial or the [+]/  
[–] buttons once the TRACKparameter has been selected — to  
specify the track you want to edit, then set the parameters in this and  
the following page as required.  
Only the data-containing tracks will  
appear and can be selected.  
The VOLUME parameters initial  
default value is 100for every track.  
This value can only be decreased.  
The effect type and depth may not be  
able to be set as expected in some  
cases. The other tracks are also  
affected and the last set track effect  
type takes priority.  
G Page 3: INITIAL EDIT [TRACK]  
Page 3 contains EFFECTTYPEand DEPTHparameters and a RE-  
VERBDEPTHparameter that can be set individually for each track.  
The track to be edited is selected in page 2 (see above), and the pa-  
rameters can be edited as required. See page 24 for information on the  
available effect types and depth settings.  
The VOICE and EFFECT TYPE  
parameters cannot be edited for the  
non-keyboard tracks (i.e. the  
RHYTHM, ABC, and/or HARMONY  
tracks).  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
CWrite the Changes ...........................................................................................  
All edited data for any number of  
tracks within one song can be written  
in a one-time WRITE operation.  
When all the initial data changes have been made as required, go back  
to INITIAL EDIT page 1 and press the WRITELCD button. The “Are  
you sure?” confirmation display will appear. Press YESto actually  
make the specified changes, or NOto abort. When this is done the  
WRITELCD button will change to UNDO, allowing you to undo the  
write operation and return to the pre-edited data before making any other  
edits or exiting from the Initial Edit mode.  
You can check if the results are as you  
expected or not, by starting and stop-  
ping playback by using the [START/  
STOP] button before the UNDO opera-  
tion.  
VExit....................................................................................................................................  
Press the [EXIT] button, or the [RECORD] button so that its indica-  
tor goes out to exit from the Initial Edit mode. If you do this after making  
any edits that you have not yet written, the “Write edited data?”  
confirmation prompt will appear. Press YESto write the edited data and  
then exit from the Initial Edit mode, NOto exit without writing the data,  
or CANCELto return to the Initial Edit mode.  
Renaming Song Files  
This function lets you enter an original name for, or change the existing name of, any song file on the  
disk recorded by the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S. The rename function is accessed via the RECORD [RE-  
NAME] display (RECORD display page 7).  
ZSelect a Song & Engage the Rename Mode........................  
Use the SONGG and G buttons, the data dial, or the [+]/[–] buttons  
to specify the song you want to rename, then press the RENAMELCD  
button to go to the NAMING display.  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
XEnter a Name.........................................................................................................  
The current song file name appears in the upper right corner of the  
display. Use the >LCD button to position the underline cursor at the  
character you want to change (song names can be up to 12 characters in  
length). Use the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons to select the character you  
want to enter from the list in the center of the display, then press the  
c.setLCD button to enter the character at the current cursor position.  
Repeat this procedure until your name is complete. The c.delLCD but-  
ton can be used to back up one space and delete a character.  
CRegister the Name ...........................................................................................  
When the name is complete press the OKLCD button to register the  
name for the current song file, or CANCELto abort.  
Press the [EXIT] button, or the [RECORD] button so that its indica-  
tor goes out, to exit from the Rename mode.  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song Recording  
Recording Without a Disk  
The Clavinova has enough internal RAM memory (about 25KB) to  
allow recording for a while even if a disk is not loaded (up to approxi-  
mately 2,500 notes if no other data is recorded).  
Chord sequence data is not recorded  
to internal RAM memory. The But-  
ton not valid !alert display will appear.  
The Punch-in/out Recording, Track  
Mix, Track Delete, Track Quantize,  
Initial Edit, and Rename functions (i.e.  
RECORD display page 3 to the last  
page) cannot be used with data in the  
internal RAM memory. The Button  
not valid !alert display will appear.  
QUICK RECORD display when recording to internal RAM memory  
SONG PLAY [MAIN] display when playing back internal RAM  
memory song  
If you accidentally record without loading a disk, make sure you use  
the SONG COPY function (described on page 102) to copy the recorded  
data to disk if you want to keep the recorded data (the internal RAM  
memory is not backed up). This is necessary because the internal RAM  
memory is cleared automatically when a Disk Orchestra Collection,  
Disklavier PianoSoft, Style File disk, or a disk containing songs recorded  
on a different instrument is loaded. The RAM is also cleared when an  
original song disk is loaded and a song is selected.  
Playback  
Original recordings can be played back and controlled in the same  
way as described in the “Disk Orchestra Collection & Song Playback”  
section, beginning on page 61. You can individually select tracks to play  
back (page 63), use the guide modes and keyboard guide lamps with the  
data recorded on any two tracks (page 67), and use the A-B repeat func-  
tion (page 70).  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
The “utility functions” described in this chapter include keyboard,  
disk, MIDI, and general functions that significantly enhance the  
versatility and flexibility of the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S. All of the utility  
functions are selected and set in the same way for consistent, easy  
operation:  
ZPress the [FUNCTION] button so that its indicator lights.  
FUNCTION MIXER  
XUse the PAGE [<] and [>] buttons to select the page containing the  
desired function.  
PAGE  
DISPLAY HOLD  
CUse the LCD buttons, data dial, and/or [+]/[–] buttons to select and  
set the individual parameters as required.  
The data dial and the [+]/[] buttons  
can be used for the parameters once  
selected by the LCD button in the  
highlighted round-framed parameter  
box.  
+
VPress the [EXIT] button, or the [FUNCTION] button so that its indi-  
cator goes out when done.  
EXIT  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
Keyboard  
G Transpose .........................................................................................................  
Press the [] and [+] buttons simultaneously  
to restore normal keyboard pitch (0).  
The Transpose function makes it possible to shift the pitch of the  
entire keyboard up or down in semitone intervals up to a maximum  
of two octaves (from –24 through 0 to +24). “Transposing” the pitch  
of the Clavinova keyboard makes it easier to play in difficult key  
signatures, and you can simply match the pitch of the keyboard to  
the range of a singer or other instrumentalist.  
The Transpose setting is retained in memory  
even when the power is turned off if the  
BACKUP page VOICE SETTING parameter  
is turned on (page 107), otherwise the  
Transpose is always set to 0when the  
power is turned on.  
Use the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons to set the desired degree of  
transposition.  
The transpose function does not affect the  
Drum Kit voices.  
Notes below and above the original 88-key  
range of the Clavinova sound one octave  
higher and lower, respectively.  
G Octave Shift......................................................................................................  
This function includes three parameters which determine whether  
the left-hand voice in a split keyboard setup (LEFT), the 2nd voice  
in the dual mode (2ND), and the right-hand or main voice (RIGHT/  
1) will be shifted up or down one octave.  
Press the LEFT, 2ND, or RIGHT/1LCD button as many times  
as necessary to set as required:  
The Octave Shift setting is retained in  
memory even when the power is turned off if  
the BACKUP page VOICE SETTING param-  
eter is turned on (page 107).  
Notes below and above the original 88-key  
range of the Clavinova sound one octave  
higher and lower, respectively.  
–1  
0
Corresponding voice shifted down one octave.  
No shift. (Default for the RIGHT/1 and 2nd voices.)  
In the normal play mode (i.e. single voice  
mode) only the RIGHT/1 setting is effective.  
+1  
Corresponding voice shifted up one octave. (Default for the  
LEFT voice.)  
G Touch Sensitivity ......................................................................................  
The Touch Sensitivity setting is retained in  
memory even when the power is turned off if  
the BACKUP page VOICE SETTING param-  
eter is turned on (page 107), otherwise the  
NORMAL setting is automatically selected  
whenever the POWER switch is turned on.  
The Clavinova can be set to one of five different types of key-  
board touch sensitivity to match different playing styles and prefer-  
ences. Press the KEY TOUCHbutton as many times as necessary to  
select the desired touch response setting.  
SOFT 2  
SOFT 1  
Allows maximum loudness to be produced with very light  
key pressure.  
Not as sensitive as the “SOFT 2” setting, but maximum  
loudness can still be easily produced with relatively light  
key pressure.  
NORMAL  
HARD 1  
Produces a fairly “standard” keyboard response. (Default.)  
Requires the keys to be played quite hard to produce  
maximum loudness.  
HARD 2  
Requires the keys to be played very hard to produce maxi-  
mum loudness.  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
Sound  
G Tune.........................................................................................................................  
The Tune setting is retained in memory even  
when the power is turned off if the BACKUP  
page TUNE/MICRO TUNING parameter is  
turned on (page 107), otherwise the tuning is  
always set at 440.0Hz when the power is  
turned on.  
The Tune function makes it possible to tune the Clavinova over  
about a ±26-Hertz (±100-cent) range in 0.2-Hertz intervals. A hun-  
dred “cents” equals one semitone, so the tuning range provided allows  
fine tuning of overall pitch over a range of approximately a semitone.  
This function is useful for tuning the Clavinova to match other instru-  
ments or recorded music. Normal pitch is A3 = 440 Hertz.  
Use the TUNEG and G LCD buttons to set the tuning as re-  
quired. The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can also be used once the  
TUNEparameter has been selected. The default value of 440.0Hz  
can be instantly recalled by pressing the TUNEG and G LCD but-  
tons simultaneously.  
The Tune function does not affect the Drum  
Kit voices.  
G Pan............................................................................................................................  
The pan setting is retained in memory even  
when the power is turned off if the BACKUP  
page VOICE SETTING parameter is turned  
on (page 107).  
The pan positions of the left-hand voice in a split keyboard setup  
(LEFT), the 2nd voice in the dual mode (2ND), and the right-hand  
or main voice (RIGHT/1) can be individually set via the appropriate  
PAN parameters.  
Press the LEFT, 2ND, or RIGHT/1LCD button according to the  
voice you want to pan, then use the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons to set  
the pan position as required. The graphic bar shows the approximate  
pan position between full left (“L”) and full right (“R”). The default  
position can be instantly recalled by pressing the [+] and [–] buttons  
simultaneously.  
The default pan position for some voices is  
center, while some voices feature keyboard  
scaling i.e. the keyboard is spread across  
the stereo sound field (see the voice list on  
page 116). Both types appear in center  
position on the LCD. Any changes in the pan  
setting are then relative to the default posi-  
tion.  
The Drum Kit voices have special pan set-  
tings for each individual instrument.  
The PAN setting affects all voices.  
The PAN setting affects the keyboard sound  
only.  
In the normal play mode (i.e. single voice  
mode) only the RIGHT/1 setting is effective.  
Pedal  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
CVP-79A  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
G Left Pedal Function ........................................................................................  
The Left Pedal function setting is re-  
tained in memory even when the  
power is turned off if the BACKUP  
page PEDAL parameter is turned on  
(page 107).  
The left pedal has a number of functions which can be selected via  
the LEFT PEDAL function. Use the LEFT PEDALG and G LCD but-  
tons to select the desired function. The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can  
also be used. The default setting — “SOFT” — can be instantly recalled  
by pressing the LEFT PEDALG and G LCD buttons simultaneously.  
Soft  
Pressing the soft pedal subtly reduces the volume and  
slightly changes the timbre of notes played. The SOFT  
function is automatically selected when the POWER  
switch is initially turned on.  
Start/Stop  
The left pedal performs the same function as the accom-  
paniment section [START/STOP] button. For details on  
the START/STOP function, refer to the “Accompani-  
ment” section, pages 30, 32.  
Harmony On/Off Allows the Harmony function (page 41) to be turned on  
or off as required while playing so that harmony can be  
applied only to specific notes or phrases.  
If the left pedal is assigned to the  
Registration +function, the setting of  
the left pedal function in the registra-  
tion memory is not recalled.  
Registration +  
Steps through the registration memory locations so a  
completely different set of panel settings can be recalled  
each time the pedal is pressed. See page 60 for details  
on the registration memory.  
Intro A/Fill to A  
Intro B/Fill to B  
Ending/rit.  
The left pedal performs the same function as the accom-  
paniment section [INTRO A/FILL TO A] button. See  
pages 30, 32 for details.  
The left pedal performs the same function as the accom-  
paniment section [INTRO B/FILL TO B] button. See  
pages 30, 32 for details.  
The left pedal performs the same function as the accom-  
paniment section [ENDING] button. See page 32 for  
details.  
Break  
Pressing the left pedal produces a break in the accom-  
paniment for as long as the pedal is held. For details on  
the BREAK function, refer to the “Accompaniment” sec-  
tion, page 32.  
Sostenuto  
(CVP-59S only)  
The left pedal functions in the same way as the CVP-  
79A/69/69A sostenuto pedal (see page 26).  
G Damper Range .....................................................................................................  
The Damper Range setting is retained  
in memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page PEDAL  
parameter is turned on (page 107).  
Determines whether the damper pedal affects the right-hand, left-  
hand, or both voices in a split setup.  
Press the DAMPER RANGELCD button as many times as necessary  
to select the desired setting.  
R
The damper affects only the right-hand voice. (Default.)  
The damper affects on the left-hand voice.  
L
L&R  
The damper affects both the left-hand and right-hand voices.  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
G Damper Mode (CVP-79A only)............................................................  
The Damper Mode setting is retained  
in memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page PEDAL  
parameter is turned on (page 107).  
Sets the damper pedal for on/off or continuous operation (refer to  
page 26). Press the DAMPER MODELCD button to alternately select  
the continuous and switch modes.  
CONT.  
Continuous damper pedal operation. (Default.)  
On/off damper pedal operation.  
SWITCH  
MIDI 1  
MIDI, the Musical Instrument Digital Interface, is a world-standard communication interface that al-  
lows MIDI-compatible musical instruments and equipment to share musical information and control one  
another. This makes it possible to create “systems” of MIDI instruments and equipment that offer far  
greater versatility and control than is available with isolated instruments. The MIDI parameters included in  
the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S’s three MIDI function pages provide extensive flexibility in adapting the  
Clavinova to just about any MIDI system.  
The parameters contained in the MIDI 1 function page include the SEND CH, which determines the  
BASIC and LEFT/2 voice MIDI send channels, LOCAL control setting — on or off, and the CLOCK set-  
ting — internal or external.  
G Send Channel .......................................................................................................  
The Send Channel settings are re-  
In any MIDI control setup, the MIDI channels of the transmitting and  
tained in memory even when the  
receiving equipment must be matched for proper data transfer (there are  
16 MIDI channels). This function sets the basic and left-hand/2nd MIDI  
send (transmit) channels of the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S. The LEFT/2  
power is turned off if the BACKUP  
page MIDI parameter is turned on  
(page 107), otherwise the default  
BASIC send channel is 1 and the  
default LEFT/2 send channel is OFF.  
parameter applies to the left-hand voice in split keyboard setups and to  
the 2nd voice in the dual mode. All other keyboard data is transmitted via  
the BASICchannel. Both parameters can be turned OFF or set to any  
channel from 1 through 16.  
Press the BASICor LEFT/2LCD button according to the channel  
you want to set, then use the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons to set the chan-  
nel as required.  
G MIDI Reception  
The CVP-79A/69/69A/59S always receives MIDI data in the “Multi-  
Timbre” mode. This is a mode in which the Clavinova voices can be  
independently controlled on different MIDI channel numbers (1  
through 16) by an external MIDI device.  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
G Local Control ON/OFF.................................................................................  
The Local setting is retained in  
memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page MIDI  
parameter is turned ON (page 107),  
otherwise the default setting is ON.  
“Local Control” refers to the fact that, normally, the Clavinova key-  
board controls its internal tone generator, allowing the internal voices to  
be played directly from the keyboard. This situation is “Local Control  
ON” since the internal tone generator is controlled locally by its own  
keyboard.  
Local control can be turned off, however, so that the Clavinova key-  
board does not play the internal voices, but the appropriate MIDI infor-  
mation is still transmitted via the MIDI OUT connector when notes are  
played on the keyboard. At the same time, the internal tone generator  
responds to MIDI information received via the MIDI IN connector. This  
means that while an external MIDI sequencer, for example, plays the  
Clavinova’s internal voices, an external tone generator can be played  
from the Clavinova keyboard.  
Press the LOCALLCD button to alternately turn local control ON and  
OFF.  
G Clock ..............................................................................................................................  
The Clock setting is retained in  
memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page MIDI  
parameter is turned ON (page 107),  
otherwise the default setting is INT.  
This function determines whether the Clavinova’s auto-accompani-  
ment or song record/playback timing is controlled by the Clavinova’s  
own internal clock or an external MIDI clock signal received from exter-  
nal equipment connected to the MIDI IN connector.  
Press the CLOCKLCD button to alternately select the EXT. (exter-  
nal) or INT. (internal) clock mode.  
If the Clock Mode is set to EXT. and a  
MIDI clock signal is not being received  
from an external source, the rhythm,  
ABC and other clock-dependent fea-  
tures will not operate.  
MIDI 2  
The “MIDI 2” function page contains the MIDI FILTER settings which can be used to turn transmission  
and reception of certain types of MIDI data on or off.  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
G Program ......................................................................................................................  
The Program setting is retained in  
memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page MIDI  
parameter is turned ON (page 107),  
otherwise the default setting is  
SEND&RECEIVE.  
Normally the Clavinova will respond to MIDI program change num-  
bers received from an external keyboard or other MIDI device, causing  
the correspondingly numbered Multi-Timbre mode voice to be selected  
on the corresponding channel (the keyboard voice does not change). The  
Clavinova will normally also send a MIDI program change number  
whenever one of its voices is selected, causing the correspondingly num-  
bered voice or program to be selected on the external MIDI device if the  
device is set up to receive and respond to MIDI program change num-  
bers.  
This function makes it possible to cancel program change number  
reception and transmission so that voices can be selected on the  
Clavinova without affecting the external MIDI device, and vice versa.  
Press the PROGRAMLCD button to alternately turn program change  
number reception and transmission ON (SEND&RECEIVE) and OFF.  
G Control..........................................................................................................................  
The Control setting is retained in  
memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page MIDI  
parameter is turned ON (page 107),  
otherwise the default setting is  
SEND&RECEIVE.  
Normally the Clavinova will respond to MIDI control change data  
received from an external MIDI device or keyboard, causing the corre-  
sponding Multi-Timbre mode voice to be affected by pedal and other  
“control” settings received from the controlling device (the keyboard  
voice is not affected). The Clavinova also transmits MIDI control change  
information when either of its pedals are operated.  
This function makes it possible to cancel control change data recep-  
tion and transmission if you do not want the Clavinova to be affected by  
control change data received from an external device or vice versa.  
Press the CONTROLLCD button to alternately turn control change  
data reception and transmission ON (SEND&RECEIVE) and OFF.  
G Start/Stop ..................................................................................................................  
The Start/Stop setting is retained in  
memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page MIDI  
parameter is turned ON (page 107),  
otherwise the default setting is  
SEND&RECEIVE.  
Normally the Clavinova will respond to MIDI start and stop com-  
mands received from an external MIDI device or keyboard, causing the  
auto-accompaniment or song record/playback functions to start or stop in  
the same way as the panel [START/STOP] button. The Clavinova also  
transmits MIDI start and stop commands when the corresponding func-  
tions are operated.  
This function makes it possible to cancel start/stop command recep-  
tion and transmission if you do not want the Clavinova to be affected by  
start/stop commands received from an external device or vice versa.  
Press the START/STOPLCD button to alternately turn start/stop  
command reception and transmission ON (SEND&RECEIVE) and OFF.  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
MIDI 3  
The MIDI 3 function page contains the TRANSPOSE and SEND parameters which determine whether  
MIDI note data will be affected by the Transpose setting (page 91), and whether the ABC, rhythm, and  
harmony data will be transmitted via the MIDI OUT terminal.  
G Transpose .................................................................................................................  
The actual note number received or  
The RECEIVEparameter determines whether MIDI note pitch re-  
transmitted is not affected. The trans-  
ceived by the Clavinova will be affected by the setting of the Transpose  
function (see page 91), while the SENDparameter determines whether  
MIDI note pitch transmitted by the Clavinova will be affected by the  
setting of the Transpose function.  
position is produced by the MIDI con-  
trol change RPN coarse tune data.  
The MIDI Transpose settings are  
retained in memory even when the  
power is turned off if the BACKUP  
page MIDI parameter is turned ON  
Press the RECEIVEor SENDLCD button to alternately turn transpo-  
(page 107), otherwise the RECEIVE  
sition of received or transmitted MIDI data ON and OFF.  
parameter is turned On and the SEND  
parameter is turned OFF.  
G Send ................................................................................................................................  
The Send settings are retained in  
memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page MIDI  
These parameters determine whether MIDI data corresponding to  
ABC/rhythm and harmony playback will be transmitted via the MIDI  
parameter is turned ON (page 107),  
otherwise both parameters are turned  
OFF.  
OUT terminal. Press the ABC&RHYor HARMONYbutton to alter-  
nately turn transmission of the corresponding data ON (9–16ch / 6–8ch)  
or OFF. When on, the ABC and rhythm data is transmitted on MIDI  
If you intend to send the ABC/rhythm  
channels 9 through 16, and the harmony data is transmitted on channels  
6 through 8.  
or harmony data via MIDI, it is a good  
idea to set the BASIC and LEFT/2  
channels (page 94) to the different  
channels than the ones used for ABC/  
rhythm (916) and harmony (68)  
data to avoid data conflict problems.  
If either of these parameters is on, the  
ABC/rhythm and/or harmony data will  
be sent even if the BASIC send chan-  
nel is turned OFF.  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
Format  
The FORMAT page provides access to the Disk Format function which allows new disks or disks  
formatted on other equipment to be “formatted” for use with the Clavinova.  
The Clavinova uses only 3.5" 2DD or 2HD floppy disks. We recommend that you use Yamaha disks.  
Before you can use a new disk for recording, the disk must be formatted so that the Clavinova can rec-  
ognize it and correctly write the music data onto it.  
ZInsert the Disk To Be Formatted ......................................................  
If you access the FORMAT function  
page via the [FUNCTION] and PAGE  
buttons (i.e. you want to format a disk  
Insert a new blank disk. Make sure that the disk’s write protect tab is  
set to the “write” position (tab closed), and insert the new disk into the  
that is already inserted), press the  
disk drive unit with the sliding door facing the drive slot and the label  
START LCD button before proceeding  
side of the disk facing upward. The disk should click securely into place,  
to step 2 below.  
and the disk drive lamp should light briefly. The “Start disk for-  
mat?” display will automatically appear if an unformatted disk is in-  
serted. Press the OKLCD button to format the disk or the CANCEL  
LCD button to abort.  
• “Protected disk!will appear if a pro-  
tected disk (DOC, etc.) that cannot be  
formatted is loaded in the drive.  
Write protect tab  
closed (unlocked  
— write enabled)  
The No disk!alert will appear if you  
attempt to execute a format operation  
when there is no disk inserted in the  
disk drive.  
2DD disks are formatted into 720 KB,  
while 2HD disks are formatted into  
1.44 MB.  
The song record or playback mode will  
be turned off if the FORMAT operation  
is executed while they are on.  
XConfirm & Start the Format Operation ......................................  
When “Are you sure?” appears press the YESLCD button to  
confirm and continue, or the NOLCD button to cancel the operation.  
This extra confirmation step is necessary because formatting completely  
erases any data that is already on the disk — make sure that the disk  
you’re about to format does not contain any important data!  
Formatting will begin the instant you select “YES”. The progress of  
the format operation will be indicated by a bar-graph on the display.  
When formatting is complete, you can go ahead and record using the  
Song Record function, use the Song Copy function to copy songs, or  
save other data to the disk.  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
Registration  
The REGISTRATION function page provides access to the Clavinova’s Registration and All Setup file  
disk operations — save, load, delete, and rename.  
Before selecting the Registration function, make sure that the disk you want to use for this operation is  
inserted in the disk drive, and both the song record or playback modes are not engaged.  
ZSelect a File Type..............................................................................................  
The Registration function cannot be  
Use either of the first two LCD buttons to select either REGISTRA-  
used when the song record or play-  
TIONor ALL SETUP, according to the type of file you want to save,  
load, delete, or rename.  
back mode is engaged the Button  
not valid!alert display will appear.  
Registration  
All Setup  
A Registration file containing all data in the 25 or 15 Regis-  
tration memories.  
See page 58 for the list of data con-  
tained in the Registration memory.  
An All Setup file containing all panel setup data in the list on  
page 122 including Registration data.  
XSelect a File Operation ...............................................................................  
Use the fourth LCD button to select the LOAD, SAVE, DELETE, or  
RENAME operation.  
CPress START............................................................................................................  
Press the STARTLCD button to begin the selected operation, then  
proceed according to the selected operation as described below:  
G SAVE...............................................................................................................................  
If you select SAVEthe name entry display will appear and you will  
have to enter a name for the file to be saved.  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
An “empty” name appears in the upper right corner of the display.  
Use the >LCD button to position the underline cursor where you want  
to enter a character (file names can be up to 12 characters in length). Use  
the data dial and/or the [+]/[–] buttons to select the character you want to  
enter from the list in the center of the display, then press the c.setLCD  
button to enter the character at the current cursor position. Repeat this  
procedure until your name is complete. The c.delLCD button can be  
used to back up one space and delete a character.  
When the name is complete press the SAVELCD button to save the  
file with the name just entered, or CANCELto abort.  
If you enter a name that already exists on the disk, the “Same  
name! Overwrite?” alert will appear. In this case press OKif it’s  
OK to overwrite the original file with the new file, or CANCELto abort  
the save operation.  
G RENAME .....................................................................................................................  
If you select RENAME, first use the FILEG and G LCD buttons to  
select the file you want to rename, then press the STARTLCD button to  
go to the name entry display. Enter a new file name in the same way as  
described for SAVE, above, then press the OKLCD button to rename the  
file with the name just entered, or CANCELto abort. If you enter a name  
that already exists on the disk, the “Same name! Overwrite?”  
alert will appear. In this case press OKif it’s OK to overwrite the origi-  
nal file with the renamed file, or CANCELto abort the rename operation.  
G LOAD..............................................................................................................................  
If you select LOAD, first use the FILEG and G LCD buttons to se-  
lect the file you want to load, then press the STARTLCD button. When  
the “Are you sure?” prompt appears, press YESto load the file or  
NOto cancel.  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
G DELETE .......................................................................................................................  
If you select DELETE, first use the FILEG and G LCD buttons to  
select the file you want to delete, then press the STARTLCD button.  
When the “Are you sure?” prompt appears, press YESto delete the  
file or NOto cancel.  
Transform  
The TRANSFORM function page allows CVP-79A/69/69A/59S performance (i.e. song) data files to be  
converted to CVP Performance format so that the data can be played on other Clavinova models, or to  
Yamaha Piano Format 1 or Piano Format 2 so that the data can be played on Yamaha Disklaviers.  
Make sure that the disk (only 2dd type disks can be used for this operation) containing the song you  
want to convert is inserted in the disk drive, and the song record mode is not engaged. Then select the  
Transform function.  
Only 2DD type disks can be used for  
this operation. If a 2HD disk is used  
the 2HD disk is not valid! Please copy  
to 2DD disk.alert display will appear.  
In this case copy the song you want to  
convert to a 2DD disk first (see Song  
Copybelow), and then try the conver-  
sion again.  
The available formats are compatible with the following Disklavier  
and Clavinova models:  
This function can not be used when  
the song record mode is engaged —  
the Button not valid!alert display will  
CVP PERFORMANCE  
PIANO FORMAT 1  
CVP-50/70/55/65/75/83S/85A/87A/89,  
CLP-705, DOM-30, DOU-10  
appear.  
MX80 series.  
Only data on disk recorded by the  
CVP-79A/69/69A/59S can be con-  
verted (data in the Clavinovas internal  
memory cannot be converted until it is  
saved to disk).  
Disklavier Grand.  
MX100 MarkII.  
Disklavier Grand MarkII  
PIANO FORMAT 2  
MX100A.  
MX100B.  
The copied data from the Disk Orches-  
tra Collection disk (page 103) cannot  
be converted.  
The converted data will automatically be saved to a free song number  
and named according to the type of conversion selected:  
If data converted to PIANO FORMAT  
1/2 is played back on the Clavinova,  
tracks 1 and 2 will not sound.  
CVP PERFORMANCE  
“C)XXXXXX” where “XXXXXX” is the original song  
name.  
Record or edit functions cannot be  
executed on a converted song.  
PIANO FORMAT 1/2  
“P)XXXXXX” where “XXXXXX” is the original song  
name.  
The original pre-converted data re-  
mains alive even after the conversion  
has been executed.  
ZSelect the Conversion Type...................................................................  
Use either of the first two LCD buttons to select the target format of  
the file: CVP PERFORMANCE, PIANO FORMAT 1, or PIANO  
FORMAT 2.  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
XSelect the Song Number to be Converted.............................  
Use the SONGLCD button — or data dial or [+]/[–] buttons — to  
select the song number to be converted.  
CStart the Conversion .....................................................................................  
Press the TRANSFORMLCD button to begin the conversion process.  
When the conversion process is finished, the “Completed! SONG  
No. XX” message will appear to inform you as to the SONG No. into  
which the data was saved.  
Song Copy  
Song data can be “backed up” by copying to a new song number or a different disk, as follows:  
(Make sure that the song record mode is not engaged before proceeding.)  
ZInsert a Disk, Select the Song Copy Function, &  
Select the Type of Copy Operation ...............................................  
The song copy function cannot be  
used when the song record mode is  
engagedthe Button not valid!alert  
display will appear.  
Insert the disk containing the song you want to copy, select the Song  
Copy function, and use either of the first two LCD buttons to select  
DISK1 — 1” to copy to a different song within the same disk, or  
DISK1 — 2” to copy to a different disk.  
If the Clavinovas internal memory  
contains song data, the CVP-DISK”  
copy mode will be automatically se-  
lected to copy the internal memory  
data to disk (see the Copying Data  
Recorded Without a Diskbelow) and  
the DISK 1 1or DISK 1 2copy  
mode cannot be selected. In this case,  
copy the internal memory data to disk  
first, if you want to keep the data, and  
delete the internal memory data by  
using the Song Delete function (page  
104). Then try the DISK 1 1or  
DISK 1 2copy operation again.  
XSelect the Source Song Number .....................................................  
Use the SONG— LCD button to select the song you want to copy.  
>
The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can also be used once the SONG— pa-  
>
rameter has been selected. The selected song name will appear in the  
upper right corner of the display.  
Only song data recorded on the CVP-  
79A/69/69A/59S and Disk Orchestra  
Collection orchestra and rhythm data  
can be copied using this function.  
CSelect the Destination Song (DISK 1 – 1 type copy)..  
This step is for the DISK 1 – 1 type copy only. If you have selected the DISK 1 –  
2 type copy, pass this step and proceed to the next Vstep.  
Data cannot be copied to Disk Orches-  
tra Collection disks, Disklavier disks, or  
any write-protected disk.  
Use the SONGbutton to select the song number you wish to copy to  
(i.e. the destination song number). The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can  
also be used once the SONGparameter has been selected. If you select a  
song number that already contains data, that data will be overwritten by  
the new song data. If the destination song already contains data, the  
name of the song file will appear in the middle right corner of the dis-  
play.  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
VStart Copying ........................................................................................................  
The copy operation is not effective if  
the same song numbers are selected  
as the Source song and the Destina-  
tion song in the DISK1 1 type copy.  
In this case the Button not valid!alert  
will appear.  
Press the COPYLCD button to begin the actual copy operation. If  
you are copying to the same disk the “Are you sure?” confirmation  
prompt will appear. Press the OKLCD button to continue, or NOto can-  
cel.  
If you choose to copy to a different disk, the “No. of disk ex-  
changes” display will appear to inform you of the number of times  
the disk will have to be exchanged, because you may have to exchange  
the source and destination disks a few times if the song being copied is  
long and complex. Press OKto continue, or CANCELto abort. If you  
press OK, the Clavinova will prompt you to insert the source and desti-  
nation disks as required. Insert the source or destination disk accordingly.  
INSERT DISK 1  
INSERT DISK 2  
Insert source disk.  
Insert destination disk.  
The first time the destination disk is inserted, the “Please select  
destination song No.” display will appear. Use the SONGGG  
LCD buttons, or data dial or [+]/[–] buttons, to select the destination  
song number. If the destination song already contains data, the name of  
the song file will appear along with the song number, and the data will be  
overwritten with the new song data. Press OKto execute the copy opera-  
tion or CANCELto abort.  
While the data is being copied the number of times the disks will  
have to be exchanged to complete the copy operation will be shown on  
the display.  
G Copying Disk Orchestra Disks ([ORCH/3-10TR] and  
[RHYTHM] parts only)  
Tracks 1 and 2 of a copied DOC song  
can be recorded, but tracks 3 through  
16 cannot be recorded.  
All Disk Orchestra data except the right-hand and left-hand parts can  
be copied to a separate disk by following the standard DISK 1 – 2  
copy procedure outlined above. The copied data cannot, however, be  
copied a second time to another disk.  
The Phrase Repeat function (page 69)  
cannot be used on a copied DOC  
song.  
G Copying Data Recorded Without a Disk  
The DISK 1 1and DISK 1 2”  
copy modes cannot be selected when  
the internal memory contains song  
data.  
If you’ve used the Song Record function to record data without first  
loading a disk: insert a formatted disk, select the Song Copy function,  
then select the destination song number and copy as described above.  
The “CVP - DISK” copy mode will automatically be selected and  
the “CVP” will be selected as the source song when the internal  
memory contains song data.  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
Song Delete  
You can delete any song from a loaded disk as follows:  
(Make sure that the song record mode is not engaged before proceeding.)  
ZInsert a Disk & Select the Song Delete Function...........  
Insert the disk containing the song you want to delete and select the  
Song Delete function.  
The song delete function cannot be  
used when the song record mode is  
engaged the Button not valid!alert  
display will appear.  
Only song data recorded on the CVP-  
79A/69/69A/59S can be deleted using  
this function.  
XSelect the Song to Delete ........................................................................  
Use the SONGG and G buttons to select the song number you wish  
to delete. The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can also be used. It is also  
possible to delete song data in the internal memory: select “CVP” in-  
stead of a song number. (“CVP” will appear and can be selected only  
when the internal memory contains data.)  
Data cannot be deleted from write-  
protected disks.  
CConfirm & Execute the Delete Operation ...............................  
Press the DELETELCD button — “Are you sure?” will appear  
on the display. Press the YESLCD button to immediately delete the se-  
lected song, or the NOLCD button if you wish to cancel the operation.  
Micro Tuning  
The Micro Tuning Feature makes it possible to individually tune each key on the Clavinova keyboard in  
order to match different tuning standards. The pitch of each key can be raised or lowered by a maximum of  
100 cents (approximately) from the standard pitch.  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
ZSelect the Micro Tuning Function...................................................  
XSelect a Key............................................................................................................  
The Micro-Tuning settings are retained  
in memory even when the power is  
turned off if the BACKUP page TUNE/  
MICRO TUNING parameter is turned  
ON (page 107), otherwise all keys are  
set to 0.  
Select the key you want to tune by pressing the key on the keyboard.  
The selected key will appear on the display.  
CTune.................................................................................................................................  
Use the TUNEsand tbuttons to tune the selected key as required.  
The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can also be used. You can play the key  
being tuned to check the sound during this operation. The maximum  
tuning range is ±100 cents (100 cents = one semitone). The normal tun-  
ing (±0cent) for the selected key can be instantly recalled by simultane-  
ously pressing the TUNEsand tbuttons.  
VRepeat as Necessary....................................................................................  
Repeat steps 2 and 3 until all the required keys have been tuned.  
G Disk Operations:  
Saving, Loading, Renaming, and Deleting Micro-tuning Files ..................................................  
Make sure that the disk you want to use for this operation is inserted  
in the disk drive, and both the song record or playback modes are not  
engaged before proceeding.  
ZSelect a File Operation ...............................................................................  
The Micro Tuning Disk Operations  
Use the fourth LCD button to select the LOAD, SAVE, DELETE, or  
cannot be used when the song record  
or playback mode is engaged the  
Button not valid!alert will be dis-  
RENAME operation.  
played.  
XPress START............................................................................................................  
Press the STARTLCD button to begin the selected operation, then  
proceed according to the selected operation as described below:  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
G SAVE...............................................................................................................................  
If you select SAVEthe name entry display will appear and you will  
have to enter a name for the file to be saved.  
An “empty” name appears in the upper right corner of the display.  
Use the >LCD button to position the underline cursor where you want  
to enter a character (file names can be up to 12 characters in length). Use  
the data dial and/or the [+]/[–] buttons to select the character you want to  
enter from the list in the center of the display, then press the c.setLCD  
button to enter the character at the current cursor position. Repeat this  
procedure until your name is complete. The c.delLCD button can be  
used to back up one space and delete a character.  
When the name is complete press the SAVELCD button to save the  
file with the name just entered, or CANCELto abort.  
If you enter a name that already exists on the disk, the “Same  
name! Overwrite?” alert will appear. In this case press OKif it’s  
OK to overwrite the original file with the new file, or CANCELto abort  
the save operation.  
G RENAME .....................................................................................................................  
If you select RENAME, first use the FILEG and G LCD buttons to  
select the file you want to rename, then press the STARTLCD button to  
go to the name entry display. Enter a new file name in the same way as  
described for SAVE, above, then press the OKLCD button to rename the  
file with the name just entered, or CANCELto abort. If you enter a name  
that already exists on the disk, the “Same name! Overwrite?”  
alert will appear. In this case press OKif it’s OK to overwrite the origi-  
nal file with the renamed file, or CANCELto abort the rename operation.  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
G LOAD..............................................................................................................................  
If you select LOAD, first use the FILEG and G LCD buttons to se-  
lect the file you want to load, then press the STARTLCD button. When  
the “Are you sure?” prompt appears, press YESto load the file or  
NOto cancel.  
G DELETE .......................................................................................................................  
If you select DELETE, first use the FILEG and G LCD buttons to  
select the file you want to delete, then press the STARTLCD button.  
When the “Are you sure?” prompt appears, press YESto delete the  
file or NOto cancel.  
Backup  
This function allows backup of various parameter settings to be turned on or off as required. To turn  
backup for a parameter group on or off first use the G and G LCD buttons, data dial, or [+]/[–] buttons to  
select the parameter group (see list below), and then use the ON/OFFLCD button to turn the selected pa-  
rameter group on or off. An asterisk (“*”) appears before the name of a parameter group when backup is  
turned on.  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
• VOICE SETTING  
• TUNE/MICRO TUNING  
• PEDAL  
The default settings for the BACKUP  
function are ABC MODE, REGISTRA-  
TION, and POPUP & ALERT ON, the  
other parameter groups OFF.  
• MIDI  
• STYLE SETTING  
• ABC MODE  
The LCD contrast, help language and  
this backup on/off setting itself are  
always backed up.  
• SONG SETTING  
• REGISTRATION  
• POPUP & ALERT  
* See page 122 for the list of parameters contained in each parameter group.  
Parameters that are backed up will be retained in memory for about a  
week if the Clavinova is not turned on during this time. All parameters  
will be reset to their default values if the power remains off for longer  
than about a week. To ensure that your backed-up settings are main-  
tained, turn the power on for a few minutes at least once a week.  
Recall  
This function can be used to recall the initial factory settings for a range of parameters — individually  
or all at once.  
To recall a parameter group first use the G and G LCD buttons, data dial, or [+]/[–] buttons to select  
the parameter group (see list below), and then press the STARTLCD button. When the “Are you  
sure?” confirmation prompt appears, press YESto recall or NOto cancel.  
• VOICE SETTING  
The initial LCD contrast, help language  
and the above backup on/off settings  
are not recalled by this function. These  
and all other settings can be reset to  
the initial factory values by turning the  
power on while holding the C7 key.  
When this is done the Back up data  
erased and replaced by Factory data.”  
message will appear for a few sec-  
onds.  
• STYLE SETTING  
• SONG SETTING  
• REGISTRATION  
• MIDI  
• ALL SETUP  
* See page 122 for the list of parameters contained in each parameter group.  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Utility Functions  
Popup Time  
Sets the amount of time the pop-up displays remain on the display screen before disappearing. The pop-  
up time of the voice/style displays can be set independently from all other pop-up displays.  
Use the VOICE/STYLEor OTHERS[G] and [G] LCD buttons to set the pop-up time between 1 and  
20 seconds as required. The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can also be used once the desired parameter has  
been selected. The default pop-up time (8 seconds) for either parameter can be recalled by pressing the  
corresponding G and G LCD buttons simultaneously.  
Song List Priority  
This function determines whether a GM (general MIDI)/SMF or DOC (Disk Orchestra Collection) file  
will take priority and be used for playback when encountered on the same disk. Use the corresponding  
LCD button to select GMor DOC(default) as required.  
Alert Sound  
This function allows you to select one of six “Alert Voices” which will sound when an error is encoun-  
tered, and set the alert volume.  
Use the VOICEG and G LCD buttons to select the alert voice. The data dial and [+]/[–] buttons can  
also be used once the VOICEparameter is selected. Press the VOLUMELCD button to select the volume  
parameter and use the data dial or [+]/[–] buttons to set the volume as required. The volume range is from  
“0” (no alert sound) to “100” (maximum volume). The default volume level (“50”) can be recalled in-  
stantly by pressing the [+] and [–] buttons simultaneously while the VOLUMEparameter is selected.  
The default alert voice is Steel  
Drums, and the alert voice will sound  
automatically when you change the  
alert voice.  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Messages  
When a disk related function button is pressed (ex. [PLAY]) and there is no disk in the  
disk drive this prompt will appear. Put the proper disk in the drive and redo the proce-  
dure.  
When renaming or copying the original song data this prompt will alert you in the event  
that there is no song data in the selected song number, or in the disk. Re-select a  
data-containing song, or put a disk with song data into the floppy disk drive.  
This alert appears if there is no Registration Memory, Micro Tuning, or related data  
other than song data on the currently inserted disk when you attempt a file-related  
operation. Insert a disk with the proper data and do the procedure again.  
This message appears when a new disk or a non Clavinova Formatted disk has been  
put into the disk drive. Press OK if you want to format the disk. Press CANCEL if you  
want to abort the formatting process.  
The current disk is write protected and cannot be written to. Insert a disk that is not  
write protected and try the procedure again.  
You have attempted to edit or record over a song that was made on another system  
(i.e. computer sequencer, etc.). Song data made on other systems cannot be edited or  
recorded over. You can however, edit or record over any song that you have recorded  
yourself on the CVP-79A/69/69A/59S.  
A button that does not have a function in the current mode has been pressed. (ex. the  
[GUIDE] button has been pressed when the Song Play mode is not engaged.)  
The disk drive heads are dirty and should be cleaned. Clean the heads with a commer-  
cially-available floppy disk head cleaner.  
An error occurred while writing to or reading from the disk. Try the operation again; if  
the error occurs a second time the disk or drive may be faulty. If the drive has been  
used for some time the heads may be dirty. Clean the heads with a commercially-  
available floppy disk head cleaner. If the error still occurs with one disk and not others  
the disk should be considered faulty and discarded. If the error occurs with all disks the  
drive may be at fault. Refer the problem to your Yamaha dealer.  
The disk operation (formatting, etc.) or data procedure is finished.  
The disk is currently being accessed and must not be ejected from the drive.  
When an operation such as DELETE is selected, this prompt will confirm that you want  
to go ahead with the operation. Press YES to continue or NO to abort the operation.  
The currently loaded disk is full and cannot hold anymore data. Delete any unneces-  
sary data in the current disk, use a disk that has more available space or use a new  
disk.  
If this appears during song recording (in this case “OK” doesn’t appear), recording will  
stop and recorded data up to that point will be saved automatically.  
A single disk can only hold up to 60 files for each data type (song, style, registration,  
etc.). If this message appears, insert a new disk or delete any unnecessary files in the  
current disk. (Style Files cannot be deleted from the disk.)  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Messages  
A file with the same name exists. Press OK if it is OK to overwrite the original file with  
new data or press CANCEL to abort the operation.  
Informs you of the number of times the disks must be exchanged when copying a  
song to a different disk before the song copy operation starts.  
When copying a song from the source disk to another disk, this message will ask you  
to specify the song number to which the song is to be copied in the destination disk  
when it is first inserted.  
Insert the source disk to be copied in the song copy to a different disk operation.  
Insert the destination disk to be copied to in the song copy to a different disk opera-  
tion.  
If the [EXIT] button is pressed prior to storing the recorded data in the CHORD SE-  
QUENCE function this confirmation prompt will appear.  
In the Song Recording INITIAL EDIT mode, if the [EXIT] button is pressed prior to  
writing the edited data, this confirmation prompt will appear.  
Only 2DD floppy disks can be used when converting data to the CVP Performance  
format or Piano format. If a 2HD disk is used this alert will appear.  
After the song data has been converted to CVP Performance format or Piano Format  
this message will inform you as to the SONG No. into which the data was saved.  
This message appears when the CUSTOM STYLE mode is engaged.  
When you attempt to change the beat in the CUSTOM STYLE mode this confirmation  
prompt will appear.  
When you attempt to change the number of measures in the CUSTOM STYLE mode  
this confirmation prompt will appear.  
When the source style is a preset style or a style loaded from the optional Style File  
disk, if you are recording new parts in the CUSTOM STYLE mode prior to clearing  
data from parts other than R1 and R2, this confirmation prompt will appear.  
When the STORE LCD button is pressed in the CUSTOM STYLE mode or when a  
new source style is selected prior to storing the current style data this confirmation  
prompt will appear.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Messages  
When the [EXIT] button is pressed in the CUSTOM STYLE mode prior to storing the  
current style data this confirmation prompt will appear.  
If the CUSTOM STYLE mode’s RECALL SECTION operation cannot be carried out,  
because the time signature has been changed, this alert will appear.  
If the data has not been stored in memory before saving to disk in the CUSTOM  
STYLE mode, this will prompt you to store the data before proceeding.  
If there is not enough memory to store the data in the CUSTOM STYLE store opera-  
tion, this alert will be displayed. It will be necessary to delete a style or simplify the  
current style before storing the new style.  
Appears when DELETE is selected in the previous message.  
The memory has become full during recording or editing in the CUSTOM STYLE  
mode. It will be necessary to simplify the style.  
If this appears during song recording (in this case “OK” doesn’t appear), recording will  
stop and recorded data up to that point will be saved automatically.  
Some Style Files are too large for the LISTEN function to handle in the STYLE FILE  
LOAD mode. In this case the data must be loaded into the internal memory in order to  
be played.  
When you attempt to LOAD a Style File and there is not enough memory to hold the  
specified file this alert will be displayed. It will be necessary to delete a style before  
loading the new style.  
As long as the Clavinova is regularly used, data is retained in memory. This message  
will appear if the power has not been turned on for quite some time (approximately one  
week). In this case all data will be initialized to the factory-preset values. This message  
also appears when you intentionally recall all the factory data by turning the power on  
while holding the C7 key (see note on page 108).  
A problem has been detected in the hardware system during power up. Refer the prob-  
lem to your Yamaha dealer.  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Connectors  
Although the Clavinova is a self-contained musical instrument that  
simply be plugged into the AC mains outlet and played, it also  
features a number of connectors for system expansion.  
G AUX IN L/L+R and R Jacks ........................................................................................  
AUX IN  
R
L/L+R  
The input signal from the AUX  
IN jacks is delivered to the AUX  
OUT jacks, but is not affected  
by the Clavinovas volume  
control or reverb effect.  
These jacks are intended primarily for use with  
external synthesizers or tone generator modules.  
For example, the outputs of the synthesizer/tone  
generator can be to the Clavinova AUX IN jacks, al-  
lowing the sound of the synthesizer/tone generator to  
be reproduced via the Clavinova’s internal amplifier  
and speaker system. For monaural signal input (when  
the connected device is monaural), use only the L/  
L+R jack.  
Tone Generator  
G AUX OUT L/L+R and R Jacks..................................................................................  
The AUX OUT jack signal must  
never be returned to the AUX  
IN jacks, either directly or  
AUX OUT  
The AUX OUT L/L+R and R jacks deliver the  
R
L/L+R  
output of the Clavinova for connection to an instru-  
ment amplifier, mixing console, PA system, or record-  
ing equipment. If you will be connecting the  
through external equipment.  
Clavinova to a monaural sound system, use only the  
L/L+R jack. When a plug is inserted into the L/L+R  
jack only, the left- and right-channel signals are com-  
bined and delivered via the L/L+R jack so you don’t  
lose any of the Clavinova’s sound.  
Stereo System  
G MIDI IN,THRU and OUT Connectors  
(MIDI IN and OUT on the CVP-59S)...................................................................  
The MIDI IN connector receives MIDI data from  
an external MIDI device (such as a synthesizer, se-  
quencer, music computer, etc.) which can be used to  
CVP-79A/69/69A  
MIDI  
OUT  
IN  
THRU  
control the Clavinova. The MIDI THRU connector  
provided on the CVP-79A, 69, and 69A re-transmits  
any data received at the MIDI IN connector, allowing  
“chaining” of several MIDI instruments or other de-  
vices. The MIDI OUT connector transmits MIDI data  
generated by the Clavinova (e.g. note and velocity  
data produced by playing the Clavinova keyboard).  
MIDI Sequencer  
Tone Generator  
G EXP PEDAL Jack (CVP-79A)....................................................................................  
An optional Yamaha FC7 Foot Controller can be  
plugged into this jack for foot volume (expression)  
EXP PEDAL  
control of the keyboard sound only (i.e. expression  
doesn’t affect the auto-accompaniment sound or disk  
playback). Press the pedal forward to increase volume,  
and backward to decrease volume.  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
If you encounter what appears to be a malfunction, please check the  
following points before assuming that your Clavinova is faulty.  
1. No Sound When the Power is Turned On  
Is the AC plug properly connected to the Clavinova and an AC wall outlet? Check the AC connection  
carefully. Is the MASTER VOLUME control turned up to a reasonable listening level?  
2. No Rhythm, ABC, or Song Playback Sound  
Check the ABC/SONG VOLUME control setting. No sound is produced if it is set to the minimum posi-  
tion.  
3. The Clavinova Reproduces Radio or TV Sound  
This can occur if there is a high-power transmitter in your vicinity. Contact your Yamaha dealer.  
4. Intermittent Static Noise  
This is usually due to turning on or off a household appliance or other electronic equipment which is fed  
by the same AC mains line as your Clavinova.  
5. Interference Appears On Radio or TV Sets Located Near the Clavinova  
The Clavinova contains digital circuitry which can generate radio-frequency noise. The solution is to  
move the Clavinova further away from the affected equipment, or vice versa.  
6. Distorted Sound When the Clavinova is Connected to An External Amplifier/Speaker  
System  
If the Clavinova is connected to a stereo system or instrument amplifier and the sound is distorted, reduce  
the setting of the Clavinova volume control to a level at which the distortion ceases.  
Options  
G BC-8 Bench  
A stable, comfortable bench styled to match your Yamaha  
Some items may not be available in  
certain areas.  
Clavinova.  
G HPE-160 Stereo Headphones  
High-performance lightweight dynamic headphones with extra-soft  
ear pads.  
G KC-883 Key Cover for the CVP-59S  
A convenient way to keep your keyboard clean and dust-free.  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
A-B repeat ............................................. 70  
ABC freeze ............................................ 60  
Accompaniment ..................................... 28  
Alert & error displays, custom style ....... 53  
Alert sound .......................................... 109  
All delete, chord sequence .................... 82  
Auto Bass Chord ................................... 34  
Aux in jacks ......................................... 113  
Aux out jacks ....................................... 113  
Initial edit ............................................... 85  
Introduction ............................................ 30  
Reverb type ........................................... 22  
Rewind ................................................... 70  
Rhythm ON/OFF, chord sequence ........ 82  
Right pedal ............................................ 26  
Root, chord ............................................ 80  
A
I
Key Cover ................................................ 3  
Keyboard percussion ............................. 16  
Keyboard utilities ................................... 91  
K
Second voice ......................................... 17  
Send ...................................................... 97  
Send channel ......................................... 94  
Single finger accompaniment ................ 35  
Small ABC ............................................. 39  
Song copy............................................ 102  
Song delete ......................................... 104  
Song list priority ................................... 109  
Song number selection .................... 62, 73  
Song playback ................................. 61, 89  
Song recording ...................................... 72  
Song repeat ........................................... 69  
Sostenuto pedal ..................................... 26  
Sound utilities ........................................ 92  
Split mode.............................................. 19  
Split point ............................................... 21  
Split point, ABC ..................................... 39  
Split voices ............................................ 19  
Start, straight ......................................... 30  
Start, synchronized ................................ 31  
Start, tap ................................................ 31  
Start/stop, MIDI ...................................... 96  
Stop ....................................................... 32  
Store, custom style ................................ 50  
Style clear .............................................. 51  
Style file load ......................................... 55  
Style list ............................................... 120  
Style selection ....................................... 28  
S
LCD buttons ............................................. 8  
Left pedal function ................................. 93  
Left pedal ............................................... 27  
Left pedal, harmony ............................... 43  
Load, registration file ........................... 100  
Local control .......................................... 95  
L
Backup ................................................. 107  
Backup parameter list .......................... 122  
Bank, registration ................................... 59  
Beat display ........................................... 31  
Beat, custom style ................................. 46  
Break, left pedal ..................................... 32  
B
C
Memory backup ..................................... 12  
Messages ............................................ 110  
Metronome ............................................ 33  
Micro tuning ......................................... 104  
Micro tuning disk operations ................ 105  
MIDI 1 utilities ........................................ 94  
MIDI 2 utilities ........................................ 95  
MIDI 3 utilities ........................................ 97  
MIDI connectors .................................. 113  
MIDI data format .................................. 124  
MIDI implementation chart ................... 156  
MIDI reception ....................................... 94  
Mixer button ........................................... 10  
Multi-track recording & playback ........... 75  
Music data, playing other types ............. 71  
Music Stand ............................................. 3  
Mute ....................................................... 64  
M
Center pedal .......................................... 26  
Check play, chord sequence ................. 82  
Chord assist ........................................... 40  
Chord sequence recording .................... 80  
Clock ...................................................... 95  
Connectors .......................................... 113  
Contrast button ...................................... 11  
Control change ...................................... 96  
Custom style .......................................... 45  
Custom style playback ........................... 52  
CVP-59S assembly ............................. 150  
CVP-69/69A assembly ........................ 142  
CVP-79A assembly ............................. 136  
Damper mode (CVP-79A) ..................... 94  
Damper pedal ........................................ 26  
Damper range ........................................ 93  
Delete, chord sequence ....................... 101  
Delete, registration file ........................... 82  
Demo tunes ........................................... 14  
Demonstration Playback ........................ 13  
Detune depth ......................................... 18  
Disk orchestra collection playback ........ 61  
Disk styles, loading ................................ 55  
Disk, custom style .................................. 52  
Display ..................................................... 8  
Display hold button .................................. 9  
Drum/key assignment list .................... 121  
Dual mode ............................................. 17  
D
Name, custom style ............................... 49  
N
O
Octave shift............................................ 91  
One touch setting .................................. 44  
Options ................................................ 114  
Tempo control ........................................ 29  
Time signature, custom style ................. 46  
Total depth, reverb ................................ 23  
Touch sensitivity .................................... 91  
Track delete ........................................... 84  
Track mix ............................................... 83  
Track modes .................................... 73, 75  
Track quantize ....................................... 84  
Tracks, adding new ............................... 77  
Transform ............................................ 101  
Transpose.............................................. 91  
Transpose, MIDI .................................... 97  
Troubleshooting ................................... 114  
Tune ...................................................... 92  
Type, chord............................................ 80  
T
Page buttons ......................................... 10  
Pan ........................................................ 92  
Panel controls .......................................... 4  
Part assignment ..................................... 65  
Part depth, reverb .................................. 23  
Part selection ......................................... 63  
Pause .................................................... 70  
Pedal utilities ......................................... 92  
Phrase repeat ........................................ 69  
Playback start/stop ................................ 62  
Polyphony .............................................. 16  
Popup time .......................................... 109  
Power Switch ........................................... 3  
Precautions.............................................. 2  
Preset recall, effect ................................ 25  
Program change .................................... 96  
Punch-in modes ..................................... 79  
Punch-in/out recording .......................... 78  
P
Effect depth ........................................... 25  
Effect type list ........................................ 24  
Effects, custom style .............................. 51  
End mark, chord sequence .................... 82  
End, chord sequence ............................. 82  
Exit button .............................................. 10  
Expression Pedal ..................................... 7  
Expression pedal jack .......................... 113  
E
F
Utility function selection ......................... 90  
U
V
Voice balance, dual mode ..................... 18  
Voice balance, split mode ...................... 20  
Voice effects .......................................... 24  
Voice list .............................................. 116  
Voice selection ...................................... 15  
Voice selection, song............................. 66  
Volume, ABC/Song............................ 6, 37  
Volume, custom style ............................ 51  
Volume, master ....................................... 6  
Volume, other .......................................... 7  
Volume, part .......................................... 38  
Volume, song ......................................... 65  
Volume, song part ................................. 66  
Fast forward ........................................... 70  
Fill-ins .................................................... 32  
Fingered accompaniment ...................... 36  
Fingering chart ..................................... 123  
Floppy Disk Handling ............................... 2  
Format, disk ........................................... 98  
Full keyboard accompaniment ............... 37  
Quantize, custom style .......................... 48  
Quantize, track ...................................... 84  
Quick recording ..................................... 72  
Q
R
Recall ................................................... 108  
Recall section, custom style .................. 50  
Recording without a disk ....................... 89  
Recording, song .................................... 72  
Registration memory.............................. 58  
Registration recall .................................. 60  
Registration, disk ................................... 99  
Rename, registration file ...................... 100  
Renaming song files .............................. 87  
Repeat ................................................... 69  
Guide modes ......................................... 67  
G
H
Harmony ................................................ 41  
Headphones ............................................ 3  
Help function .......................................... 11  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice List/Stimmenverzeichnis/Liste des voix/  
Bank  
Element  
Program  
Number  
Usable  
Range  
Group  
Piano  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
CVP-59S  
Pan  
MSB LSB  
CVP-79A CVP-69/69A CVP-59S  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
112  
113  
112  
0
1
1
Grand Piano1  
Grand Piano2  
BrightPiano  
Rock Piano  
Mellow Piano  
Elec.Grand  
Piano EP 1  
Piano EP 2  
Honky Tonk  
Elec.Piano  
EP Jazz  
Grand Piano1  
Grand Piano2  
BrightPiano  
Rock Piano  
Mellow Piano  
Grand Piano1  
Grand Piano2  
BrightPiano  
Rock Piano  
Mellow Piano  
c
k
c
c
c
k
k
c
c
c
k
k
c
k
k
c
k
k
k
k
k
c
c
k
c
c
k
c
c
k
c
c
c
k
c
c
k
c
k
c
k
c
k
k
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
2 (S)  
1
2
2
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
F2~F5  
F2~F5  
C3~C7  
C2~C6  
C4~C7  
C3~C5  
C2~C6  
F3~C6  
C3~F4  
C3~C5  
E1~C5  
E1~C5  
E1~C5  
E1~C5  
E1~C5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
E1~D5  
C2~F4  
C2~C5  
D2~G4  
G2~C5  
C2~G4  
1
1
2
2 (S)  
1
2
2
2
1
1
114  
116  
115  
0
1
2 (S)  
2
1
1
3
2
2
3
Piano EP 1  
Piano EP 2  
Honky Tonk  
Elec.Piano  
EP Jazz  
Piano EP 1  
Piano EP 2  
Honky Tonk  
Elec.Piano  
EP Jazz  
2
3
2
2
2
0
4
2
2
2
E.Piano  
0
5
2
2
2
112  
116  
0
5
2
2
2
5
Bell EP  
Bell EP  
Bell EP  
2
2
2
6
DX EP Pop  
DX EP Pop  
DX EP Pop  
2
2
2
115  
116  
117  
117  
112  
113  
115  
116  
0
6
DX EP Modern DX EP Modern DX EP Modern  
1
1
1
6
Mallet EP  
Crystal EP  
Stage EP  
Harpsichord1  
Harpsichord2  
Grand Harpsi  
Harpsi Pop  
Clavi  
Mallet EP  
Crystal EP  
Mallet EP  
Crystal EP  
2
1
1
6
2
2
2
5
2
1
2
Harpsichord  
7
Harpsichord1  
Harpsichord2  
Grand Harpsi  
Harpsichord1  
Harpsichord2  
Grand Harpsi  
1
7
1
1
1
7
2
2
2
7
2
1
1
8
Clavi  
Clavi  
1
0
47  
12  
12  
9
Harp  
Harp  
Harp  
1
1
1
Vibes  
112  
0
Vibes  
Vibes  
Vibes  
2
2
2
Jazz Vibes  
Celesta  
1
1
1
0
Celesta  
Celesta  
1
112  
0
9
Celesta 4ft  
Glockenspiel  
Music Box  
Marimba  
Celesta 4ft  
Glockenspiel  
Music Box  
Marimba  
Xylophone  
TubularBells  
Dulcimer  
Gut Guitar  
Nylon Guitar  
Steel Guitar  
Celesta 4ft  
Glockenspiel  
Music Box  
Marimba  
Xylophone  
TubularBells  
Dulcimer  
Gut Guitar  
Nylon Guitar  
Steel Guitar  
1
1
1
10  
11  
13  
14  
15  
16  
25  
25  
26  
26  
26  
27  
27  
27  
28  
28  
29  
29  
30  
31  
32  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
1
1
1
0
2
2
2
112  
0
1
1
1
Xylophone  
TubularBells  
Dulcimer  
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
2
2
2
Guitar  
112  
0
Gut Guitar  
Nylon Guitar  
Steel Guitar  
Folk Guitar  
12Str Guitar  
J.Gtr Mellow  
Jazz Guitar  
J.Gtr Hard  
Rock Guitar1  
Rock Guitar2  
Mute Guitar  
Pick Guitar  
Ovrdr.Guitar  
Dist.Guitar  
GuitarHarmo.  
Sitar  
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
112  
115  
112  
0
1
1
1
2
J.Gtr Mellow  
Jazz Guitar  
J.Gtr Mellow  
Jazz Guitar  
1
1
1
1
113  
0
1
2
2
Rock Guitar  
Rock Guitar  
2
113  
112  
0
1
1
1
1
Pick Guitar  
Ovrdr.Guitar  
Dist.Guitar  
GuitarHarmo.  
Sitar  
Pick Guitar  
Ovrdr.Guitar  
Dist.Guitar  
GuitarHarmo.  
Sitar  
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
Banjo  
Banjo  
Banjo  
1
1
1
0
Shamisen  
Koto  
Shamisen  
Koto  
Shamisen  
Koto  
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
Kalimba  
Kalimba  
Kalimba  
1
1
1
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lista de voces  
Bank  
Program  
Element  
Usable  
Range  
Group  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
CVP-59S  
Pan  
Number  
MSB LSB  
CVP-79A CVP-69/69A CVP-59S  
Clavi. tone/  
synth  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
112  
0
89  
89  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
102  
93  
95  
97  
97  
98  
99  
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
20  
20  
17  
17  
18  
19  
19  
19  
21  
22  
22  
24  
23  
49  
49  
50  
49  
49  
51  
52  
53  
53  
53  
54  
55  
41  
41  
42  
43  
44  
111  
45  
46  
56  
Clavinova T.  
Clavinova T.  
Clavinova T.  
k
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
k
k
k
k
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
k
c
c
c
c
k
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
k
k
k
k
c
c
c
k
c
c
c
k
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 (S)  
2
2
1
1
2
1
2
1
2
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2 (S)  
1
2
1
1
2
1
2
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
C1~C7  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
G0~C6  
G0~C6  
G0~C6  
C2~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
New Age Pad1 New Age Pad1 New Age Pad1  
New Age Pad2 New Age Pad2 New Age Pad2  
115  
0
Warm Pad  
PolySynthPad  
Choir Pad  
Bowed Pad  
Metallic Pad  
Halo Pad  
Warm Pad  
PolySynthPad  
Choir Pad  
Bowed Pad  
Metallic Pad  
Halo Pad  
Warm Pad  
PolySynthPad  
Choir Pad  
Bowed Pad  
Metallic Pad  
Halo Pad  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sweep Pad  
Cosmic Pad  
Ice Pad  
Sweep Pad  
Cosmic Pad  
Ice Pad  
Sweep Pad  
Cosmic Pad  
Ice Pad  
112  
112  
112  
112  
0
Techno Pad  
SynthCrystal  
Rain  
Techno Pad  
SynthCrystal  
Rain  
Techno Pad  
SynthCrystal  
Rain  
0
SoundTrack  
Crystal  
SoundTrack  
Crystal  
SoundTrack  
Crystal  
0
0
Atmosphere  
Brightness  
Goblins  
Atmosphere  
Brightness  
Goblins  
Atmosphere  
Brightness  
Goblins  
0
0
0
Echoes  
Echoes  
Echoes  
0
Sci-Fi  
Sci-Fi  
Sci-Fi  
Organ  
0
Pipe Organ  
Chapel Organ  
Pipe Organ  
Chapel Organ  
Pipe Organ  
Chapel Organ  
2 (S) C0~C6  
115  
115  
0
1
2
1
1
2
1
2
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
F2~A5  
F2~A5  
F2~F5  
C3~C5  
C0~C6  
C0~C6  
C0~C6  
C0~C6  
C1~C6  
C0~C6  
C0~C6  
E1~E5  
E1~E5  
E1~E5  
C2~G4  
C2~C5  
G2~C6  
G2~C6  
C2~E5  
C1~E4  
E0~G2  
G2~C6  
E0~C6  
C1~C6  
C2~C4  
Draw 16 Organ Draw 16 Organ Draw 16 Organ  
Draw 8 Organ  
Perc. Organ  
Rock Organ  
Trem.Organ 1  
Trem.Organ 2  
Reed Organ  
French Accrd  
Accordion  
Tango Accrd.  
Harmonica  
Orch.Strings  
Strings  
Draw 8 Organ  
Perc. Organ  
Rock Organ  
Draw 8 Organ  
Perc. Organ  
Rock Organ  
0
0
112  
115  
0
Reed Organ  
French Accrd  
Accordion  
Tango Accrd.  
Harmonica  
Orch.Strings  
Strings  
Reed Organ  
French Accrd  
Accordion  
Tango Accrd.  
Harmonica  
Orch.Strings  
Strings  
0
115  
0
0
Strings /  
Choir  
115  
0
0
Strings Slow  
Strings Soft  
Chamber Str  
Syn.Strings1  
Syn.Strings2  
Choir  
Strings Slow  
Strings Soft  
Chamber Str  
Syn.Strings1  
Syn.Strings2  
Choir  
Strings Slow  
Strings Soft  
Chamber Str  
Syn.Strings1  
Syn.Strings2  
Choir  
112  
113  
0
0
115  
112  
0
Chapel Choir  
Synth Choir  
Voice Oohs  
Synth Voice  
Violin 1  
Chapel Choir  
Synth Choir  
Voice Oohs  
Synth Voice  
Chapel Choir  
Synth Choir  
Voice Oohs  
Synth Voice  
0
0
112  
0
Violin 2  
Violin  
Violin  
0
Viola  
Viola  
Viola  
0
Cello  
Cello  
Cello  
0
Contrabass  
Fiddle  
Contrabass  
Fiddle  
Contrabass  
Fiddle  
0
0
Trem.Strings  
Pizzicato  
Trem.Strings  
Pizzicato  
Trem.Strings  
Pizzicato  
0
0
OrchestraHit  
OrchestraHit  
OrchestraHit  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice List / Stimmenverzeichnis / Liste des voix / Lista de voces  
Bank  
Element  
Program  
Number  
Usable  
Range  
Group  
Brass  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
CVP-59S  
Pan  
MSB LSB  
CVP-79A CVP-69/69A CVP-59S  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
115  
112  
0
62  
62  
62  
62  
63  
64  
63  
57  
58  
59  
60  
60  
61  
67  
66  
65  
67  
68  
69  
69  
70  
71  
72  
72  
73  
74  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
110  
112  
81  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
83  
BigBnd Brass  
Brass Sect.1  
Brass Sect.2  
Pop Brass  
Synth Brass1  
Synth Brass2  
Analog Brass  
Trumpet  
c
k
c
k
c
c
k
c
c
c
c
k
c
c
c
c
c
c
k
c
c
c
k
c
c
k
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
k
2
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
A#2~A#5  
A#0~D#4  
F0~G2  
A#2~A#4  
F#2~A5  
F1~F4  
Brass Sect.1  
Brass Sect.2  
Pop Brass  
Synth Brass1  
Synth Brass2  
Brass Sect.1  
Brass Sect.2  
Pop Brass  
Synth Brass1  
Synth Brass2  
113  
0
0
112  
0
Trumpet  
Trumpet  
0
Trombone  
Trombone  
Tuba  
Trombone  
Tuba  
0
Tuba  
0
MuteTrumpet1 MuteTrumpet1 MuteTrumpet1  
MuteTrumpet2 MuteTrumpet2 MuteTrumpet2  
112  
0
French Horn  
Breath Sax  
Alto Sax  
French Horn  
Breath Sax  
Alto Sax  
Soprano Sax  
Tenor Sax  
Baritone Sax  
French Horn  
Breath Sax  
Alto Sax  
Soprano Sax  
Tenor Sax  
Baritone Sax  
Sax / Flute  
115  
0
F#1~D#4  
C#2~G#4  
F#2~D#5  
F#1~D#4  
C#1~G#3  
A#2~G5  
A#2~G5  
E2~A#4  
A#0~F4  
D2~G5  
D2~G5  
D4~C7  
G2~F#6  
C3~C6  
C3~C6  
C3~C6  
C3~C6  
G2~C5  
C3~C6  
C3~C5  
C1~F4  
0
Soprano Sax  
Tenor Sax  
Baritone Sax  
Oboe 1  
0
0
112  
0
Oboe 2  
Oboe  
Oboe  
0
English Horn  
Bassoon  
English Horn  
Bassoon  
English Horn  
Bassoon  
0
112  
0
Clarinet 1  
Clarinet 2  
Piccolo  
Clarinet  
Clarinet  
0
Piccolo  
Piccolo  
112  
0
Flute 1  
Flute 2  
Flute  
Flute  
0
Recorder  
Pan Flute  
Blown Bottle  
Shakuhachi  
Whistle  
Recorder  
Pan Flute  
Blown Bottle  
Shakuhachi  
Whistle  
Recorder  
Pan Flute  
Blown Bottle  
Shakuhachi  
Whistle  
0
0
0
0
0
Ocarina  
Ocarina  
Ocarina  
0
Bagpipe  
Bagpipe  
Shanai  
Bagpipe  
Shanai  
0
Shanai  
C2~C4  
A-1~C7  
A-1~C7  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
C1~C6  
A-1~C7  
C2~C6  
0
Square Lead  
Saw. Lead  
CalliopeLead  
Chiff Lead  
Square Lead  
Saw. Lead  
CalliopeLead  
Chiff Lead  
Square Lead  
Saw. Lead  
CalliopeLead  
Chiff Lead  
0
0
0
0
Charang Lead Charang Lead Charang Lead  
0
Voice Lead  
Fifths Lead  
Bass & Lead  
Synth Wood  
Voice Lead  
Fifths Lead  
Bass & Lead  
Synth Wood  
Voice Lead  
Fifths Lead  
Bass & Lead  
Synth Wood  
0
0
112  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Voice List / Stimmenverzeichnis / Liste des voix / Lista de voces  
Bank  
Element  
Program  
Number  
Usable  
Range  
Group  
Bass  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69/69A  
CVP-59S  
Pan  
MSB LSB  
CVP-79A CVP-69/69A CVP-59S  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
112  
0
33  
33  
Acous.Bass 1  
Acous.Bass 2  
Acous.Bass 3  
E.Bass Slap  
Finger Bass  
Elec.Bass  
Acous.Bass 1  
Acous.Bass 2  
Acous.Bass 3  
E.Bass Slap  
Finger Bass  
Acous.Bass 1  
Acous.Bass 2  
Acous.Bass 3  
E.Bass Slap  
Finger Bass  
k
c
k
k
c
k
k
c
c
c
c
k
c
c
d
d
d
d
d
d
d
d
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
c
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
2
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
1
1
2
2
C0~F#3  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
E0~G2  
*
115  
112  
0
33  
34  
34  
113  
114  
0
34  
34  
Heavy Bass  
Picked Bass  
Fretless  
35  
Picked Bass  
Fretless  
Picked Bass  
Fretless  
0
36  
0
37  
Slap Bass 1  
Slap Bass 2  
Hammer Bass  
Analog Bass  
Synth Bass  
Standard Kit  
Room Kit  
Slap Bass 1  
Slap Bass 2  
Slap Bass 1  
Slap Bass 2  
0
38  
115  
0
37  
39  
Analog Bass  
Synth Bass  
Standard Kit  
Room Kit  
Rock Kit  
Analog Bass  
Synth Bass  
Standard Kit  
Room Kit  
Rock Kit  
0
40  
Drums/Perc. 127  
0
1
127  
127  
127  
127  
127  
127  
127  
0
0
9
*
0
17  
Rock Kit  
*
0
25  
Electro kit  
Electro kit  
Analog Kit  
Jazz Kit  
Electro kit  
Analog Kit  
Jazz Kit  
*
0
26  
Analog Kit  
Jazz Kit  
*
0
33  
*
0
41  
Brush Kit  
Brush Kit  
Brush Kit  
*
0
49  
Classic Kit  
Timpani  
Classic Kit  
Timpani  
Classic Kit  
Timpani  
*
0
48  
E0~C2  
C3~C5  
C2~C5  
C2~C5  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
C3~C4  
0
0
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
128  
126  
127  
Tinkle Bell  
Agogo  
Tinkle Bell  
Agogo  
Tinkle Bell  
Agogo  
0
0
0
0
Steel Drums  
Woodblock  
Taiko Drum  
Melodic Tom  
Synth Drum  
Steel Drums  
Woodblock  
Taiko Drum  
Melodic Tom  
Synth Drum  
Steel Drums  
Woodblock  
Taiko Drum  
Melodic Tom  
Synth Drum  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reverse Cym. Reverse Cym. Reverse Cym.  
0
0
Fret Noise  
Breath Noise  
Seashore  
Bird Tweet  
Telephone  
Gunshot  
Fret Noise  
Breath Noise  
Seashore  
Bird Tweet  
Telephone  
Gunshot  
Fret Noise  
Breath Noise  
Seashore  
Bird Tweet  
Telephone  
Gunshot  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Helicopter  
Applause  
Helicopter  
Applause  
Helicopter  
Applause  
0
0
* Refer to the “Drum/key Assignment List” on page 121.  
* Siehe “Verzeichnis der Schlagzeugklänge” auf Seite 121.  
* Reportez-vous à la “Liste d’assignation instrument de batterie/touche du clavier” donnée à la page 121.  
* Consulte la “Lista de asignaciones de teclas/batería” en la página 121.  
• Bank LSB: “0” refers to GM system level 1 voice allocation. (Some  
GM voices not listed above are not selectable on the panel but  
sound when the corresponding program numbers are received.)  
• Pan: c=Center, k=Keyboard Scaling Pan, d=Drum Kit Pan.  
• Element: (S)=Stereo voice.  
• Bank LSB : “0” concerne l’assignation de voix GM System Level 1.  
(Certaines voix GM ne sont pas indiquées dans la liste ci-dessus et ne  
peuvent pas être sélectionnées au moyen des touches du panneau,  
mais leur son est malgré tout produit à la réception de leur numéro de  
programme.)  
• Pan : c = Centre, k = Panoramique d’échelle du clavier,  
d = Panoramique de kit de batterie.  
• Bank LSB: “0” entspricht der Stimmenzuordnung “GM System  
Level 1”. (Manche der oben aufgeführten GM-Stimmen sind nicht  
über das Bedienfeld wählbar, können jedoch per MIDI-  
Programmwechsel gespielt werden.)  
• Pan: c = Mitte, k = tastenskalierte Verschiebung, d = Schlagzeug-  
Anordnung  
• Element : (S) = Voix stéréo  
• Bank LSB: “0” se refiere a la asignación de voces de nivel 1 del  
sistema GM (algunas voces GM que no se enumeran arriba no pueden  
seleccionarse en el panel, pero suenan cuando se reciben los  
números de programa correspondientes.)  
• Pan: c = central, k = efecto panorámico graduado del teclado,  
d = efecto panorámico de juego de batería.  
• Element: (S) = Stereo-Stimme  
• Element: (S) = voz estereofónica.  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Style List/Rhythmusverzeichnis/  
Liste des styles / Lista de estilos  
Group  
Style Name  
BEAT  
Group  
Style Name  
BEAT  
Group  
Style Name  
March 1  
BEAT  
POP  
Pop Ballad 1  
Pop Ballad 2  
Light Pop  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
BALLAD  
Jazz Ballad1  
Jazz Ballad2  
Slow Rock 1  
Slow Rock 2  
Blues  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
3/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
TRADITIONAL  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
2/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
4/4  
3/4  
3/4  
3/4  
3/4  
3/4  
3/4  
3/4  
3/4  
3/4  
3/4  
March 2  
Polka  
Piano Ballad  
Organ Ballad  
8Beat  
6/8 March  
Tarantella  
BigBandBalad  
Gospel  
Showtune  
Folk  
Show Time  
Overture  
Pop Rhumba  
NewAge  
Enka  
Pops Enka  
Swing  
Ragtime  
16BEAT  
16Bt Ballad1  
16Bt Ballad2  
16Bt Ballad3  
16Beat Pop  
Funk  
JAZZ  
COUNTRY  
Bluegrass  
Cool Jazz  
Uptempo Jazz  
Bigband Jazz  
Dixieland  
Boogie  
8Beat Cntry  
Country Rock  
Country Pop  
Folk Rock  
Fusion  
Country Shfl  
Cntry 2 Step  
Cntry Ballad  
CowboyBoogie  
Trad. Wlatz1  
Trad. Waltz2  
CntryT.Waltz  
Vienna Waltz  
Flamenco  
Fusion Balad  
Fusion Shffl  
Funky Jazz  
Dance Pop1  
Dance Pop2  
Eurobeat  
Charleston  
2Beat Swing  
Foxtrot  
DANCE POP  
Trad. Swing  
Rhumba 1  
Rhumba 2  
Mambo  
WALTZ  
LATIN  
Techno  
Synth Boogie  
Disco Soul  
Party Pop  
Tropical  
Tango  
Cha Cha  
Bolero  
Jazz Waltz  
Swing Waltz  
Cntry Waltz  
Slow Waltz  
Gospel Waltz  
Beguine  
ROCK  
Upbeat Pop  
Rock Ballad  
Rock & Roll  
Rock Shuffle  
Pop Shuffle  
Jazz Rock  
Twist  
Merengue  
Son  
LATIN POP  
Bossanova1  
Bossanova2  
Pop Bossa  
Reggae  
Pop Reggae  
Samba 1  
Samba 2  
Jazz Samba  
Salsa  
Soul  
Rhythm&Blues  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drum/key Assignment List / Verzeichnis der Schlagzeugklänge /  
Liste d’assignation instrument de batterie/touche du clavier /  
Lista de asignaciones de teclas/batería  
Keyboard  
MIDI  
Key Alternate  
Standard Kit  
Room Kit  
Rock Kit  
Electro Kit  
Analog Kit  
Jazz Kit  
Brush Kit  
Classic Kit  
Note  
C#1  
D1  
Note# Note off assign  
13 C#-1  
14 D-1  
15 D#-1  
16 E-1  
17 F-1  
18 F#-1  
19 G-1  
20 G#-1  
21 A-1  
22 A#-1  
23 B-1  
24 C0  
25 C#0  
26 D0  
27 D#0  
28 E0  
29 F0  
30 F#0  
31 G0  
32 G#0  
33 A0  
34 A#0  
35 B0  
36 C1  
37 C#1  
38 D1  
39 D#1  
40 E1  
41 F1  
42 F#1  
43 G1  
44 G#1  
45 A1  
46 A#1  
47 B1  
48 C2  
49 C#2  
50 D2  
51 D#2  
52 E2  
53 F2  
54 F#2  
55 G2  
56 G#2  
57 A2  
58 A#2  
59 B2  
60 C3  
61 C#3  
62 D3  
63 D#3  
64 E3  
65 F3  
66 F#3  
67 G3  
68 G#3  
69 A3  
70 A#3  
71 B3  
72 C4  
73 C#4  
74 D4  
75 D#4  
76 E4  
77 F4  
78 F#4  
79 G4  
80 G#4  
81 A4  
82 A#4  
83 B4  
84 C5  
3
3
Surdo Mute  
Surdo Open  
Hi Q  
Whip Slap  
Scratch Push <——  
Scratch Pull  
Finger Snap  
Click Noise  
Metronome Click <——  
Metronome Bell <——  
Seq Click L  
Seq Click H  
Brush Tap  
Brush Swirl L <——  
Brush Slap <——  
Brush Swirl H <——  
Snare Roll  
Castanet  
Snare L  
Sticks  
Bass Drum L  
Open Rim Shot <——  
Bass Drum M <——  
Bass Drum H BD Room  
Side Stick  
Snare M  
Hand Clap  
Snare H  
Floor Tom L  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
SD Rock M  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Brush Slap L  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
BD Soft  
<——  
Brush Slap  
<——  
Brush Tap  
Brush Tom 1  
<——  
Brush Tom 2  
<——  
Brush Tom 3  
<——  
Brush Tom 4  
Brush Tom 5  
<——  
Brush Tom 6  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Gran Cassa  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Jazz Tom 1  
<——  
Jazz Tom 2  
<——  
Jazz Tom 3  
<——  
Jazz Tom 4  
Jazz Tom 5  
Hand Cym.Open L  
Jazz Tom 6  
Hand Cym.Closed L  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Hand Cym.Open H  
<——  
Hand Cym.Closed H  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
D#1  
E1  
F1  
4
4
F#1  
G1  
G#1  
A1  
<——  
<——  
<——  
A#1  
B1  
<——  
<——  
<——  
C2  
C#2  
D2  
O
D#2  
E2  
F2  
O
O
Reverse Cymbal Reverse Cymbal <——  
<——  
Hi Q  
Snare M  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Hi Q  
SD Rock H  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
F#2  
G2  
G#2  
A2  
Bass Drum M Bass Drum H 4 Bass Drum M <——  
<——  
Bass Drum H 3 BD Rock  
BD Rock  
<——  
SD Rock  
<——  
SD Rock Rim SD Rock H  
Rock Tom 1  
<——  
Rock Tom 2  
<——  
Rock Tom 3  
<——  
Rock Tom 4  
Rock Tom 5  
<——  
Rock Tom 6  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
A#2  
<——  
<——  
BD Analog L  
BD Analog H  
Analog Side Stick <——  
Analog Snare L <——  
<——  
Analog Snare H <——  
Analog Tom 1 Jazz Tom 1  
Analog HH Closed 1 <——  
Analog Tom 2 Jazz Tom 2  
Analog HH Closed 2 <——  
Analog Tom 3 Jazz Tom 3  
Analog HH Open <——  
<——  
<——  
BD Jazz  
B2  
C3  
BD Gate  
<——  
SD Rock L  
<——  
C#3  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
D3  
D#3  
E3  
F3  
<——  
Room Tom 1  
E Tom 1  
<——  
E Tom 2  
<——  
E Tom 3  
<——  
E Tom 4  
E Tom 5  
<——  
E Tom 6  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
F#3  
1
1
1
Hi-Hat Closed <——  
G3  
Floor Tom H  
Hi-Hat Pedal  
Low Tom  
Hi-Hat Open  
Mid Tom L  
Mid Tom H  
Room Tom 2  
<——  
Room Tom 3  
<——  
Room Tom 4  
Room Tom 5  
G#3  
A3  
A#3  
B3  
Analog Tom 4 Jazz Tom 4  
Analog Tom 5 Jazz Tom 5  
Analog Cymbal <——  
C4  
C#4  
Crash Cymbal 1 <——  
High Tom  
D4  
Room Tom 6  
Analog Tom 6 Jazz Tom 6  
D#4  
E4  
F4  
F#4  
G4  
G#4  
A4  
Ride Cymbal 1 <——  
Chinese Cymbal <——  
Ride Cymbal Cup <——  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal <——  
Cowbell <——  
Crash Cymbal 2 <——  
Vibraslap <——  
Ride Cymbal 2 <——  
Bongo H  
Bongo L  
Conga H Mute <——  
Conga H Open <——  
Conga L  
Timbale H  
Timbale L  
Agogo H  
Agogo L  
Cabasa  
Maracas  
Samba Whistle H <——  
Samba Whistle L <——  
Guiro Short  
Guiro Long  
Claves  
Wood Block H <——  
Wood Block L <——  
Cuica Mute  
Cuica Open  
Triangle Mute <——  
Triangle Open <——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Analog Cowbell <——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Analog Conga H <——  
Analog Conga M <——  
Analog Conga L <——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
A#4  
B4  
C5  
<——  
<——  
C#5  
D5  
D#5  
E5  
F5  
F#5  
G5  
G#5  
A5  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
A#5  
Analog Maracas <——  
B5  
O
O
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Analog Claves <——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
C6  
C#6  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
D6  
O
D#6  
E6  
F6  
<——  
<——  
F#6  
<——  
<——  
Scratch Push Scratch Push <——  
Scratch Pull  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
G6  
Scratch Pull  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
G#6  
A6  
2
2
A#6  
Shaker  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
<——  
<——  
<——  
B6  
C7  
<——  
“<——” indique que le contenu est le même que celui de “Standard Kit”.  
“<——” indicates the content is the same as that of Standard Kit.  
Les voix “Drum Kit” répondent aux et transmettent les numéros de note MIDI  
correspondant.  
The Drum Kit voices respond to and transmit the corresponding MIDI note  
numbers.  
Key off : Le son produit par les touches marquées “ O” cesse à l’instant où la  
Key Off: Keys marked “ O” stop sounding the instant they are released.  
touche est relâchée.  
Alternate Assign: Playing any instrument within a numbered group will imme-  
diately stop the sound of any other instrument in the same group of the same  
number.  
Alternate Assign : Le fait de jouer un instrument appartenant à un groupe ayant  
un numéro arrête immédiatement le son de tout autre instrument appartenant à  
un groupe ayant le même numéro.  
“<——” bedeutet “wie Standard Kit”.  
“<——” indica que el contenido es el mismo que el del juego estándar.  
Die Schlagzeug-Stimmen sprechen auf MIDI-Notennummern an und  
übertragen entsprechende Nummern.  
Las voces del juego de batería responden a los números de notas MIDI  
correspondientes y los transmiten.  
Key Off: Durch “ O” gekennzeichnete Klänge verstummen beim Loslassen der  
Key Off: Las teclas marcadas con “ O” dejan de sonar en el momento en que se  
Taste.  
sueltan.  
Alternate Assign: Mit derselben Nummer gekennzeichnete Klänge werden von  
demselben Instrument erzeugt und können daher nicht gleichzeitig produziert  
werden. Spielt einer dieser Klänge gerade, wird er beim Anschlagen einer  
anderen Taste mit derselben “Alternate Assign”-Nummer stummgeschaltet.  
Alternate Assign: Al tocar algún instrumento con un grupo numerado detendrá  
inmediatamente el sonido de cualquier otro instrumento del mismo grupo con el  
mismo número.  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Backed Up Parameters/ Dauerhaft gespeicherte Parameter/  
Paramètres sauvegardés / Parámetros respaldados  
Backup Recall Default  
Backup Recall Default  
VOICE SETTING  
Keyboard Voice  
Keyboard Volume  
Split Point  
Backup Off  
Program Change Send  
& Receive/Off  
O
O
O
O
O
O
Send & Receive  
Send & Receive  
Send & Receive  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Grand Piano 1  
Control Change Send  
& Receive/Off  
100  
F#2  
Off  
Start/Stop Command  
Send & Receive/Off  
Dual Mode  
Split Mode  
Off  
Transpose Receive On/Off  
Transpose Send On/Off  
ABC & Rhythm Send On/Off  
Harmony Send On/Off  
TUNE/MICRO TUNING  
Tune  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
On  
Dual Voice  
Strings Slow  
Off  
Split Voice  
Acous. Bass 1  
Off  
Dual Balance  
Split Balance  
Dual Detune Depth  
Reverb On/Off  
Reverb Type  
Center  
Center  
5
Off  
Backup Off  
O
O
440.0  
On  
Micro-tuning  
0
Hall 1  
50  
PEDAL  
Backup Off  
Reverb Depth  
(Total, Rhythm, Bass,  
Chord, Keyboard)  
Left Pedal Function  
Damper Range  
O
O
O
Soft  
R
Damper Mode (CVP-79A)  
POPUP & ALERT  
Voice/Style Popup Time  
Others Popup Time  
Alert Voice  
Continuous  
Backup On  
8
Effect On/Off  
Effect Type  
O
O
O
O
O
O
Preset for each voice  
Preset for each voice  
O
O
O
O
Effect Depth  
(Main Voice)  
(Dual Voice, Split Voice)  
Preset for each voice  
50  
8
Steel Drums  
50  
Touch Sensitivity  
Right/1 Octave Shift  
Left Octave Shift  
2nd Octave Shift  
Right/1 Pan  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Normal  
Alert Volume  
0
ABC MODE  
Backup On  
Single Finger  
Backup On  
+1  
ABC Mode  
O
O
O
O
0
REGISTRATION  
ALL SETUP  
Center  
Left Pan  
Center  
*
*
“REGISTRATION” includes all of the panel setup data in the 25 or 15 Registration memories.  
See page 58 for a list of data contained in the Registration memory.  
“ALL SETUP” includes all of the above parameters (including the “—” marked parameters)  
and REGISTRATION data.  
2nd Pan  
Center  
Transpose  
0
Voice within each group  
STYLE SETTING  
ABC On/Off  
First voice within each group  
*
“REGISTRATION” schließt alle Bedienfeld-Setups in den 25 bzw. 15 Registration-  
Speicherplätzen mit ein. Eine Liste der in den Registration-Setups gespeicherten Daten  
finden Sie auf Seite 58.  
“ALL SETUP” schließt alle der obigen Parameter (auch die mit “—” markierten) sowie  
REGISTRATION-Daten mit ein.  
Backup Off  
*
*
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Off  
Small ABC On/Off  
Harmony On/Off  
Harmony Type  
Style  
Off  
“REGISTRATION” comprend toutes les données de réglage de panneau contenues dans les  
25 ou 15 emplacements de mémoire de registration. La liste des données contenues dans la  
mémoire de registration est donnée à la page 58.  
“ALL SETUP” comprend tous les paramètres et données de registration mentionnés ci-  
dessus, (y compris les paramètres indiqués par “—”).  
Off  
Trio  
*
*
Pop Ballad 1  
“REGISTRATION” incluye todos los datos de ajustes del panel de las 25 ó 15 memorias de  
registros. Vea la página 58 para encontrar la lista de los datos contenidos en la memoria de  
registros.  
“ALL SETUP” incluye todos los parámetros de arriba (incluyendo los parámetros marcados  
con “—”) y los datos de REGISTRATION.  
Main A/B  
Main A  
Tempo  
Preset for each style  
*
Rhythm Volume  
Bass Volume  
Chord Volume  
Pad Volume  
90  
90  
90  
90  
Phrase Volume  
Harmony Volume  
Metronome  
90  
The LCD contrast, help language and this backup on/off setting itself are always backed up.  
The initial LCD contrast, help language and this backup on/off setting itself are not recalled by  
the recall function. These and all other settings can be reset to the initial factory values by  
turning the power on while holding the C7 key.  
90  
Normal  
Default Values: LCD contrast= 10, Help language= English  
One Touch Setting  
Setup Selection  
(CVP-79A/69/69A)  
First setup in the list  
Die Displaykontrasteinstellung, die Spracheneinstellung sowie die BACKUP-Einstellungen  
werden in jedem Fall dauerhaft gespeichert.  
Die Displaykontrasteinstellung, die Spracheneinstellung sowie die BACKUP-Einstellung  
selbst sind von der Rücksetzung durch die RECALL-Funktion ausgeschlossen. Diese und  
alle anderen Einstellungen können auf die werkseitigen Standardwerte rückgesetzt werden,  
indem Sie das Instrument bei gedrückt gehaltener C7-Taste einschalten.  
Standardwerte: Displaykontrast = 10, Sprache für Help-Text = Englisch.  
Style within each group  
SONG SETTING  
Song List Priority  
Guide Mode  
O
O
First style within each group  
Backup Off  
O
O
O
O
O
O
DOC  
Les réglages de contraste de l’affichage, de langue de la fonction Aide et de la fonction  
“Backup” sont toujours conservés en mémoire.  
Le contraste de l’affichage, la langue de la fonction Aide et les réglages de la fonction  
“Backup” d’origine ne peuvent pas être rappelés en utilisant la fonction de remise à l’état  
initial “RECALL”. Ces réglages, comme tous les autres réglages, peuvent être rétablis en  
mettant l’instrument sous tension tout en maintenant enfoncée la touche du clavier C7.  
Default Values: LCD contrast= 10, Help language= English  
Next Note  
Part Assign  
Part1=Track1, Part2=Off  
MIDI  
Backup Off  
1 ch  
Send Channel Right/1  
Send Channel Left  
Local On/Off  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Los ajustes del contraste del LCD, del idioma de ayuda y este ajuste de activación/  
desactivación de respaldo siempre están respaldados.  
Los ajustes iniciales del contraste del LCD, del idioma de ayuda y los ajustes de arriba de  
activación/desactivación de respaldo no se activan con esta función. Estos y otros ajustes  
podrá reponerse a sus valores iniciales de fábrica conectando la alimentación mientras se  
mantiene presionada la tecla C7.  
Off  
On  
Clock Internal/External  
Internal  
Valores de ajuste de fábrica: Contraste del LCD = 10, idioma de ayuda = Inglés  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fingering Chart/Akkordkiste/  
Tablature / Gráfica de digitado  
* All fingerings shown are simple root-position types.  
* Die hier gezeigten Akkorde sind jeweils die Grundakkorde.  
* Tous les doigtés indiqués sont du type à position fondamentale simple.  
* Todos los digitados se muestran como tipos de posición de raíz sencilla.  
Example for “C” chords  
Beispiele für “C”-Akkorde  
Exemples d’accords en “C”  
Ejemplo de acordes “C”  
(b5)  
(#11)  
CM  
C
C
CM  
CM  
6
7
7
7
(b5)  
(9)  
(9)  
Cadd  
CM  
CM  
C
6
C
Caug  
9
7
(#5)  
(#5)  
C
Cm  
Cm  
Cm  
Cm  
Cm  
Cm  
7
7
6
7
(b5)  
(9)  
(11)  
7
(b5)  
Cm  
Cmadd  
CmM  
9
7
7
7
(b5)  
(9)  
CmM  
CmM  
Cdim  
7
C
7
7
7
(b5)  
7
(9)  
(#11)  
(13)  
C sus  
7
C
C
C
C
C
C
7
7
7
7
4
(b9)  
(#9)  
(b13)  
C
7
Csus  
4
7
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MIDI Data Format/MIDI-Datenformat/Format des  
If you’re already very familiar with MIDI, or are using a computer to control your music hardware with computer-gen-  
erated MIDI messages, the data provided in this section can help you to control the Clavinova.  
Falls Sie bereits mit MIDI vertraut sind oder einen Computer zur Hardware-Steuerung einsetzen, werden Ihnen die  
nachfolgend aufgeführten Daten bei der Steuerung des Clavinovas wahrscheinlich hilfreich sein.  
Si vous vous êtes déjà familiarisés avec l’interface MIDI, ou si vous utilisez un ordinateur pour commander votre  
matériel de musique au moyen de messages MIDI générés par ordinateur, les données suivantes vous aideront à  
commander le Clavinova.  
Si ya está muy familiarizado con MIDI o si está usando una computadora para controlar su música con mensajes  
MIDI generados por computadora, los datos proporcionados en esta sección le ayudarán a controlar la Clavinova.  
The Clavinova corresponds to a portion of the XG format, the Clavinova does not perfectly correspond to all XG  
parameters.  
1.2.10 Harmonic Content  
1. Channel Messages  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
1.1 Key On and Key Off  
71  
Harmonic Content  
(0:-64, 64:+0, 127:+63)  
Receivable note range: C-2 to G8 (true voice A-1 to C7)  
Velocity range: 1 to 127 (Value accepted only at Note On)  
Applies adjustment to the resonance value set by the voice. This parameter  
specifies relative change, with value 64 producing zero adjustment. As values  
get higher the sound becomes increasingly eccentric. Note that for some voices  
the effective parameter range is narrower than the legal parameter range.  
1.2 Control Change  
If the Control Change Filter in Function [MIDI 2] is set to “ON” transmission and  
reception are disabled.  
1.2.11 Release Time  
Cntrl# Parameter  
72 Release Time  
Data Range  
0...127  
1.2.1 Bank Select  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
(0:-64, 64:+0, 127:+63)  
0
32  
Bank Select MSB  
Bank Select LSB  
0:Normal, 127:Drum  
0...127  
Applies adjustment to the envelope release time set by the voice.  
This parameter specifies relative change, with value 64 producing zero  
adjustment.  
A new bank selection does not become effective until receipt of the next  
Program Change message.  
1.2.12 Attack Time  
1.2.2 Modulation  
Cntrl# Parameter  
73 Attack Time  
Data Range  
0...127  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Modulation  
Data Range  
0...127  
1
(0:-64, 64:+0, 127:+63)  
Applies adjustment to the envelope attack time set by the voice.  
This parameter specifies relative change, with value 64 producing zero  
1.2.3 Data Entry  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
0...127  
adjustment.  
6
Data Entry MSB  
Data Entry LSB  
Depending on the particular voice type, Attack Time data will have little or no  
affect.  
38  
Sets the value for the parameter specified by RPN/NRPN.  
1.2.13 Brightness  
1.2.4 Main Volume  
Cntrl# Parameter  
74 Brightness  
Data Range  
0...127  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
(0:-64, 64:+0, 127:+63)  
7
Volume MSB  
Applies adjustment to the cutoff frequency set by the voice. This parameter  
specifies relative change, with value 64 producing zero adjustment. Lower  
voices produce a softer sound. For some voices the effective parameter range is  
narrower than the legal parameter range.  
1.2.5 Pan  
Cntrl# Parameter  
10  
Data Range  
0...127  
Panpot MSB  
0 = left; 127 = right  
1.2.14 Portamento Control  
1.2.6 Expression  
Cntrl# Parameter  
84 Portamento Control  
Data Range  
0...127  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
11  
Expression MSB  
Message should be sent with Note On already sounding. The data value sets  
the portamento source key number.  
The channel with change from the currently sounding pitch to the next  
received Note-On key using Portamento Time of 0.  
1.2.7 Damper  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
64  
Damper MSB  
1.2.15 Effect1 Depth ( Reverb Send Level )  
Half pedal continuous data is received and accepted.  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
91  
Effect1 Depth  
1.2.8 Sostenuto  
Adjusts the reverb send level.  
Cntrl# Parameter  
66 Sostenuto  
Data Range  
0...127  
1.2.16 Effect3 Depth ( Chorus Send Level )  
(0-63:off, 64-127:on)  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
1.2.9 Soft Pedal  
93  
Effect3 Depth  
Cntrl# Parameter  
67 Soft Pedal  
Data Range  
0...127  
Adjusts the chorus send level.  
Half pedal continuous data is received and accepted.  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
donées MIDI / Formato de datos MIDI  
1.2.17 Effect4 Depth ( Variation Effect Send Level )  
$1D $rr $mm  
$1E $rr $mm  
$1F $rr $mm  
Drum Instrument Reverb Send Level  
mm : $00 - $7F (0 to Max)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
Cntrl# Parameter  
94 Effect4 Depth  
Data Range  
0...127  
when Variation Connection = 1 (System)  
Drum Instrument Chorus Send Level  
mm : $00 - $7F (0 to Max)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
Adjusts the variation effect send level. Not effective if “Variation Connection”  
is set to 0 (Insertion).  
Drum Instrument Variation Send Level  
mm : $00 - $7F (0 to Max)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
1.2.18 Data Increment / Decrement (for RPN)  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
0...127  
96  
97  
RPN Increment  
RPN Decrement  
The LSB 14H-1FH (for drums) message will be accepted under the following  
conditions, the channel must be set to the drum mode, and drum setups 1 or 2  
must be set to that channel. (Default = drum setup 1.)  
The data byte has no meaning.  
Note: The CVP 79A/69/69A/59S contain 3 drum setups (1 Preset Drum &  
Drum Setup 1, 2). Preset Drum being the preset drum setup, its  
parameters cannot be rewritten.  
This message adds or subtracts 1 to/from the Pitchbend Sensitivity, Fine Tune,  
and Coarse Tune MSBs. Note that the Increment (Decrement) message will not  
change a setting that has already reached its maximum (minimum) value.  
Incrementation or decrementation of the Fine Tune value never carries over to  
the Coarse Tune value.  
1.2.20 RPN (Registered parameter number)  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
0...127  
1.2.19 NRPN (Nonregistered parameter number)  
100  
101  
RPN LSB  
RPN MSB  
Cntrl# Parameter  
Data Range  
0...127  
Default:7F 7FH  
98  
99  
RPN LSB  
RPN MSB  
0...127  
The following parameters are supported.  
First send the NPRN MSB and LSB to select the control parameter, then set  
the value by Data Entry.  
The following NRPN values are supported.  
NRPN  
MSBLSB MSB  
Data entry  
Parameter Data Range  
-- Pitchbend Sensitivity  
00H 00H mmH  
NRPN  
MSBLSB MSB  
Data entry  
mm: 00-0cH(0-12 semitones:1 octave)  
Can be set up 1 octave, in semitone units.  
Default: 02H  
Parameter Data Range  
$01 $08 $mm  
$01 $09 $mm  
$01 $0A $mm  
$01 $20 $mm  
$01 $21 $mm  
$01 $63 $mm  
$01 $64 $mm  
$01 $66 $mm  
$14 $rr $mm  
Vibrato Rate  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
LSB is ignored.  
00H 01H mmH  
00H 02H mmH  
11H  
Fine Tuning  
Vibrato Depth  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
mm:00H-40H-7FH(-64-0-+63)  
--  
Course Tuning  
mm:28H - 40H - 58H(-24-+24 semitones)  
LSB is ignored.  
Vibrato Delay  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
Filter Cutoff Freq.  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
7FH 7FH -- --  
RPN Null  
Clears current RPN and NRPN number settings. Does  
not change internal parameter settings.  
Filter Resonance  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
EG Attack Time  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
1.2.21 Channel Mode Messages  
The following Channel Mode messages are supported. (But the actual mode is fixed to  
Poly and can not be changed.)  
EG Decay Time  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
2nd byte 3rd byte  
EG Release Time  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
120  
121  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
0
0
0
0
All Sound Off  
Reset All Controllers  
All Notes Off  
Omni Off  
Omni On  
Mono  
Drum Filter Cutoff Freq.  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
0
0 ~ 16  
0
$15 $rr $mm  
$16 $rr $mm  
$17 $rr $mm  
Drum Filter Resonance  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
Poly  
Drum EG Attack Rate  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
1.2.21.1 All Sound Off  
Switches off all sound from the channel. Does not reset Note On and Hold On  
conditions established by Channel Messages.  
Drum EG Decay Rate  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
(Effects both Decay 1 and Decay 2)  
1.2.21.2 Reset All Controllers  
Resets controllers as follows.  
$18 $rr $mm  
$19 $rr $mm  
$1A $rr $mm  
$1C $rr $mm  
Drum Instrument Pitch Coarse  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
Controller  
Value  
+-0 (center)  
0 (off)  
127 (max)  
0 (off)  
0 (off)  
0 (off)  
Pitchbend change  
Modulation  
Expression  
Damper Pedal  
Sostenuto  
Soft Pedal  
Portamento Control  
RPN  
Drum Instrument Pitch Fine  
mm : $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
Drum Instrument Level  
mm : $00 - $7F (0 to Max)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
Resets portamento source note number  
Sets number to null. (Internal data remains unchanged.)  
Sets number to null. (Internal data remains unchanged.)  
NRPN  
Drum Instrument Panpot  
mm : $00, $01 - $40 - $7F (Random, L C R)  
rr : drum instrument note number  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MIDI Data Format / MIDI-Datenformat/ Format des donées MIDI / Formato de datos MIDI  
1.2.21.3 All Notes Off  
2.1.3 Universal Non-Realtime Message  
2.1.3.1 General MIDI Mode On  
Switches off all of the channel’s “on” notes. Any notes being held by HOLD1 or  
SOSTENUTO continue to sound until HOLD1/SOSTENUTO goes off.  
11110000  
01111110  
01111111  
00001001  
00000001  
11110111  
or  
F0  
7E  
7F  
09  
01  
F7  
= Exclusive status  
= Universal Non-Realtime  
= ID of target device  
= Sub-ID #1=General MIDI Message  
= Sub-ID #2=General MIDI On  
= End of Exclusive  
1.2.21.4 Omni Off  
Same processing as for All Notes Off.  
1.2.21.5 Omni On  
Same processing as for All Notes Off.  
11110000  
01111110  
0xxxnnnn  
F0  
7E  
XN  
= Exclusive status  
= Universal Non-Realtime  
1.2.21.6 Mono  
=
When N is received N=0~F, whichever is received.  
X = don't care  
Same processing as for All Sound Off.  
00001001  
00000001  
11110111  
09  
01  
F7  
= Sub-ID #1=General MIDI Message  
= Sub-ID #2=General MIDI On  
= End of Exclusive  
1.2.21.7 Poly  
Same processing as for All Sound Off.  
When the General MIDI mode ON message is received, the MIDI system will  
be reset to its default settings.  
This message requires approximately 50ms to execute, so sufficient time  
should be allowed before the next message is sent.  
1.3 Program Change  
If the Program Change Filter in Function [MIDI 2] is set to “ON” transmission and  
reception are disabled.  
1.4 Pitchbend  
2.1.4 XG Native Parameter Change  
11110000  
01000011  
0001nnnn  
F0  
43  
1n  
Exclusive status  
YAMAHA ID  
When n is received n=0~F, whichever is received.  
When n is transmitted n always=0.  
Model ID of XG  
Address High  
Address Mid  
Address Low  
2. System Exclusive Messages  
01001100  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
0ddddddd  
|
4C  
2.1 Parameter Change  
aaaaaaa  
aaaaaaa  
aaaaaaa  
ddddddd  
|
The CVP 79A/69/69A/59S models support the following Parameter Change messages.  
[UNIVERSAL REALTIME MESSAGE ]  
1) Master Volume  
Data  
11110111  
F7  
End of Exclusive  
[UNIVERSAL NON-REALTIME MESSAGE ]  
3) General MIDI Mode On  
Data size must match parameter size (2 or 4 bytes).  
[XG NATIVE ]  
1) XG System on  
2) XG System Data parameter change  
3) Multi Effect1 Data parameter change  
4) Drum Setup Data parameter change  
2.1.4.1 XG System On  
11110000 F0  
Exclusive status  
YAMAHA ID  
01000011  
0001nnnn  
43  
1N  
When N is received N=0~F, whichever is received.  
When N is transmitted N always=0.  
Model ID of XG  
Address High  
Address Mid  
Address Low  
Data  
End of Exclusive  
[Others]  
1) Master tuning  
2) Channel Detune  
3) Volume & Expression Realtime Control off  
01001100  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
00000000  
11110111  
4C  
00  
00  
7E  
00  
F7  
2.1.2 Universal Realtime Message  
When the XG System On message is received, the MIDI system will be reset  
to its default settings.  
The message requires approximately 50ms to execute, so sufficient time should  
be allowed before the next message is sent.  
2.1.2.1 Master Volume  
11110000  
01111111  
01111111  
00000100  
00000001  
0sssssss  
0ttttttt  
F0  
7F  
7F  
04  
= Exclusive status  
= Universal Realtime  
= ID of target device  
= Sub-ID #1=Device Control Message  
= Sub-ID #2=Master Volume  
= Volume LSB  
01  
2.1.4.2 XG System Data parameter change  
*SS  
TT  
F7  
See Tables 1-1, 1-2.  
= Volume MSB  
= End of Exclusive  
11110111  
or  
2.1.4.3 Multi Effect1 Data parameter change  
11110000  
01111111  
0xxxnnnn  
F0  
7F  
XN  
= Exclusive status  
= Universal Realtime  
See Tables 1-1, 1-3.  
=
When N is received N=0~F, whichever is received.  
x = don't care  
2.1.4.4 Multi Part Data parameter change  
See Tables 1-1, 1-4.  
00000100  
00000001  
0sssssss  
0ttttttt  
04  
01  
SS  
TT  
F7  
= Sub-ID #1=Device Control Message  
= Sub-ID #2=Master Volume  
= Volume LSB  
= Volume MSB  
= End of Exclusive  
2.1.4.5 Drum Setup Data parameter change  
See Tables 1-1, 1-5.  
11110111  
If operation is in XG mode, this message reinitializes all drum setup parameters.  
The drum setup will not be reset if any changes are made from the CVP 79A/69/69A/  
59S front panel.  
The volume for all channels will be changed.  
*Hexadecimal representation of 0sssss ss. (Same below)  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.1.5 Other Parameter Changes  
2.2.1.1 XG System Data bulk dump  
2.1.5.1 Master Tuning  
See Tables 1-1, 1-2.  
11110000  
01000011  
0001nnnn  
F0  
43  
1n  
Exclusive status  
YAMAHA ID  
When n is received n=0~F, whichever is received.  
2.2.1.2 Multi Effect1 Data bulk dump  
See Tables 1-1, 1-3.  
When n is transmitted n always=0.  
00100111  
00000001  
00000000  
00000000  
27  
30  
00  
00  
Model ID  
Sub ID  
2.2.1.3 Drums Setup Data bulk dump  
See Tables 1-1, 1-5.  
2.3 Parameter Request  
0mmmmmmm mm  
Master Tune MSB  
Master Tune LSB  
The CVP 79A/69/69A/59S models support the following request for  
parameters covered by Parameter Change specifications.  
0lllllll  
0ccccccc  
11110111  
ll  
cc  
F7  
End of Exclusive  
11110000  
01000011  
0011nnnn  
F0  
43  
3n  
Exclusive status  
YAMAHA ID  
When n is received n=0~F, whichever is received.  
When n is transmitted n always=0.  
Model ID of XG  
Address High  
Address Mid  
Address Low  
End of Exclusive  
Changes tuning of all channels.  
2.1.5.2 Channel Detune  
11110000 F0  
01001100  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
11110111  
4C  
Exclusive status  
YAMAHA ID  
Clavinova ID  
CVP-79A/69/69A/59S ID  
Sub ID  
n = MIDI Channel  
Dual Detune  
Value vv: $00 - $40 - $7F (-64 - 0 - +63)  
End of Exclusive  
aaaaaaa  
aaaaaaa  
aaaaaaa  
F7  
01000011  
0001nnnn  
00111001  
00010001  
0000nnnn  
01000011  
0vvvvvvv  
11110111  
43  
73  
39  
11  
0n  
43  
vv  
F7  
If the parameter’s data size is 2 or 4. The Parameter Request address for that  
parameter is the first byte of the bulk.  
2.4 Dump Request  
The CVP 79A/69/69A/59S models support the following request for data  
covered by bulk dump.  
The Channel Detune message only affects the specified channel.  
2.1.5.3 Volume and Expression Realtime Control Off  
11110000  
01000011  
0010nnnn  
F0  
43  
2n  
Exclusive status  
YAMAHA ID  
When n is received n=0~F, whichever is received.  
When n is transmitted n always=0.  
Model ID of XG  
Address High  
Address Mid  
Address Low  
End of Exclusive  
11110000  
01000011  
0001nnnn  
00111001  
00010001  
0000nnnn  
01000101  
0vvvvvvv  
11110111  
F0  
43  
73  
39  
11  
0n  
45  
vv  
F7  
Exclusive status  
YAMAHA ID  
Clavinova ID  
CVP-79A/69/69A/59S ID  
Sub ID  
01001100  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
11110111  
4C  
aaaaaaa  
aaaaaaa  
aaaaaaa  
F7  
n = MIDI Channel  
Volume and Expression Realtime Control Off  
Value vv: $00:Off $7F:On  
End of Exclusive  
For more information on the “Address” field, refer to the attached table.  
In the attached tables “TOTAL SIZE” partitions a data series into single bulk  
dumps. The “address” is the first byte of the bulk data.  
When “On” is received subsequent volume and expression changes are only  
valid during key on. Normal operation resumes when “Off” is received.  
2.2 Bulk Dump  
The CVP 79A/69/69A/59S models support the following parameters.  
3. Realtime Messages  
[XG NATIVE ]  
1) XG System Data  
2) Multi Effect1 Data  
3) Drums Setup Data  
3.1 Active Sensing  
a) Transmission  
Transmitted approximately once every 200msec.  
2.2.1 XG Native Bulk Data  
11110000  
01000011  
0000nnnn  
F0  
43  
0n  
Exclusive status  
YAMAHA ID  
When n is received n=0~F, whichever is received.  
When n is transmitted n always=0.  
Model ID of XG  
ByteCount  
ByteCount  
Address High  
Address Mid  
b) Reception  
If no MIDI data is received within 400ms following receipt of FE, the unit  
executes processing equivalent to ALL SOUND OFF, ALL NOTES OFF, and  
RESET ALL CONTROLLERS, then clears any remaining FEs.  
01001100  
0bbbbbbb  
0bbbbbbb  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
0aaaaaaa  
00000000  
|
4C  
3.2 MIDI Clock  
bbbbbbb  
bbbbbbb  
aaaaaaa  
aaaaaaa  
aaaaaaa  
00  
a) Transmission  
Transmitted as 1/96 clocks.  
Address Low  
Data  
b) Reception  
If the [MIDI 1] clock function is set to the External mode it will receive a  
resolution of 1/96 clocks.  
|
|
|
0ccccccc  
11110111  
ccccccc  
F7  
Check sum  
End of Exclusive  
3.3 Start/Stop  
If the [MIDI 2] function Start/Stop filter is ON transmission and reception are  
disabled.  
For information about “Address” and “Byte Count” fields, refer to attached  
tables.  
In the attached tables “TOTAL SIZE” partitions a data series into single bulk  
dumps. The “address” is the first byte of the bulk data.  
The checksum value is set such that the sum of Byte Count, Address, Data, and  
Checksum has value zero in its seven least significant bits.  
a) Transmission  
All rhythm start and stop signals are transmitted.  
b) Reception  
If too much bulk data is received at a time there is a chance of error. The total  
data for a bulk dump should not exceed 512 bytes, it is recommended that data  
be kept under 512 bytes with an interval time of 120msec or more between 512  
byte bulk.  
When the relative message is received, the rhythm or song will start or stop.  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MIDI Data Format / MIDI-Datenformat/ Format des donées MIDI / Formato de datos MIDI  
<Table 1-1>  
Parameter Change  
Address  
(H) (M) (L)  
Parameter Base Address  
Model ID = 4C  
Description  
System  
Drum Setup Reset  
XG System On  
CVP MIDI  
SYSTEM  
00  
00  
00  
00  
02  
30  
31  
00  
00 7D  
00  
00  
00  
01  
18  
18  
7E  
7F  
00  
00  
00  
Reset All Parameters  
Effect1(Reverb,Chorus,Variation )  
Drum Setup 1  
Address Parameter  
3n 0B 00 note number 13  
3n 0C 00 note number 14  
EFFECT 1  
DRUM  
Drum Setup 2  
:
:
m
3n 5B 00 note number 91  
Note: The CVP 79A/69/69A/59S contain 3 drum setups (1 Preset Drum &  
Drum Setup 1, 2). Preset Drum being the preset drum setup, its  
parameters cannot be rewritten.  
<Table 1-2>  
MIDI Parameter Change table ( SYSTEM )  
Address  
(H)  
00 00 00  
01  
Size  
(H)  
4
Data  
(H)  
0000 - 07FF  
Parameter  
Description  
Default value  
(H)  
00 04 00 00  
-400  
MASTER TUNE  
-102.4 - +102.3[cent]  
1st bit3-0bit15-12  
2nd bit3-0bit11-8  
3rd bit3-0bit7-4  
4th bit3-0bit3-0  
0 - 127  
02  
03  
04  
06  
07  
1
1
1
00 - 7F  
28 - 58  
MASTER VOLUME  
TRANSPOSE  
7F  
40  
-24 - +24[semitones]  
7D  
7E  
7F  
n
00  
00  
DRUM SETUP RESET  
XG SYSTEM ON  
RESET ALL PARAMETERS  
n=Drum setup number  
00=XG sytem ON  
00=ON (receive only)  
TOTAL SIZE  
07  
<Table 1-3>  
MIDI Parameter Change table ( EFFECT 1)  
Refer to the “Effect MIDI Map” for a complete list of Reverb, Chorus and Variation type numbers.  
Refer to the “Effect Parameter List” for a detailed description of each parameter.  
Address  
(H)  
02 01 00  
Size  
(H)  
2
Data  
(H)  
Parameter  
Description  
Default value  
(H)  
01(=HALL1)  
00  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
01-7F  
REVERB TYPE MSB  
REVERB TYPE LSB  
Refer to Effect MIDI Map  
00 : basic type  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
REVERB PARAMETER 1  
REVERB PARAMETER 2  
REVERB PARAMETER 3  
REVERB PARAMETER 4  
REVERB PARAMETER 5  
REVERB PARAMETER 6  
REVERB PARAMETER 7  
REVERB PARAMETER 8  
REVERB PARAMETER 9  
REVERB PARAMETER 10  
REVERB RETURN  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
-dB...0dB...+6dB(0...64...127)  
L63...C...R63(1...64...127)  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
40  
0A  
0B  
0C  
1
1
1
0D  
REVERB PAN  
40  
TOTAL SIZE  
0E  
02 01 10  
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
REVERB PARAMETER 11  
REVERB PARAMETER 12  
REVERB PARAMETER 13  
REVERB PARAMETER 14  
REVERB PARAMETER 15  
REVERB PARAMETER 16  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
Depends on reverb type  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
TOTAL SIZE  
02 01 20  
2
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
01-7F  
00-7F  
CHORUS TYPE MSB  
CHORUS TYPE LSB  
Refer to Effect MIDI Map  
00 : basic type  
41(=CHORUS1)  
00  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
2A  
2B  
2C  
2D  
2E  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CHORUS PARAMETER 1  
CHORUS PARAMETER 2  
CHORUS PARAMETER 3  
CHORUS PARAMETER 4  
CHORUS PARAMETER 5  
CHORUS PARAMETER 6  
CHORUS PARAMETER 7  
CHORUS PARAMETER 8  
CHORUS PARAMETER 9  
CHORUS PARAMETER 10  
CHORUS RETURN  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
-dB...0dB...+6dB(0...64...127)  
L63...C...R63(1...64...127)  
-dB...0dB...+6dB(0...64...127)  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
40  
CHORUS PAN  
SEND CHORUS TO REVERB  
40  
00  
TOTAL SIZE  
0F  
02 01 30  
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
CHORUS PARAMETER 11  
CHORUS PARAMETER 12  
CHORUS PARAMETER 13  
CHORUS PARAMETER 14  
CHORUS PARAMETER 15  
CHORUS PARAMETER 16  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
Depends on chorus type  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
TOTAL SIZE  
02 01 40  
42  
2
2
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
VARIATION TYPE MSB  
VARIATION TYPE LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 1 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 1 LSB  
Refer to Effect MIDI Map  
00 : basic type  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
05(=DELAY L,C,R)  
00  
Depends on variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
44  
46  
48  
4A  
4C  
4E  
50  
52  
54  
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
01-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-01  
00-7F  
VARIATION PARAMETER 2 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 2 LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 3 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 3 LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 4 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 4 LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 5 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 5 LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 5 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 6 LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 7 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 7 LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 8 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 8 LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 9 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 9 LSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 10 MSB  
VARIATION PARAMETER 10 LSB  
VARIATION RETURN  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
-dB...0dB...+6dB(0...64...127)  
L63...C...R63(1...64...127)  
-dB...0dB...+6dB(0...64...127)  
-dB...0dB...+6dB(0...64...127)  
0:INSERTION,1:SYSTEM  
OFF(127)  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
Depends on Variation type  
40  
56  
57  
58  
59  
5A  
5B  
1
1
1
1
1
1
VARIATION PAN  
40  
00  
00  
00  
SEND VARIATION TO REVERB  
SEND VARIATION TO CHORUS  
VARIATION CONNECTION  
VARIATION PART  
Part 1-16 (0-15)  
5C  
5D  
5E  
5F  
60  
1
1
1
1
1
TOTAL SIZE  
21  
02 01 70  
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
00-7F  
VARIATION PARAMETER 11  
VARIATION PARAMETER 12  
VARIATION PARAMETER 13  
VARIATION PARAMETER 14  
VARIATION PARAMETER 15  
VARIATION PARAMETER 16  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Refer to Effect Parameter List  
Depends on variation type  
Depends on variation type  
Depends on variation type  
Depends on variation type  
Depends on variation type  
Depends on variation type  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
TOTAL SIZE  
* “VARIATION” refers to the EFFECT on the panel.  
<Table 1-4>  
MIDI Parameter Change table ( MULTI PART )  
Address  
(H)  
08 nn 07  
Size  
(H)  
1
Data  
(H)  
00 - 01  
Parameter  
Description  
Default value  
(H)  
00 (Part other than 10)  
01 (Part10)  
PART MODE  
0:NORMAL  
1:Preset Drum  
2 - 3:Drum Setup 1, 2  
nn 11  
nn 41  
nn 42  
nn 43  
nn 44  
nn 45  
nn 46  
nn 47  
nn 48  
nn 49  
nn 4A  
nn 4B  
nn 4C  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
DRY LEVEL  
0 - 127  
7F  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
SCALE TUNING C  
SCALE TUNING C#  
SCALE TUNING D  
SCALE TUNING D#  
SCALE TUNING E  
SCALE TUNING F  
SCALE TUNING F#  
SCALE TUNING G  
SCALE TUNING G#  
SCALE TUNING A  
SCALE TUNING A#  
SCALE TUNING B  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
-64 - +63[cent]  
nn = PartNumber  
For DRUM PART, the SCALE TUNING parameter is ineffective.  
<Table 1-5>  
MIDI Parameter Change table ( DRUM SETUP )  
Address  
(H)  
Size  
(H)  
1
1
1
Data  
(H)  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
Parameter  
Description  
Default value  
(H)  
40  
40  
3n rr 00  
3n rr 01  
3n rr 02  
3n rr 03  
3n rr 04  
PITCH COARSE  
PITCH FINE  
LEVEL  
PAN  
-64 - +63  
-64 - +63[cent]  
0 - 127  
Depends on note  
1
1
00 - 7F  
0:random  
Depends on note  
L63...C...R63(1...64...127)  
3n rr 05  
3n rr 06  
3n rr 07  
3n rr 08  
3n rr 09  
3n rr 0A  
3n rr 0B  
3n rr 0C  
3n rr 0D  
3n rr 0E  
3n rr 0F  
TOTAL SIZE  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
00 - 7F  
REVERB SEND  
CHORUS SEND  
VARIATION SEND  
FILTER CUTOFF FREQUENCY  
FILTER RESONANCE  
EG ATTACK  
EG DECAY1  
EG DECAY2  
0 - 127  
0 - 127  
0 - 127  
Depends on note  
Depends on note  
7F  
-64 - 63  
-64 - 63  
-64 - 63  
-64 - 63  
-64 - 63  
40  
40  
40  
40  
40  
1
1
10  
[Note]  
n:  
rr:  
Drum Setup number (0 to 1)  
Note number (0D to 54)  
Receipt of “XG System On” or “GM System On” message generates reinitialization of all DRUM SETUP parameters.  
“Drum Setup Reset” message can be used to reinitialize drum setup parameters.  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MIDI Data Format / MIDI-Datenformat/ Format des donées MIDI / Formato de datos MIDI  
Effect MIDI Map  
REVERB TYPE  
TYPE MSB  
DEC HEX  
TYPE LSB  
00  
01  
<——  
02  
<——  
<——  
Room6  
<——  
<——  
<——  
03~07  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
08  
<——  
Hall2*  
Room1*  
Stage1*  
Plate1*  
<——  
09  
<——  
0a  
<——  
0b  
<——  
<——  
Room7  
<——  
<——  
<——  
0c  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
0d~  
000  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
:
015  
016  
017  
018  
019  
020  
:
0
1
No Effect  
Hall1*  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Hall3  
Hall4  
Hall5  
2
Room4  
Room5  
Stage4  
<——  
<——  
Room2*  
Stage2*  
Plate3  
Room3*  
<——  
<——  
<——  
3
Stage3  
4
Plate2  
5
No Effect  
:
<——  
:
F
No Effect  
WhiteRoom*  
Tunnel*  
Canyon* (79)  
Basement*  
No Effect  
:
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
:
127  
7F  
No Effect  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<—— .......... Same as Basic Effect (LSB=0)  
* ............. Used in Panel REVERB SW  
(79) ...... CVP-79A only  
CHORUS TYPE  
TYPE MSB  
DEC HEX  
TYPE LSB  
00  
01  
02  
03~07  
08  
09  
0a  
0b  
0c  
0d~  
000  
001  
:
064  
065  
066  
067  
068  
069  
:
0
1
No Effect  
No Effect  
:
No Effect  
Chorus4  
Celeste  
Flanger2  
Symphonic (79) <——  
No Effect  
:
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
:
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
:
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Chorus2  
Celeste2  
Flanger3  
Chorus3  
Celeste3  
<——  
Celeste4  
Flanger1  
<——  
Celeste5  
Flanger4  
<——  
Chorus1  
Flanger5  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
071  
072  
073  
:
47  
48  
49  
:
No Effect  
Phaser (79)  
No Effect  
:
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
127  
7F  
No Effect  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<—— .......... Same as Basic Effect (LSB=0)  
(79)....... CVP-79A only  
VARIATION TYPE  
TYPE MSB  
DEC HEX  
TYPE LSB  
00  
01  
02  
03~07  
08  
<——  
Hall2  
09  
0a  
<——  
Hall5  
0b  
<——  
0c  
0d~  
<——  
000  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
011  
012  
:
0
1
No Effect  
<——  
Hall3  
<——  
<——  
Room6  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Hall4  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Hall1  
<——  
Room7  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
2
Room4  
Room5  
Stage4  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
EarlyRef.2  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Room1  
Stage1  
Plate1  
Delay2  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Room2  
Stage2  
Plate3  
Delay3  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Room3  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
3
Stage3  
4
Plate2  
5
Delay L, C, R*  
Delay L, R*  
Echo*  
6
7
8
CrossDelay*  
EarlyRef.1  
GateReverb  
ReverseGate  
No Effect  
:
No Effect  
Karaoke1  
No Effect  
:
9
A
B
C
:
019  
020  
021  
:
13  
14  
15  
:
<——  
<——  
Karaoke3  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Karaoke2  
<——  
063  
064  
065  
066  
067  
068  
069  
070  
071  
072  
073  
074  
075  
076  
077  
078  
079  
080  
081  
082  
083  
084  
085  
:
3F  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
4A  
4B  
4C  
4D  
4E  
4F  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
:
No Effect  
Thru  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Chorus3*  
Celeste3  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Celeste6  
<——  
<——  
RotarySp.5  
Tremolo4  
AutoPan4  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
AutoPan5  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Chorus4  
Chorus2*  
Celeste2  
Flanger3  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Celeste*  
Celeste4  
Flanger1*  
Symphonic*  
RotarySp.3  
Tremolo2  
AutoPan*  
<——  
Celeste5  
Flanger4  
<——  
Chorus1*  
Flanger5  
<——  
Flanger2  
Symphonic2  
RotarySp.Fast*  
Tremolo*  
AutoPan2  
Phaser*  
<——  
<——  
<——  
RotarySp.4  
Tremolo3  
AutoPan3  
<——  
<——  
<——  
RotarySp.Slow*  
<——  
<——  
Distortion  
OverDrive  
AmpSim.1  
3BandEQ2  
2BandEQ  
AutoWah2  
No Effect or Thru  
Detune* (79)  
No Effect or Thru  
TouchWah* (79)  
Compressor* (79)  
NoizeGate (79)  
No Effect or Thru  
<——  
<——  
<——  
AmpSim.2  
BoostHL*  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
AmpSim.3  
3BandEQ3  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
AutoWah*  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
Wah+Dist (79)  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
127  
7F  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<——  
<—— .......... Same as Basic Effect (LSB=0)  
* ............. Used in Panel EFFECT SW  
(79) ...... CVP-79A only  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Effect Parameter List  
BASIC EFFECT TYPE  
No. Parameter  
Data Range  
MIDI Value  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
No. Parameter  
Data Range  
MIDI Value  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
CVP-79A  
CVP-79A  
TREMOLO  
CHORUS, CELESTE  
1 LFO Frequency  
2 AM Depth  
3 PM Depth  
4 —  
0.00~39.7Hz  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
1 LFO Frequency  
2 LFO PM Depth  
3 Feedback Level  
4 Delay Offset  
5 —  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 Dry/Wet  
0.00~39.7Hz  
0~127  
0-127  
0-63  
1-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
1-127  
0-127  
0~127  
-63~+63  
0~127  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
5 —  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 —  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
1-127  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 EQ Mid Frequency  
12 EQ Mid Gain  
13 EQ Mid Width  
14 LFO Phase Difference  
15 Input Mode  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
1.0~12.0  
-180~+180deg  
mono/stereo  
14-54  
52-76  
10-120  
4-124  
11 EQ Mid Frequency  
12 EQ Mid Gain  
13 EQ Mid Width  
14 LFO AM Depth  
15 Input Mode  
16 —  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
1.0~12.0  
0~127  
mono/stereo  
14-54  
52-76  
10-120  
0-127  
0-1  
resolution = 3deg.  
0-1  
16 —  
AUTO PAN  
FLANGER  
1 LFO Frequency  
2 L/R Depth  
0.00~39.7Hz  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-5  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-5  
1 LFO Frequency  
2 LFO Depth  
3 Feedback Level  
4 Delay Offset  
5 —  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 Dry/Wet  
0.00~39.7Hz  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
1-127  
0-63  
0-127  
0-127  
1-127  
0-63  
3 F/R Depth  
0~127  
-63~+63  
4 PAN Direction  
L<->R,L->R,L<-R,  
Lturn,Rturn,L/R  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
0~63  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
5 —  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 —  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
1-127  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 EQ Mid Frequency  
12 EQ Mid Gain  
13 EQ Mid Width  
14 LFO Phase Difference  
15 —  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
1.0~12.0  
-180~+180deg  
14-54  
52-76  
10-120  
4-124  
11 EQ Mid Frequency  
12 EQ Mid Gain  
13 EQ Mid Width  
14 —  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
14-54  
52-76  
10-120  
-12~+12dB  
1.0~12.0  
resoulusion = 3deg.  
15 —  
16 —  
16 —  
SYMPHONIC  
PHASER  
1 LFO Frequency  
2 LFO Depth  
3 Delay Offset  
4 —  
0.00~39.7Hz  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
1 LFO Frequency  
2 LFO Depth  
3 Phase Shift Offset  
4 Feedback Level  
5 —  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 Dry/Wet  
0.00~39.7Hz  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
1-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
1-127  
0~127  
0~127  
-63~+63  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
5 —  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 Dry/Wet  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
1-127  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
1-127  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 EQ Mid Frequency  
12 EQ Mid Gain  
13 EQ Mid Width  
14 —  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
14-54  
52-76  
10-120  
11 Stage  
3~10  
“3-10 (4,6,8)”  
3-10 (6~10 (phaser1)  
-12~+12dB  
/ 3~5 (phaser2))  
1.0~12.0  
12 Diffusion  
13 LFO Phase Difference  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
Mono/Stereo  
-180~+180deg.  
0-1  
0-1  
4-124  
15 —  
16 —  
ROTARY SPEAKER  
1 LFO Frequency  
2 LFO Depth  
3 —  
0.00~39.7Hz  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
DISTORTION, OVERDRIVE  
1 Drive  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
2 EQ Low Frequency  
3 EQ Low Gain  
4 LPF Cutoff  
5 Output Level  
6 —  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
1.0k~Thru  
0~127  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
4 —  
52-76  
52-76  
34-60  
0-127  
5 —  
34-60  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 Dry/Wet  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
0-127  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
1-127  
7 EQ Mid Frequency  
500Hz~10.0kHz  
14-54  
28-54  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
52-76  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
8 EQ Mid Gain  
9 EQ Mid Width  
10 Dry/Wet  
-12~+12dB  
1.0~12.0  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
52-76  
10-120  
1-127  
10-120  
11 EQ Mid Frequency  
12 EQ Mid Gain  
13 EQ Mid Width  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
14-54  
52-76  
10-120  
-12~+12dB  
1.0~12.0  
11 Edge (Clip Curve)  
12 —  
0~127  
0-127  
13 —  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MIDI Data Format / MIDI-Datenformat/ Format des donées MIDI / Formato de datos MIDI  
No. Parameter  
Data Range  
MIDI Value  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
No. Parameter  
Data Range  
MIDI Value  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
CVP-79A  
CVP-79A  
GUITAR AMP SIMULATOR  
HALL, ROOM, STAGE, PLATE  
1 Drive  
2 AMP Type  
3 LPF Cutoff  
4 Output Level  
5 —  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-3  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Reverb Time  
Diffusion  
Initial Delay  
HPF Cutoff  
LPF Cutoff  
0.3~30.0s  
0~10  
0-69  
0-10  
0-63  
0-52  
34-60  
0-69  
0-10  
0-63  
0-52  
34-60  
Off,Stack,Combo,Tube 0-3  
1.0k~Thru  
34-60  
0-127  
34-60  
0-127  
0~63  
0~127  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
6 —  
7 —  
8 —  
1-127  
9 —  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
1-127  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 Edge (Clip Curve)  
12 —  
0~127  
0-127  
11 Rev Delay  
12 Density  
0~63  
0~3  
0-63  
0-63  
“0-4 *REV (0-4), 0-3  
VAR (0-3)”  
13 —  
14 —  
13 Er/Rev Balance  
14 High Damp  
15 Feedback Level  
16 —  
E63>R~E=R~E<R63  
1-127  
1-10  
1-127  
1-127  
15 —  
0.1~1.0  
-63~+63  
16 —  
MONO EQ (3BAND)  
DELAY L, C, R  
1 EQ Low Gain  
-12~+12dB  
52-76  
52-76  
28-54  
2 EQ Mid Frequency  
500Hz~10.0kHz  
14-54  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Lch Delay  
Rch Delay  
Cch Delay  
Feedback Delay  
Feedback Level  
Cch Level  
High Damp  
0.1~715.0ms  
0.1~715.0ms  
0.1~715.0ms  
0.1~715.0ms  
-63~+63  
0~127  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-127  
0-127  
1-10  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-127  
0-127  
1-10  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
52-76  
10-120  
52-76  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
28-58  
3 EQ Mid Gain  
4 EQ Mid Width  
5 EQ High Gain  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ High Frequency  
8 —  
-12~+12dB  
1.0~12.0  
-12~+12dB  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
52-76  
10-120  
52-76  
28-58  
0.1~1.0  
9 —  
10 —  
1-127  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 —  
12 —  
13 —  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
11 HPF Cutoff  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
0-52  
34-60  
12 LPF Cutoff  
13 EQ Low Frequency  
14 EQ Low Gain  
15 EQ High Frequency  
16 EQ High Gain  
8-40  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
STEREO EQ (2BAND)  
DELAY L, R  
1 EQ Low Frequency  
2 EQ Low Gain  
3 EQ High Frequency  
4 EQ High Gain  
5 —  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Lch Delay  
Rch Delay  
Feedback Delay 1  
Feedback Delay 2  
Feedback Level  
High Damp  
0.1~715.0ms  
0.1~715.0ms  
0.1~715.0ms  
0.1~715.0ms  
-63~+63  
0.1~1.0  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-127  
1-10  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-7150  
1-127  
1-10  
-12~+12dB  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
6 —  
7 —  
8 —  
1-127  
9 —  
10 —  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 EQ Mid Frequency  
12 EQ Mid Gain  
13 EQ Mid Width  
14 —  
100Hz~10.0kHz  
14-54  
52-76  
10-120  
11 HPF Cutoff  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
0-52  
34-60  
-12~+12dB  
12 LPF Cutoff  
1.0~12.0  
13 EQ Low Frequency  
14 EQ Low Gain  
15 EQ High Frequency  
16 EQ High Gain  
8-40  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
15 —  
16 —  
AUTO WAH  
ECHO  
1 LFO Frequency  
2 LFO Depth  
0.00~39.7Hz  
0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
10-120  
0-127  
0-127  
0-127  
10-120  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Lch Delay1  
0.1~355.0ms  
-63~+63  
0.1~355.0ms  
-63~+63  
0.1~1.0  
1-3550  
1-127  
1-3550  
1-127  
1-10  
1-3550  
1-3550  
0-127  
1-3550  
1-127  
1-3550  
1-127  
1-10  
Lch Feedback Level  
Rch Delay1  
Rch Feedback Level  
High Damp  
Lch Delay2  
3 Cutoff Frequency Offset 0~127  
4 Resonance  
5 —  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 Dry/Wet  
1.0~12.0  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
4-40 32Hz~2.0kHz 8-40  
0.1~355.0ms  
0.1~355.0ms  
0~127  
1-3550  
1-3550  
0-127  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
1-127  
Rch Delay2  
Delay2 Level  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
1-127  
11 Drive  
12 —  
13 —  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
0~127  
0-127  
11 HPF Cutoff  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
0-52  
34-60  
12 LPF Cutoff  
13 EQ Low Frequency  
14 EQ Low Gain  
15 EQ High Frequency  
16 EQ High Gain  
8-40  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
No. Parameter  
Data Range  
MIDI Value  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
CVP-79A  
CROSS DELAY  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
L->R Delay  
R->L Delay  
Feedback Level  
Input Select  
High Damp  
0.1~355.0ms  
0.1~355.0ms  
-63~+63  
L,R,L&R  
0.1~1.0  
1-3550  
1-3550  
1-127  
0-2  
1-3550  
1-3550  
1-127  
0-2  
1-10  
1-10  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
1-127  
11 HPF Cutoff  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
50Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
0-52  
34-60  
12 LPF Cutoff  
13 EQ Low Frequency  
14 EQ Low Gain  
15 EQ High Frequency  
16 EQ High Gain  
8-40  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
EARLY REF  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Type  
S-H, L-H, Rdm, Rvs, Plt, Spr 0-5  
0-5  
Room Size  
Diffusion  
Initial Delay  
Feedback Level  
HPF Cutoff  
LPF Cutoff  
0.1~7.0  
0~10  
0-44  
0-44  
0-10  
0-63  
1-127  
0-52  
34-60  
0-10  
0-63  
1-127  
0-52  
34-60  
0~63  
-63~+63  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
1-127  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 Liveness  
12 Density  
13 High Damp  
14 —  
0~10  
0~3  
0.1~1.0  
0-10  
0-3  
1-10  
0-10  
0-3  
1-10  
15 —  
16 —  
GATE REVERB, REVERSE GATE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Type  
TypeA,TypeB  
0.1~7.0  
0~10  
0-1  
0-1  
Room Size  
Diffusion  
Initial Delay  
Feedback Level  
HPF Cutoff  
LPF Cutoff  
0-44  
0-10  
0-63  
1-127  
0-52  
34-60  
0-44  
0-10  
0-63  
1-127  
0-52  
34-60  
0~63  
-63~+63  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
1-127  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 Liveness  
12 Density  
13 High Damp  
14 —  
0~10  
0~3  
0.1~1.0  
0-10  
0-3  
1-10  
0-10  
0-3  
1-10  
15 —  
16 —  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MIDI Data Format / MIDI-Datenformat/ Format des donées MIDI / Formato de datos MIDI  
OPTION EFFECT TYPE  
No. Parameter  
Data Range  
MIDI Value  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
No. Parameter  
Data Range  
MIDI Value  
CVP-69/69A/59S  
CVP-79A  
CVP-79A  
NOISE GATE (CVP-79A only)  
PITCH CHANGE (CVP-79A only)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Attack  
1~40ms  
0-19  
0-15  
55-97  
0-127  
1 Pitch  
2 Initial Delay  
3 Fine 1  
4 Fine 2  
5 Feedback Gain  
6 —  
-24~+24  
0~127  
-50~+50  
-50~+50  
-99~+99%  
40-88  
0-127  
14-114  
14-114  
1-127  
Release  
10~680ms  
Threshold  
Output Level  
-72~-30dB  
0~127  
7 —  
8 —  
9 —  
10 Dry/Wet  
10 —  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 —  
12 —  
13 —  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
11 Pan 1  
12 Output Level 1  
13 Pan 2  
14 Output Level 2  
15 —  
16 —  
L63~R63  
0~127  
L63~R63  
0~127  
1-127  
0-127  
1-127  
0-127  
WHITE ROOM, TUNNEL, CANYON (CVP-79A only), BASEMENT  
TOUCH WAH, WAH+DIST (CVP-79A only)  
1 Sensitive 0~127  
2 Cutoff Frequency Offset 0~127  
0-127  
0-127  
10-120  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Reverb Time  
Diffusion  
Initial Delay  
HPF Cutoff  
LPF Cutoff  
Width  
0.3~30.0s  
0~10  
0-69  
0-10  
0-63  
0-52  
34-60  
0-37  
0-73  
0-104  
0-30  
0-69  
0-10  
0-63  
0-52  
34-60  
0-37  
0-73  
0-104  
0-30  
1-127  
0~63  
3 Resonance  
4 —  
5 —  
1.0~12.0  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
0.5~10.2m  
0.5~20.2m  
0.5~30.2m  
0~30  
6 EQ Low Frequency  
7 EQ Low Gain  
8 EQ High Frequency  
9 EQ High Gain  
10 Dry/Wet  
32Hz~2.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
500Hz~16.0kHz  
-12~+12dB  
4-40  
52-76  
28-58  
52-76  
Heigt  
Depth  
Wall Vary  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
11 Rev Delay  
12 Density  
0~63  
0~3  
0-63  
0-63  
11 Drive  
12 —  
13 —  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
0~127  
0-127  
“0-4 *REV (0-4), 0-3  
VAR (0-3)”  
13 Er/Rev Balance  
14 High Damp  
15 Feedback Level  
16 —  
E63>R~E=R~E<R63  
1-127  
1-10  
1-127  
1-127  
0.1~1.0  
-63~+63  
COMPRESSOR (CVP-79A only)  
KARAOKE1, 2, 3  
1 Attack  
2 Release  
3 Threshold  
4 Ratio  
5 Output Level  
6 —  
1~40ms  
10~680ms  
-48~-6dB  
1.0~20.0  
0~127  
0-19  
0-15  
79-121  
0-7  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Delay Time  
0~127  
0-127  
1-127  
0-52  
34-60  
0-127  
1-127  
0-52  
34-60  
Feedback Level  
-63~+63  
HPF Cutoff  
LPF Cutoff  
Thru~8.0kHz  
1.0k~Thru  
0-127  
7 —  
8 —  
9 —  
10 —  
10 Dry/Wet  
D63>W~D=W~D<W63 1-127  
1-127  
11 —  
12 —  
13 —  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
11 —  
12 —  
13 —  
14 —  
15 —  
16 —  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications/Technische Datan/  
Spécifications/Especificationes  
CVP-79A  
CVP-69  
CVP-69A  
CVP-59S  
KEYBOARD  
TONE GENERATOR  
VOICE  
88 KEYS (A-1 — C7)  
AWM (Advanced Wave Memory)  
Voice Groups: PIANO, E. PIANO, HARPSICHORD, GUITAR, CLAVINOVA TONE/SYNTH, ORGAN, STRINGS/CHOIR,  
BRASS, SAX/FLUTE, BASS, DRUMS/PERCUSSIVE (192 voices for CVP-79A, 172 voices for CVP-69/69A/59S)  
DUAL, SPLIT, EFFECT  
STYLE  
Style Groups: POP, 16BEAT, DANCE POP, ROCK, BALLAD, JAZZ, LATIN, LATIN POP, TRADITIONAL, COUNTRY, WALTZ  
(100 styles)  
DISK/CUSTOM, HARMONY, ONE TOUCH SETTING  
AUTO BASS CHORD  
INTRO A/FILL TO A, INTRO B/FILL TO B, MAIN A, MAIN B, ENDING, SMALL ABC, ABC ON  
METRONOME, TEMPO –/+  
START/STOP  
TAP, SYNCHRO, START/STOP  
KEYBOARD PERCUSSION  
REVERB  
8 Drum Kits (72 instruments in each Drum Kit)  
HALL1, HALL2, ROOM1, ROOM2, ROOM3, STAGE1, STAGE2, PLATE, WHITE ROOM, TUNNEL, CANYON (CVP-79A only),  
BASEMENT  
SONG  
PLAY, RECORD, GUIDE  
SONG CONTROL  
REGISTRATION  
r REW, f FF, o PAUSE  
MEMORY, BANK, 1 — 5, ABC FREEZE  
LCD & DISPLAY  
CONTROLS  
240 x 64 dots Liquid Crystal Display, CONTRAST, BEAT, FUNCTION, MIXER, PAGE </>, DISPLAY HOLD, 5 LCD Buttons,  
EXIT, Data Dial, –/+  
VOLUME  
MASTER VOLUME, ABC/SONG VOLUME  
25 demonstration tunes, 4 help languages (English, German, French, Japanese)  
3.5" 2DD or 2HD Micro Floppy Disk Drive  
DAMPER  
DEMO/HELP  
DISK DRIVE  
PEDAL  
CONTROLS  
RIGHT  
CENTER  
LEFT  
SOSTENUTO  
Multi-function: SOFT, START/STOP, HARMONY ON/OFF, REGISTRATION+, INTRO A/FILL TO A, INTRO B/FILL TO B,  
ENDING/RIT., BREAK, SOSTENUTO (CVP-59S only)  
JACKS  
PHONES x 2, AUX OUT R and L/L + R, AUX IN R and L/L+R, EXP PEDAL (CVP-79A only)  
CONNECTORS  
MIDI IN/OUT/THRU  
MIDI IN/OUT  
INPUT & OUTPUT  
AUX OUT: Output Impedance 600 Ω  
LEVEL/IMPEDANCE  
AUX IN: Input Impedance 10 k/ Input Sensitivity -10dBm  
MAIN AMPLIFIERS  
SPEAKERS  
120 W (60 W x 2)  
120 W (60 W x 2)  
120 W (60 W x 2)  
60 W (30 W x 2)  
(16 cm + 5 cm) x 2, 5 cm x 2  
(6-5/16" + 2") x 2, 2" x 2  
(16 cm + 5 cm) x 2, 5 cm x 2  
(6-5/16" + 2") x 2, 2" x 2  
(16 cm + 5 cm) x 2, 5 cm x 2  
(6-5/16" + 2") x 2, 2" x 2  
16 cm x 2, 5 cm x 2  
6-5/16" x 2, 2" x 2  
DIMENSIONS Music stand  
1417 mm x 590 mm x 840 mm  
(55-13/16" x 23-1/4" x 33-1/16")  
1417 mm x 590 mm x 848 mm  
(55-13/16" x 23-1/4" x 33-3/8")  
1417 mm x 590 mm x 845 mm  
(55-13/16" x 23-1/4" x 33-1/4")  
1396 mm x 566 mm x 830 mm  
(54-15/16" x 22-5/16" x 32-11/16")  
(W x D x H)  
down  
Music stand  
up  
1417 mm x 590 mm x 1025 mm  
(55-13/16" x 23-1/4" x 40-3/8")  
1417 mm x 590 mm x 1019 mm  
(55-13/16" x 23-1/4" x 40-1/8")  
1417 mm x 590 mm x 1025 mm  
(55-13/16" x 23-1/4" x 40-3/8")  
1396 mm x 566 mm x 1003 mm  
(54-15/16" x 22-5/16" x 39-1/2")  
WEIGHT  
68.0 kg (149.9 lbs.)  
71.5 kg (157.6 lbs.)  
69.0 kg (152.1 lbs.)  
65.5 kg (144.4 lbs.)  
* Specifications subject to change without notice.  
* Änderungen ohne Vorankündigung vorbehalten.  
* Sous toute réserve de modification des caractéristiques sans préavis.  
* Especificaciones sujetas a cambios sin previo aviso.  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
5 x 20 mm screws x 28  
Schrauben (5 x 20 mm) x 28  
Vis de 5 x 20 mm x 28  
Tornillos de 5 x 20 mm x 28  
AC power cord  
Netzkabel  
Cordon d’alimentation  
Cable de alimentación de CA  
CVP-79A: Assembly  
CVP-79A: Zusammenbau  
We do not recommend attempting to assemble the Clavinova  
alone. The job can be easily accomplished, however, with only two  
people.  
Wir raten Ihnen davon ab, das Clavinova alleine zusammenzu-  
bauen und aufzustellen. Zwei Personen können diese Arbeit jedoch  
problemlos ausführen.  
Use only the screws provided or replacements of exactly the speci-  
fied size. Using screws of the wrong size can result in damage to  
the instrument.  
Verwenden Sie ausschließlich die mitgeliefenten Schrauben oder  
Ersatzschrauben identischer Größe. Die Verwendung von Schrau-  
ben mit abweichenden Maßen kann eine Beschädigung des Instru-  
ments zur Folge haben.  
ZOpen the box and remove all the parts.  
On opening the box you should find the parts shown in  
the illustration above. Check to make sure that all the  
required parts are provided.  
ZDen Versandkarton öffnen und alle Teile  
auspacken.  
Der Karton sollte alle in der Abbildung gezeigten Teile  
enthalten. Vergewissern Sie sich, daß alle Teile voll-  
zählig vorhanden sind.  
XCarefully lean the main unit against a wall.  
To make it easier to install the legs, place a soft blanket  
or similar material on the floor near a wall, close the  
Clavinova keyboard cover, place the front panel of the  
Clavinova (the side with the keyboard) on the blanket  
and gently lean the unit against the wall — MAKING  
SURE THAT IT CAN NOT FALL — as shown in the  
illustration.  
XDie Haupteineit vorsichtig an eine Wand leh-  
nen.  
Um das Anschrauben der Beine zu erleichtern, breiten  
Sie eine Decke oder ein weiches Tuch neben der Wand  
auf dem Boden aus, schließen den Tastaturdeckel des  
Clavinova, stellen das Instrument mit der Vorderkante  
(Seite mit der Tastatur) vorsichtig auf die Decke und  
lehnen es an die Wand, wie in der Abbildung gezeigt.  
VERGEWISSERN SIE SICH, DASS DAS IN-  
STRUMENT NICHT KIPPEN ODER WEG-  
RUTSCHEN KANN!  
CAttach the front legs.  
Securely attach the two front legs using three screws  
for each leg (use a Philips “+” screwdriver) as shown in  
the illustration. Make sure that the screws are firmly  
tightened.  
CDie vorderen Beine montieren.  
Schrauben Sie die beiden vorderen Beine mit jeweils  
drei Schrauben (Kreuzschlitzschraubendreher verwen-  
den!) gut am Clavinova fest, wie in der Abbildung  
gezeigt. Ziehen Sie die Schrauben fest an.  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
3
Blanket, etc.  
Decke o. ä.  
Couverture, etc.  
Manta, etc.  
Three screws on each side  
Drei Schrauben pro Bein  
Trois vis de chaque côté  
Tres tornillos en cada lado  
CVP-79A: Montage  
CVP-79A: Montaje  
Nous ne vous conseillons pas dessayer dassembler le Clavinova  
seul. Toutefois, ce travail peut être facilement exécuté par deux  
personnes.  
No le recomendamos que monte la Clavinova usted solo. Sin  
embargo, el trabajo podrá realizarse con más facilidad entre dos  
personas solamente.  
Nutilisez que les vis fournies ou des vis ayant exactement les  
mêmes dimensions. Lutilisation de vis de dimensions incorrectes  
pourrait endommager linstrument.  
Emplee sólo los tornillos suministrados u otros que sean exacta-  
mente del mismo tamaño especificado. El empleo de tornillos del  
tamaño erróneo puede dañar el instrumento.  
ZOuvrez le carton et retirez toutes les pièces.  
Les pièces indiquées sur l’illustration devraient toutes  
se trouver dans le carton. Vérifiez qu’il n’en manque  
aucune.  
ZAbra la caja y extraiga todas las partes.  
Al abrir la caja, encontrará las partes mostradas en la  
ilustración de arriba. Compruebe y asegúrese de que  
no falta ninguna de las partes requeridas.  
XAppuyez le clavier contre un mur en faisant  
très attention.  
XIncline con cuidado la unidad principal con-  
tra una pared.  
Pour faciliter la pose des pieds, placez une couverture  
épaisse, ou un matériau similaire, sur le plancher à  
proximité d’un mur. Fermez le cache-clavier et placez  
la face avant du Clavinova (côté clavier) sur la couver-  
ture et appuyez ensuite le clavier contre le mur de la  
manière illustrée. ASSUREZ-VOUS QU’IL NE  
PEUT PAS TOMBER.  
Para facilitar la instalación de las patas, coloque una  
manta blanda o un material semejante sobre el piso  
cerca de una pared, cierre la cubierta del teclado de la  
Clavinova, coloque el panel frontal de la Clavinova (el  
lado con el teclado) sobre la manta e incline con cuida-  
do la unidad contra la pared — ASEGURANDOSE  
DE QUE NO PUEDA CAERSE — como se muestra  
en la ilustración.  
CPosez les pieds avant.  
CColoque las patas delanteras.  
Fixez les deux pieds avant en utilisant trois vis par pied  
(utilisez un tournevis cruciforme “+”) comme illustré.  
Vérifiez que les vis sont serrées à fond.  
Fije las dos patas delanteras usando tres tornillos para  
cada pata (emplee un destornillador de cabeza en cruz  
“+”) como se muestra en la ilustración. Asegúrese de  
que los tornillos queden bien apretados.  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Four screws on each side  
Jeweils vier Schrauben an Vorder-  
und Hinterseite  
Quatre vis de chaque côté  
Cuatro tornillos en cada lado  
VAttach the speaker box.  
VDen Lautsprecherkasten montieren.  
Nehmen Sie die von Klettband gehaltene Bespannung  
vom Lautsprecherkasten ab. Setzen Sie den  
Remove the speaker box cover (attached with  
Velcro”) from the speaker box. Gently rest the speaker  
box onto the corresponding brackets on the front legs.  
(Be careful not to touch the speakers when handling  
the speaker box. Damage may result.) Make sure the  
speaker cord is extending out from the rear of the  
speaker box. Secure the speaker box to the main key-  
board unit using four screws on each side. Insert the  
speaker cord connector into the corresponding socket  
on the main keyboard unit, making sure that the pro-  
truding clip on the connector is facing left.  
Lautsprecherkasten vorsichtig auf die Halterungen an  
den vorderen Beinen. (Vermeiden Sie dabei unbedingt  
ein Berühren der Lautsprechermembrane.) Das  
Lautsprecherkabel muß an der Hinterseite (d.h. oben)  
aus dem Lautsprecherkasten ragen. Schrauben Sie den  
Lautsprecherkasten mit jeweils vier Schrauben an  
Vorder- und Hinterseite an der Haupteinheit fest.  
Schließen Sie dann das Lautsprecherkabel an die  
Buchse der Haupteinheit an (die Führungsnase am  
Stecker muß dabei nach links weisen).  
BDie Pedalkastengruppe montieren.  
Bevor Sie die Pedalkastengruppe mit den hinteren Bei-  
nen montieren, schließen Sie das aus dem einen Bein  
ragende Pedalkabel an die entsprechende Buchse der  
Haupteinheit an (die Führungsnase am Stecker muß  
dabei nach oben weisen). Schieben Sie überlanges  
Kabel wieder in das Bein zurück, und schrauben Sie  
dann die Pedalkastengruppe mit fünf Schrauben pro  
Bein (jeweils 3 für das Bein selbst und 2 für die  
Halterung am Bein) an die Haupteinheit.  
BAttach the pedal box assembly.  
Before attaching the rear leg and pedal box assembly,  
insert the pedal cord plug extending from the rear leg  
into the corresponding socket in the main unit. Make  
sure that the protruding clip on the connector is facing  
up. Put the excess cord into the leg and securely attach  
the rear leg and pedal assembly using 5 screws for each  
leg (three screws per leg and two screws on each leg  
bracket).  
NDen Lautsprecherkasten an den vorderen  
NSecure the speaker box.  
Beinen sichern.  
Stand the main unit on its legs and securely attach the  
speaker box to the bracket on the front legs using two  
screws for each bracket. If it is impossible to align the  
bracket holes with the speaker box holes, slightly  
loosen the three screws on each of the front legs, align  
the holes, and secure the speaker box. After the speaker  
box is firmly attached, retighten the screws on the front  
legs firmly. Put the speaker box cover back in place  
with the “Velcro” on the cover and speaker box. (Make  
sure the cut out corners of the speaker cover mask the  
brackets.)  
Stellen Sie das Instrument nun auf seine Beine, um den  
Lautsprecherkasten zusätzlich mit jeweils zwei Schrau-  
ben an die Halterungen der beiden vorderen Beine zu  
schrauben. Sollten die Schraubenbohrungen nicht zur  
Deckung gebracht werden können, lösen Sie die  
Befestigungsschrauben der vorderen Beine ein wenig.  
Nach Festschrauben des Lautsprecherkastens dürfen Sie  
jedoch nicht vergessen, die Schrauben der Beine wieder  
fest anzuziehen. Bringen Sie nun die Bespannung wieder  
an, indem Sie die Klettband-Gegenstücke an  
Bespannungsrahmen und Lautsprecherkasten aufeinander  
ausrichten. (Die Halterungen müssen in den ausgesparten  
Mulden des Bespannungsrahmens zu liegen kommen.)  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Five screws on each side  
Fünf Schrauben pro Bein  
Cinq vis de chaque côté  
Cinco tornillos en cada lado  
5
6
Two screws on each side  
Jeweils zwei Schrauben links und rechts  
Deux vis de chaque côté  
Dos tornillos en cada lado  
VPosez la boîte des haut-parleurs.  
Retirez le couvercle (fixé au moyen de velcro) de la  
boîte des haut-parleurs. Poser la boîte des haut-  
parleurs sur les ferrures correspondantes des pieds  
avant. (Faites bien attention de ne pas toucher les haut-  
parleurs lorsque vous manipulez la boîte. Cela pourrait  
les endommager.) Assurez-vous que le cordon des  
haut-parleurs sort de l’arrière de la boîte. Fixez la  
boîte sur le clavier en utilisant quatre vis de chaque  
côté. Branchez le connecteur du cordon des haut-  
parleurs à la prise correspondante du clavier en veillant  
à ce que la partie en saillie du connecteur soit dirigée  
vers la gauche.  
VMonte la caja de altavoces.  
Extraiga la cubierta de la caja de altavoces (unida con  
cinta de adhesión por contacto) de la caja de altavoces.  
Apoye con cuidado la caja de altavoces en las ménsulas  
correspondientes de las patas delanteras. (Tenga cuidado  
en no tocar los altavoces cuando se manipule la caja de  
altavoces. Podrían ocasionarse daños.) Asegúrese de que  
el cable de altavoz se extienda desde la parte posterior de  
la caja del altavoz. Fije le caja de altavoces a la unidad  
del teclado principal usando cuatro tornillos en cada lado.  
Inserte el conector del cable de altavoces en el receptácu-  
lo correspondiente de la unidad del teclado principal,  
asegurándose de que el retenedor que sobresale del  
conector queda orientado hacia la izquierda.  
BMonte el conjunto de la caja de pedales  
Antes de montar la pata trasera y el conjunto de la caja  
de pedales, inserte la clavija del cables de los pedales,  
que se extiende desde la pata trasera al receptáculo  
correspondiente de la unidad principal. Asegúrese de  
que el retenedor que sobresale del conector queda  
orientado hacia arriba. Ponga el cable sobrante en la  
pata y fije con seguridad la pata trasera y el conjunto  
de pedales usando 5 tornillos para cada pata (tres torni-  
llos por pata y dos tornillos en la ménsula de cada pata.  
BFixez le pédalier.  
Avant de poser l’ensemble pied arrière/pédalier, bran-  
chez le connecteur du cordon de pédalier sortant du  
pied arrière à la prise correspondante du clavier.  
Veillez à ce que la partie en saillie du connecteur soit  
dirigée vers le haut. Placez le cordon en excès dans le  
pied et fixer solidement l’ensemble pied arrière/péda-  
lier en utilisant 5 vis pour chaque pied (trois vis par  
pied et deux vis pour chaque ferrure de fixation).  
NFije la caja de altavoces  
NFixer la boîte des haut-parleurs.  
Apoye la unidad principal sobre sus patas y monte con  
seguridad la caja de altavoces en la ménsula de las patas  
delanteras usando dos tornillos para cada ménsula. Si es  
imposible alinear los orificios de las ménsulas con los  
orificios de la caja de altavoces, afloje un poco los tres  
tornillos de cada una de las patas delanteras, alinee los  
orificios, y fije la caja de altavoces. Después de haber  
montado firmemente la caja de altavoces, vuelva a apre-  
tar bien los tornillos de las patas delanteras. Ponga de  
nuevo la cubierta de la caja de altavoces en su lugar con  
la cinta de adhesión por contacto de la cubierta y de la  
caja de altavoces. (Asegúrese de que las esquinas corta-  
das de la cubierta de altavoces encubre las ménsulas.)  
Mettez le clavier sur ses pieds et fixez la boîte des  
haut-parleurs à la ferrure de fixation des pieds avant à  
l’aide de deux vis par ferrure. S’il est impossible d’ali-  
gner les trous des ferrures de fixation sur les trous de la  
boîte des haut-parleurs, desserrez légèrement les trois  
vis de chaque pied avant, alignez les trous et fixez la  
boîte des haut-parleurs. Reposez le couvercle de la  
boîte des haut-parleurs et fixez-le au moyen des velcros  
du couvercle et de la boîte. (Assurez-vous que les  
coins découpés du couvercle cachent bien les ferrures.)  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
A voltage selector is provided in some areas.  
Spannungswähler  
(nur in bestimmten Verkaufsgebieten)  
Un sélecteur de tension est prévu pour  
certaines régions  
El selector de tensión está provisto para  
ciertos destinos.  
2 4 0  
127  
MVoltage Selector  
MDen Spannungswähler einstellen.  
Bevor Sie nun das Netzkabel anschließen, müssen Sie  
den Spannungswähler (falls vorhanden) auf die örtliche  
Netzspannung einstellen. Zum Verstellen drehen Sie  
den Spannungswähler mit einem  
Before connecting the AC power cord, check the set-  
ting of the voltage selector which is provided in some  
areas. To set the selector for 110V, 127V, 220V or  
240V main voltages, use a “minus” screwdriver to  
rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage for  
your region appears next to the pointer on the panel.  
The voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is  
initially shipped.  
Schlitzschraubendreher, bis der richtige Spannungswert  
(110, 127, 220 oder 240) an der Pfeilmarkierung steht.  
Bei der Auslieferung werden alle Instrumente mit  
Spannungswähler auf “240” voreingestellt.  
After the proper voltage has been selected connect the  
AC power cord. A plug adaptor may be also provided  
in some areas to match the pin configuration of the AC  
wall outlets in your area.  
Nachdem Sie den Spannungswähler richtig eingestellt  
haben, können Sie nun das Netzkabel anschließen. In  
manchen Gebieten wird ein Steckerdapter mitgeliefert,  
um den Anschluß an die evtl. unterschiedlich geformte  
Steckdose zu ermöglichen.  
<Set the Adjusters.  
<Die Pedalstützen einstellen.  
For stability, four adjusters are provided on the bottom  
of the pedal box and rear leg assembly. After position-  
ing the Clavinova in its intended location, rotate the  
adjusters until they come in firm contact with the floor  
surface. The adjusters ensure stable pedal operation  
and facilitates pedal effect control. If the adjusters are  
not in firm contact with the floor surface, distorted  
sound may result.  
Für bessere Standfestigkeit sind unter der Pedalkasten-  
gruppe vier verstellbare Pedalstützen vorgesehen.  
Nachdem Sie das Clavinova an seinem festen Stand-  
platz aufgestellt haben, drehen Sie diese Stützen her-  
aus, bis sie fest auf dem Boden stehen. Die Stützen  
sorgen beim Spielen für präzise Pedalbetätigung. Wenn  
die vier Pedalstützen nicht fest auf dem Boden aufste-  
hen, können Klangverzerrungen auftreten.  
After assembling the Clavinova, check once more to make sure  
that all screws have been securely fastened.  
Vergewissern Sie sich nach Zusammenbau und Aufstellung des  
Clavinova noch einmal davon, daß alle Schrauben fest angezogen  
sind.  
If the stand leans to the side, makes unusual noises, or otherwise  
seems unstable during use, check and tighten all screws while  
following the assembly instructions given above.  
Wenn das Instrument schief steht, komische Geräusche erzeugt  
oder sich beim Spielen wackelig anfühlt, prüfen Sie gemäß den  
obigen Anweisungen, ob das Instrument richtig zusammengebaut  
wurde, und ziehen dabei die einzelnen Schrauben noch einmal  
nach.  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8
MSélecteur de tension  
MSelector de tensión  
Avant de connecter le cordon d’alimentation, vérifiez  
le réglage du sélecteur de tension qui est prévu pour  
certaines régions. Pour régler le sélecteur sur 110 V,  
127 V, 220 V ou 240 V, utilisez un tournevis à lame  
plate pour tourner le cadran du sélecteur afin de mettre  
l’indication correspondant à la tension de votre région  
vis à vis du repère triangulaire situé sur le panneau. Le  
sélecteur de tension est réglé sur 240 V au départ  
d’usine.  
Antes de conectar el cable de alimentación de CA,  
compruebe el ajuste del selector de tensión que se in-  
corpora para ciertos destinos. Para ajustar el selector a  
110V, 127V, 220V ó 240V de la red de alimentación,  
emplee un destornillador de cabeza recta “-” para girar  
el selector de modo que la tensión correcta de su zona  
aparezca al lado del indicador del panel. El selector de  
tensión se ajusta a 240V cuando la unidad sale de fábri-  
ca.  
Une fois que vous avez réglé le sélecteur de tension,  
connectez le cordon d’alimentation. Un adaptateur de  
prise peut également être fourni dans certaines régions  
pour pouvoir brancher le cordon à la prise secteur mu-  
rale.  
Después de haber seleccionado la tensión correcta,  
enchufe el cable de alimentación. En algunas zonas  
puede suministrarse también un adaptador para adaptar  
la configuración de las patillas de los tomacorrientes de  
CA de su localidad.  
<Réglez la hauteur du pédalier.  
<Ajuste los reguladores  
Pour assurer la stabilité, quatre dispositifs de réglage  
ont été prévus à la partie inférieure de l’ensemble péda-  
lier/pied arrière. Après avoir placé le Clavinova à l’en-  
droit où vous souhaitez l’installer, tournez ces disposi-  
tifs jusqu’à ce qu’ils soient en contact ferme avec la  
surface du sol. Ces dispositifs assurent la stabilité du  
pédalier lors de son utilisation et facilitent la com-  
mande au pied des effets. Si ces dispositifs ne sont pas  
en contact ferme avec le sol, il pourra se produire une  
distorsion du son.  
Para más estabilidad, se proporcionan cuatro regulado-  
res en la parte inferior de la caja de pedales y en el  
conjunto de la pata trasera. Después de situar la  
Clavinova en la posición deseada, gire los reguladores  
hasta que hagan buen contacto con la superficie del  
piso. Los reguladores aseguran una operación estable  
de los pedales y facilitan el control de los efectos con  
los pedales. Si los ajustadores no están en buen con-  
tacto con la superficie del piso, el sonido podría  
distorsionarse.  
Après avoir assemble le Clavinova, vérifiez de nouveau que toutes  
les vis sont bien serrées à fond.  
Después de haber montado la Clavinova, compruebe una vez más  
que todos los tornillos se hayan apretado bien.  
Si linstrument penche dun côté, sil fait un bruit inhabituel, ou sil  
paraît instable lorsque vous lutilisez, vérifiez que vous lavez as-  
semblé correctement et que toutes les vis sont bien serrées en  
suivant les instructions de montage données ici.  
Si el soporte se inclina a un lado, hace ruidos anormales, o parece  
inestable durante la utilización, compruebe y apriete todos los  
tornillos siguiendo las instrucciones de montaje anteriores.  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
5 x 50 mm long gold-colored screws x 6  
Goldfarbene Schrauben (5 x 50 mm) x 6  
Vis longues dorées de 5 x 50 mm x 6  
Tornillos dorados largos de 5 x 50 mm x 6  
A
1
B
6 x 20 mm large flat-head screws (black) x 8  
Senkschrauben (6 x 20 mm) x 8  
Grosses vis à tête plate de 6 x 20 mm (noires) x 8  
C
E
2
Tornillos grandes de cabeza plana (negros) de  
6 x 20 mm x 8  
C
D
D
4 x 20 mm small round-head screws (black) x 8  
Rundkopfschrauben (4 x 20 mm) x 8  
Petites vis à tête ronde de 4 x 20 mm (noires) x 8  
Tornillos pequeños de cabeza redonda (negros) de  
4 x 20 mm x 8  
AC power cord  
Netzkabel  
Cordon d’alimentation  
3
Cable de alimentación de CA  
CVP-69/69A: Assembly  
CVP-69A/69: Zusammenbau  
Wir raten Ihnen davon ab, das Clavinova alleine zusammenzu-  
bauen und aufzustellen. Zwei Personen können diese Arbeit jedoch  
problemlos ausführen.  
We do not recommend attempting to assemble the Clavinova  
alone. The job can be easily accomplished, however, with only two  
people.  
Verwenden Sie ausschließlich die mitgeliefenten Schrauben oder  
Ersatzschrauben identischer Größe. Die Verwendung von Schrau-  
ben mit abweichenden Maßen kann eine Beschädigung des Instru-  
ments zur Folge haben.  
Use only the screws provided or replacements of exactly the speci-  
fied size. Using screws of the wrong size can result in damage to  
the instrument.  
ZDen Versandkarton öffnen und alle Teile  
auspacken.  
ZOpen the box and remove all the parts.  
On opening the box you should find the parts shown in  
the illustration. Check to make sure that all the required  
parts are provided.  
Der Karton sollte alle in der Abbildung gezeigten Teile  
enthalten. Vergewissern Sie sich, daß alle Teile voll-  
zählig vorhanden sind.  
XAttach the feet (D) to the side panels (C).  
Secure the feet (D) to the side panels (C) using three 5  
x 50 mm long gold-colored screws 1 for each side.  
Make sure the rounded edge of the side panels and the  
protruding end of the feet are facing front.  
XDie Füße (D) an die Seitenwände (C) schrauben.  
Schrauben Sie die beiden Füße (D) mit jeweils drei  
goldfarbenen Schrauben (5 x 50 mm) 1 an den  
Seitenwänden (C) fest. Die abgerundete Kante der  
Seitenwände und das hervorspringende Ende der Füße  
müssen dabei nach vorne weisen.  
CAttach the speaker box (B) to the side pan-  
els (C).  
CDen Lautsprecherkasten (B) mit den Seiten-  
wänden (C) verschrauben.  
Remove the speaker box cover (attached with  
Velcro”) from the speaker box. (Be careful not to  
touch the speakers when handling the speaker box.  
Damage may result.) Secure the speaker box (B) to the  
side panels (C), as shown in the illustration, using one  
6 x 20 mm (large flat-head) screw 2 for each bottom  
bracket and two 4 x 20 mm (small round-head) screws  
3 for each side bracket. Make sure the side brackets  
are positioned inside of the speaker box (as shown in  
the illustration) before securing.  
Nehmen Sie die von Klettband gehaltene Bespannung  
vom Lautsprecherkasten ab. (Vermeiden Sie bei der  
Handhabung des Lautsprecherkastens unbedingt ein  
Berühren der Lautsprechermembrane, da diese leicht  
beschädigt werden.) Schrauben Sie nun den  
Lautsprecherkasten (B), wie in der Abbildung gezeigt,  
an den Seitenwänden (C) fest: Verwenden Sie jeweils  
eine Senkschraube (6 x 20 mm) 2 zum Befestigen an  
den beiden unteren Halterungen und jeweils zwei  
Rundkopfschrauben (4 x 20 mm) 3 zum Verschrauben  
mit den beiden seitlichen Halterungen. Vergewissern  
Sie sich vor dem Eindrehen der Schrauben, daß die  
Halterungen sich im Pedalkasten befinden (d.h. nicht  
sichtbar sind), wie in der Abbildung angedeutet.  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
3
B
C
B
C
D
4 x 20 mm (small round-head) screws  
Rundkopfschrauben (4 x 20 mm)  
Petites vis de 4 x 20 mm (à tête ronde)  
Tornillos de 4 x 20 mm (pequeños de cabeza redonda)  
5 x 50 mm long gold-colored screws  
Goldfarbene Schrauben (5 x 50 mm)  
Vis longues dorées de 5 x 50 mm  
Tornillos dorados largos de 5 x 50 mm  
3
1
6 x 20 mm (large flat-head) screw  
Senkschraube (6 x 20 mm)  
2
Grosses vis de 6 x 20 mm (à tête plate)  
Tornillo de 6 x 20 mm (grande de cabeza plana)  
CVP-69/69A: Montage  
CVP-69/69A: Montaje  
Nous ne vous conseillons pas dessayer dassembler le Clavinova  
seul. Toutefois, ce travail peut être facilement exécuté par deux  
personnes.  
No le recomendamos que monte la Clavinova usted solo. Sin  
embargo, el trabajo podrá realizarse con más facilidad entre dos  
personas solamente.  
Nutilisez que les vis fournies ou des vis ayant exactement les  
mêmes dimensions. Le fait dutiliser des vis de dimensions incor-  
rectes pourrait endommager linstrument.  
Emplee sólo los tornillos suministrados u otros que sean exacta-  
mente del mismo tamaño especificado. El empleo de tornillos del  
tamaño erróneo puede dañar el instrumento.  
ZOuvrez le carton et retirez toutes les pièces.  
Les pièces indiquées sur l’illustration devraient toutes  
se trouver dans le carton. Vérifiez qu’il n’en manque  
aucune.  
ZAbra la caja y extraiga todas las partes.  
Al abrir la caja, encontrará las partes mostradas en la  
ilustración de arriba. Compruebe y asegúrese de que  
no falta ninguna de las partes requeridas.  
XMontez les supports inférieurs (D) sur les  
panneaux latéraux (C)  
X
Monte las patas (D) en los paneles laterales (C).  
Fije las patas (D) a los paneles laterales (C) usando tres  
tornillos durados largos de 5 x 50 mm 1 para cada  
lado. Asegúrese de que el borde redondeado de los  
paneles laterales y el extremo que sobresale de los pies  
queden orientados hacia adelante.  
Fixez les supports inférieurs (D) aux panneaux latéraux  
(C) en utilisant trois vis longues dorées de 5 x 50 mm  
1 de chaque côté. Veillez à ce que le bord arrondi des  
panneaux latéraux et la partie qui dépasse des supports  
inférieurs soient dirigés vers l’avant.  
CMonte la caja de altavoces (B) en los pane-  
les laterales (C).  
CFixez la boîte des haut-parleurs (B) aux pan-  
neaux latéraux (C)  
Extraiga la cubierta de la caja de altavoces (unida con  
cinta de adhesión por contacto) de la caja de altavoces.  
(Tenga cuidado en no tocar los altavoces cuando se  
manipule la caja de altavoces. Podrían ocasionarse  
daños.) Fije le caja de altavoces (B) a los paneles late-  
rales (C), como se muestra en la ilustración, usando un  
tornillo de 6 x 20 mm (grande de cabeza plana) 2 para  
cada ménsula inferior y dos tornillos de 4 x 20 mm  
(pequeños de cabeza redonda) 3 para cada ménsula  
lateral. Asegúrese de que las ménsulas laterales que-  
den situadas dentro de la caja de altavoces (como se  
muestra en la ilustración) antes de la fijación.  
Retirez le couvercle (fixé au moyen de velcro) de la  
boîte des haut-parleurs. (Faites bien attention de ne pas  
toucher les haut-parleurs lorsque vous manipulez la  
boîte. Cela pourrait les endommager.) Fixez la boîte  
des haut-parleurs (B) aux panneaux latéraux (C) de la  
manière illustrée en utilisant une grosse vis 2 de 6 x  
20 mm (à tête plate) pour chaque ferrure inférieure et  
deux petites vis 3 de 4 x 20 mm (à tête ronde) pour  
chaque ferrure latérale. Assurez-vous que les ferrures  
latérales sont bien positionnées à l’intérieur de la boîte  
des haut-parleurs (comme montré sur l’illustration)  
avant de serrer les vis.  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
4 x 20 mm (small round-head) screws  
Rundkopfschrauben (4 x 20 mm)  
Petites vis de 4 x 20 mm (à tête ronde)  
Tornillos de 4 x 20 mm  
3
B
(pequeños de cabeza redonda)  
C
6 x 20 mm (large flat-head) screw  
Senkschraube (6 x 20 mm)  
Grosses vis de 6 x 20 mm (à tête plate)  
2
Tornillo de 6 x 20 mm (grande de cabeza plana)  
VAttach the pedal box (E) to the speaker box  
(B).  
VDen Pedalkasten (E) am Lautsprecherkasten  
(B) festschrauben.  
Secure the pedal box (E) to the speaker box (B) using  
one 6 x 20 mm (large flat-head) screw 2 for each  
bottom bracket and two 4 x 20 mm (small round-head)  
screws 3 for each rear bracket. Make sure that the  
pedal cord passes through the recess in the top of the  
pedal assembly and the speaker cord is extending out to  
the rear from the top of the speaker box (see illustra-  
tion).  
Schrauben Sie den Pedalkasten mit jeweils einer Senk-  
schraube (6 x 20 mm) 2 für die beiden unteren  
Halterungen und zwei Rundkopfschrauben (4 x 20  
mm) 3 für die beiden hinteren Halterungen an den  
Lautsprecherkasten (B). Achten Sie dabei darauf, daß  
das Pedalkabel oben aus dem einen Bein des Pedal-  
kastens ragt und das Lautsprecherkabel nach hinten  
gelegt ist, wie in der Abbildung gezeigt.  
BAttach the main keyboard unit (A). (Part 1)  
Gently lower the main keyboard unit (A) onto the  
speaker box (B) and stand assembly so that the rear of  
the main unit is positioned about 10cm behind the back  
of the side panel. WATCH YOUR FINGERS WHEN  
DOING THIS!! Insert one 6 x 20 mm (large flat-head)  
screw 2 into the innermost hole leaving about 1cm of  
the screw protruding on each side of the main unit’s  
bottom panel. These screws will slide into the rear  
side-panel brackets in step 6.  
BDie Haupteinheit (A) montieren. (Teil 1)  
Setzen Sie die Haupteinheit (A) vorsichtig so auf den  
Lautsprecherkasten und die Seitenwände, daß ihre  
Hinterseite etwa 10 cm über den Hinterkanten der  
Seitenwände übersteht. VORSICHT! KLEMMEN  
SIE SICH DABEI NICHT DIE FINGER EIN! Dre-  
hen Sie hinten an der Unterseite der Haupteinheit links  
und rechts jeweils eine Senkschraube (6 x 20 mm) 2  
in die innere Bohrung, so daß noch etwa 1 cm Gewinde  
hervorsteht. Diese Schrauben greifen in Schritt 6 in die  
hinteren Halterungen der Seitenwände.  
* Keep your fingers away from the area marked Danger Zonein  
the illustrations when lowering the main keyboard unit onto the  
stand assembly.  
* Halten Sie beim Aufsetzen der Haupteinheit auf die Ständer-  
baugruppe von dem in der Abbildung mit Gefahrenzonege-  
kennzeichneten Bereich fern.  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Danger Zone  
5
Gefahrenzone  
Zones dangereuses  
Zona peligrosa  
A
C
A
B
10 cm behind the side panel  
10 cm Überstand  
10 cm derrière le panneau latéral  
10 cm detrás del panel lateral  
6 x 20 mm (large flat-head) screw  
Senkschraube (6 x 20 mm)  
Grosses vis de 6 x 20 mm (à tête plate)  
Tornillo de 6 x 20 mm (grande de cabeza plana)  
2
VFixez le pédalier (E) à la boîte des haut-  
parleurs (B).  
VMonte la caja de pedales (E) en la caja de  
altavoces (B).  
Fixez le pédalier (E) à la boîte des haut-parleurs (B) en  
utilisant une grosse vis 2 de 6 x 20 mm (à tête plate)  
pour chaque ferrure inférieure et deux petites vis 3 de  
4 x 20 mm (à tête ronde) pour chaque ferrure arrière.  
Assurez-vous que le cordon du pédalier passe dans la  
découpe à la partie supérieure du pédalier et que le  
cordon des haut-parleurs sort vers l’arrière de la boîte  
des haut-parleurs (voir l’illustration).  
Fije la caja de pedales (E) a la caja de altavoces (B)  
usando un tornillo de 6 x 20 mm (grande de cabeza  
plana) 2 para cada ménsula inferior y dos tornillos de  
4 x 20 mm (pequeños de cabeza redonda) 3 para cada  
ménsula trasera. Asegúrese de que el cable de los pe-  
dales pasa por el hueco de la parte superior del conjun-  
to de pedales y que el cable de altavoces sale por la  
parte posterior de encima de la caja de altavoces (vea la  
ilustración).  
BPosez le clavier (A) (1ère étape)  
BMonte la unidad del teclado principal (A).  
(Parte 1)  
Abaissez le clavier (A) avec précaution sur la boîte des  
haut-parleurs (B) et sur les supports de manière que  
l’arrière du clavier dépasse de 10 cm environ derrière  
les panneaux latéraux. FAITES ATTENTION A VOS  
DOIGTS EN EXECUTANT CETTE OPERATION  
!! Mettez une vis 2 de 6 x 20 mm (à tête plate) dans  
le trou le plus à l’intérieur de chaque côté du clavier de  
manière que ces vis sortent d’environ 1 cm du panneau  
inférieur. Ces vis se glisseront dans les ferrures arrière  
des panneaux latéraux au cours de l’étape 6.  
Baje con cuidado la unidad del teclado principal (A) a  
la caja de altavoces (B) y conjunto del soporte de modo  
que la parte posterior de la unidad principal quede si-  
tuada a unos 10 cm detrás de la parte posterior del pa-  
nel lateral. ¡CUANDO LO HAGA, TENGA CUI-  
DADO CON LOS DEDOS! Inserte un tornillo de 6 x  
20 mm (grande de cabeza plana) 2 en el orificio más  
interior dejando aproximadamente 1 cm del tornillo  
sobresaliendo en cada lado del panel inferior de la uni-  
dad principal. Estos tornillos se deslizarán a las  
ménsulas del panel lateral trasero en el paso 6.  
* Lorsque vous abaissez le clavier sur son support, ne placez  
pas les mains dans les zones marquées Zones dangereuses”  
sur lillustration.  
* Mantenga apartados los dedos de la parte marcada con Zona  
peligrosaen las ilustraciones cuando baje la unidad del tecla-  
do principal al conjunto del soporte.  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
A
6 x 20 mm (large flat-head) screw  
Senkschraube (6 x 20 mm)  
Grosses vis de 6 x 20 mm (à tête plate)  
A
2
Tornillo de 6 x 20 mm  
(grande de cabeza plana)  
C
A
NAttach the main keyboard unit. (Part 2)  
NDie Haupteinheit montieren. (Teil 2)  
Positionieren Sie die Haupteinheit so auf der Ständer-  
baugruppe, daß die beiden eingedrehten Schrauben  
hinter den hinteren Halterungen an den Seitenwänden  
zu liegen kommen, und schieben Sie dann nach vorn,  
bis die Schrauben bis zum Anschlag in den  
With the protruding screw heads on the bottom panel  
of the main unit positioned behind the side-panel rear  
brackets, slide the main keyboard unit forward until the  
screw heads stop against the end of the slot in the rear  
brackets. Align the holes in the bottom of the main unit  
with those in the front side-panel brackets (also center  
the main unit to produce an equal clearance on the left  
and right sides, as shown in the illustrations), then se-  
cure the main keyboard unit to the stand assembly us-  
ing two 6 x 20 mm (large flat-head) screws 2 screwed  
through the front bracket and then firmly tightening the  
two protruding screws that slid into the rear brackets.  
Put the speaker box cover back in place with the  
Velcro” on the cover and speaker box. (Make sure that  
the upper edge of the cover fits snugly against the un-  
der side of the main unit.)  
Halterungsschlitzen sitzen. Bringen Sie die Bohrungen  
der vorderen Halterungen mit denen an der Unterseite  
der Haupteinheit zur Deckung (achten Sie auch darauf,  
daß die Haupteinheit mittig positioniert ist, d.h. links  
und rechts gleichviel übersteht, wie in der Abbildung  
gezeigt), und schrauben Sie die Haupteinheit dann mit  
zwei weiteren Senkschrauben (6 x 20 mm) 2 an den  
vorderen Halterungen fest, um danach die beiden be-  
reits eingedrehten Schrauben fest anzuziehen. Bringen  
Sie nun die Bespannung wieder an, indem Sie die  
Klettband-Gegenstücke an Bespannungsrahmen und  
Lautsprecherkasten aufeinander ausrichten. (Die Ober-  
kante des Bespannungsrahmens muß bündig an der  
Unterseite der Haupteinheit anliegen.)  
MConnect the speaker cord and pedal cord.  
Insert the speaker cord connector into the correspond-  
ing socket on the right (closest to the pedal box) of the  
keyboard unit. Plug the pedal cord connector into the  
socket on the left (farthest from the pedal box) of the  
keyboard unit. Note that both connectors must be in-  
serted with the protruding clip facing the rear of the  
main unit.  
MDas Lautsprecherkabel und das Pedalkabel  
anschließen.  
Schließen Sie das Lautsprecherkabel an die rechte  
(dem Pedalkasten am nächsten gelegene) Buchse an an  
der Unterseite der Haupteinheit an. Das Pedalkabel  
schließen Sie an die linke (am weitesten vom Pedal-  
kasten entfernte) Buchse an. Die beiden Stecker müs-  
sen mit der Führungsnase in Richtung Rückseite (der  
Haupteinheit) in die jeweilige Buchse gesteckt werden.  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
NPosez le clavier (A) (2ère étape)  
NMonte la unidad del teclado principal.  
(Parte 2)  
Les têtes de vis sortant du panneau inférieur du clavier  
étant positionnées derrière les ferrures arrières des pan-  
neaux latéraux, faites glisser le clavier vers l’avant  
jusqu’à ce que les têtes de vis soient en butée contre le  
fond de la fente des ferrures arrière. Alignez les trous  
du panneau inférieur du clavier sur les trous des ferru-  
res avant des panneaux latéraux (centrez également le  
clavier de manière à avoir un jeu identique de chaque  
côté, comme illustré). Fixez ensuite le clavier sur le  
support en vissant une grosse vis 2 de 6 x 20 mm (à  
tête plate) à travers chaque ferrure avant et en serrant à  
fond les deux vis glissées dans les ferrures arrière. Re-  
posez le couvercle de la boîte des haut-parleurs et  
fixez-le au moyen des velcros du couvercle et de la  
boîte. (Assurez-vous que le bord supérieur du couver-  
cle est bien calé contre le panneau inférieur du clavier.)  
Con las cabezas de tornillos sobresaliendo por el panel  
inferior de la unidad principal situado detrás de las  
ménsulas traseras del panel lateral, deslice la unidad  
del teclado principal hacia adelante hasta que las cabe-  
zas de tornillos topen contra el extremo de la ranura de  
las ménsulas traseras. Alinee los orificios de la parte  
inferior de la unidad principal con los de las ménsulas  
del panel lateral frontal (centre también la unidad prin-  
cipal para producir una holgura igual en los lados iz-  
quierdo y derecho, como se muestra en las ilustracio-  
nes), y fije entonces la unidad del teclado principal en  
el conjunto del soporte usando dos tornillos de 6 x 20  
mm (grandes de cabeza plana) 2 enroscados por la  
ménsula frontal y apriete entonces bien los tornillos  
que sobresalen que se incorporan en las ménsulas trase-  
ras. Ponga de nuevo la cubierta de la caja de altavoces  
en su lugar con la cinta de adhesión por contacto de la  
cubierta y de la caja de altavoces. (Asegúrese de que el  
borde superior de la cubierta se adapta bien contra el  
lado inferior de la unidad principal.)  
MConnectez le cordon des haut-parleurs et le  
cordon du pédalier.  
Branchez le connecteur du cordon des haut-parleurs à  
la prise correspondante sur le côté droit du clavier (la  
plus proche du pédalier). Branchez le connecteur du  
cordon du pédalier à la prise située sur le côté gauche  
du clavier (la plus éloignée du pédalier). Veuillez noter  
que les deux connecteurs doivent être branchés avec la  
partie en saillie dirigée vers l’arrière du clavier.  
MConecte el cable de altavoces y el cable de  
pedales.  
Inserte el conector del cable de altavoces en el receptá-  
culo correspondiente de la derecha (más cercano a la  
caja de pedales) de la unidad del teclado. Enchufe el  
conector del cable de pedales en el receptáculo de la  
izquierda (el más apartado de la caja de pedales) de la  
unidad del teclado. Tenga presente que ambos  
conectores deben insertarse con el retenedor saliente  
orientado a la parte trasera de la unidad principal.  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8
A voltage selector is provided in some areas.  
Spannungswähler  
(nur in bestimmten Verkaufsgebieten)  
Un sélecteur de tension est prévu pour  
certaines régions  
El selector de tensión está provisto para  
ciertos destinos.  
2 4 0  
127  
<Voltage Selector  
<Den Spannungswähler einstellen.  
Bevor Sie nun das Netzkabel anschließen, müssen Sie  
den Spannungswähler (falls vorhanden) auf die örtliche  
Netzspannung einstellen. Zum Verstellen drehen Sie  
den Spannungswähler mit einem  
Before connecting the AC power cord, check the set-  
ting of the voltage selector which is provided in some  
areas. To set the selector for 110V, 127V, 220V or  
240V main voltages, use a “minus” screwdriver to ro-  
tate the selector dial so that the correct voltage for your  
region appears next to the pointer on the panel. The  
voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially  
shipped.  
Schlitzschraubendreher, bis der richtige Spannungswert  
(110, 127, 220 oder 240) an der Pfeilmarkierung steht.  
Bei der Auslieferung werden alle Instrumente mit  
Spannungswähler auf “240” voreingestellt.  
After the proper voltage has been selected connect the  
AC power cord. A plug adaptor may be also provided  
in some areas to match the pin configuration of the AC  
wall outlets in your area.  
Nachdem Sie den Spannungswähler richtig eingestellt  
haben, können Sie nun das Netzkabel anschließen. In  
manchen Gebieten wird ein Steckerdapter mitgeliefert,  
um den Anschluß an die evtl. unterschiedlich geformte  
Steckdose zu ermöglichen.  
>Be sure to set the pedal adjusters.  
For stability, two adjusters are provided on the bottom  
of the pedal assembly (E). Rotate the adjusters until  
they comes in firm contact with the floor surface. The  
adjusters ensure stable pedal operation and facilitate  
pedal effect control. If the adjusters are not in firm  
contact with the floor surface, distorted sound may  
result.  
>Die Pedalstützen einstellen.  
Für bessere Standfestigkeit sind unter dem Pedalkasten  
(E) zwei verstellbare Pedalstützen vorgesehen. Nach-  
dem Sie das Clavinova an seinem festen Standplatz  
aufgestellt haben, drehen Sie diese Stützen heraus, bis  
sie fest auf dem Boden stehen. Die Stützen sorgen  
beim Spielen für präzise Pedalbetätigung. Wenn die  
beiden Pedalstützen nicht fest auf dem Boden aufste-  
hen, können Klangverzerrungen auftreten.  
After assembling the Clavinova, check once more to make sure  
that all screws have been securely fastened.  
If the stand leans to the side, makes unusual noises, or otherwise  
seems unstable during use, check and tighten all screws while  
following the assembly instructions given above.  
Vergewissern Sie sich nach Zusammenbau und Aufstellung des  
Clavinova noch einmal davon, daß alle Schrauben fest angezogen  
sind.  
Wenn das Instrument schief steht, komische Geräusche erzeugt  
oder sich beim Spielen wackelig anfühlt, prüfen Sie gemäß den  
obigen Anweisungen, ob das Instrument richtig zusammengebaut  
wurde, und ziehen dabei die einzelnen Schrauben noch einmal  
nach.  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
E
<Sélecteur de tension  
<Selector de tensión  
Avant de connecter le cordon d’alimentation, vérifiez  
le réglage du sélecteur de tension qui est prévu pour  
certaines régions. Pour régler le sélecteur sur 110 V,  
127 V, 220 V ou 240 V, utilisez un tournevis à lame  
plate pour tourner le cadran du sélecteur afin de mettre  
l’indication correspondant à la tension de votre région  
vis à vis du repère triangulaire situé sur le panneau. Le  
sélecteur de tension est réglé sur 240 V au départ  
d’usine.  
Antes de conectar el cable de alimentación de CA,  
compruebe el ajuste del selector de tensión que se in-  
corpora para ciertos destinos. Para ajustar el selector a  
110V, 127V, 220V ó 240V de la red de alimentación,  
emplee un destornillador de cabeza recta “–” para girar  
el selector de modo que la tensión correcta de su zona  
aparezca al lado del indicador del panel. El selector de  
tensión se ajusta a 240V cuando la unidad sale de fábri-  
ca.  
Une fois que vous avez réglé le sélecteur de tension,  
connectez le cordon d’alimentation. Un adaptateur de  
prise peut également être fourni dans certaines régions  
pour pouvoir brancher le cordon à la prise secteur mu-  
rale.  
Después de haber seleccionado la tensión correcta,  
enchufe el cable de alimentación. En algunas zonas  
puede suministrarse también un adaptador para adaptar  
la configuración de las patillas de los tomacorrientes de  
CA de su localidad.  
>N’oubliez pas de régler la hauteur du péda-  
lier.  
>Asegúrese de ajustar los reguladores de los  
pedales.  
Pour assurer la stabilité, deux dispositifs de réglage ont  
été prévus à la partie inférieure du pédalier (E). Tour-  
nez ces dispositifs jusqu’à ce qu’ils soient en contact  
ferme avec la surface du sol. Ces dispositifs assurent  
la stabilité du pédalier lors de son utilisation et facili-  
tent la commande au pied des effets. Si ces dispositifs  
ne sont pas en contact ferme avec le sol, il pourra se  
produire une distorsion du son.  
Para más estabilidad, se proporcionan dos reguladores  
en la parte inferior del conjunto de pedales (E). Gire  
los reguladores hasta que hagan buen contacto con la  
superficie del piso. Los reguladores aseguran una ope-  
ración estable de los pedales y facilitan el control de  
los efectos con los pedales. Si los ajustadores no están  
en buen contacto con la superficie del piso, el sonido  
podría distorsionarse.  
Après avoir assemble le Clavinova, vérifiez de nouveau que toutes  
les vis sont bien serrées à fond.  
Después de haber montado la Clavinova, compruebe una vez más  
que todos los tornillos se hayan apretado bien.  
Si linstrument penche dun côté, sil fait un bruit inhabituel, ou sil  
paraît instable lorsque vous lutilisez, vérifiez que vous lavez as-  
semblé correctement et que toutes les vis sont bien serrées en  
suivant les instructions de montage données ici.  
Si el soporte se inclina a un lado, hace ruidos anormales, o parece  
inestable durante la utilización, compruebe y apriete todos los  
tornillos siguiendo las instrucciones de montaje anteriores.  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
6 x 25 mm round-head screws x4  
Rundkopfschrauben (6 x 25 mm) x 4  
Vis à tête ronde de 6 x 25 mm x 4  
A
1
2
3
Tornillos de cabeza redonda de 6 x 25 mm x 4  
B
C
4 x 20 mm round-head screws x4  
Rundkopfschrauben (4 x 20 mm) x 4  
Vis à tête ronde de 4 x 20 mm x 4  
Tornillos de cabeza redonda de 4 x 20 mm x 4  
Bundled pedal cord inside  
Gebündeltes Pedalkabel  
Cordon de pédalier enroulé à l’intérieur  
Cable de pedales enrollado en el interior  
6 x 18 mm flat-head screws x6  
Senkschrauben (6 x 18 mm) x 6  
Vis à tête plate de 6 x 18 mm x 6  
Tornillos de cabeza plana de 6 x 18 mm x 6  
D
AC power cord  
Netzkabel  
Cordon d’alimentation  
Cable de alimentación de CA  
CVP-59S: Assembly  
CVP-59S: Zusammenbau  
We do not recommend attempting to assemble the Clavinova  
alone. The job can be easily accomplished, however, with only two  
people.  
Wir raten Ihnen davon ab, das Clavinova alleine zusammenzu-  
bauen und aufzustellen. Zwei Personen können diese Arbeit jedoch  
problemlos ausführen.  
Use only the screws provided or replacements of exactly the speci-  
fied size. Using screws of the wrong size can result in damage to  
the instrument.  
Verwenden Sie ausschließlich die mitgeliefenten Schrauben oder  
Ersatzschrauben identischer Größe. Die Verwendung von Schrau-  
ben mit abweichenden Maßen kann eine Beschädigung des Instru-  
ments zur Folge haben.  
ZOpen the box and remove all the parts.  
On opening the box you should find the parts shown in  
the illustration above. Check to make sure that all the  
required parts are provided.  
ZDen Versandkarton öffnen und alle Teile  
auspacken.  
Der Karton sollte alle in der Abbildung gezeigten Teile  
enthalten. Vergewissern Sie sich, daß alle Teile voll-  
zählig vorhanden sind.  
XAttach the side panels (D) to the pedal box  
(C).  
XDie Seitenwände (D) mit dem Pedalkasten  
(C) verschrauben.  
Before installing the pedal box, untie and straighten out  
the bundled cord attached to the bottom of the pedal  
box.  
Place the pedal box on top of the wooden blocks at-  
tached to the side panels (D), and attach using the four  
6 x 25 mm round-head screws 1 — two screws on  
each side. Make sure the pedals extend in the same  
direction as the feet.  
Bevor Sie den Pedalkasten festschrauben, lösen Sie  
zunächst das an der Unterseite des Pedalkastens befe-  
stigte Kabel und ziehen es gerade.  
Setzen Sie den Pedalkasten auf die Holzklötze an den  
Innenseiten der Seitenwände (D), um ihn dann mit den  
vier größeren Rundkopfschrauben (6 x 25 mm) 1  
festzuschrauben (jeweils zwei Schrauben links und  
rechts). Achten Sie darauf, daß die Pedale und die Füße  
in dieselbe Richtung weisen.  
CAttach the center panel (B) to the side pan-  
els (D).  
CDie Rückwand (B) an die beiden Seiten-  
wände (D) schrauben.  
The center panel (B) should be screwed to the vertical  
brackets on the side panels (D) using the four 4 x 20  
mm round-head screws 2, as shown in the illustration.  
Make sure the center panel is attached to the side of the  
brackets facing the pedals.  
Die Rückwand wird an den beiden senkrecht ange-  
brachten Halterungen mit den vier kleineren Rundkopf-  
schrauben (4 x 20 mm) 2 festgeschraubt, wie in der  
Abbildung gezeigt. Achten Sie darauf, daß die Rück-  
wand vor den Halterungen angesetzt und fest-  
geschraubt wird.  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
3
6 x 25 mm round-head screws  
Rundkopfschrauben (6 x 25 mm)  
Vis à tête ronde de 6 x 25 mm  
1
Tornillos de cabeza redonda de 6 x 25 mm x 4  
B
D
C
D
C
4 x 20 mm round-head screws  
Rundkopfschrauben (4 x 20 mm)  
Vis à tête ronde de 4 x 20 mm  
2
Tornillos de cabeza redonda de 4 x 20 mm x 4  
CVP-59S: Montage  
CVP-59S: Montaje  
Nous ne vous conseillons pas dessayer dassembler le Clavinova  
seul. Toutefois, ce travail peut être facilement exécuté par deux  
personnes.  
No le recomendamos que monte la Clavinova usted solo. Sin  
embargo, el trabajo podrá realizarse con más facilidad entre dos  
personas solamente.  
Nutilisez que les vis fournies ou des vis ayant exactement les  
mêmes dimensions. Le fait dutiliser des vis de dimensions incor-  
rectes pourrait endommager linstrument.  
Emplee sólo los tornillos suministrados u otros que sean exacta-  
mente del mismo tamaño especificado. El empleo de tornillos del  
tamaño erróneo puede dañar el instrumento.  
ZOuvrez le carton et retirez toutes les pièces.  
Les pièces indiquées sur l’illustration devraient toutes  
se trouver dans le carton. Vérifiez qu’il n’en manque  
aucune.  
ZAbra la caja y extraiga todas las partes.  
Al abrir la caja, encontrará las partes mostradas en la  
ilustración de arriba. Compruebe y asegúrese de que  
no falta ninguna de las partes requeridas.  
XFixez les panneaux latéraux (D) au pédalier  
(C)  
XMonte los paneles laterales (D) en la caja de  
pedales (C).  
Avant de poser le pédalier, détachez le cordon de la  
partie inférieure du pédalier et déroulez-le.  
Placez le pédalier sur les cales en bois fixées aux pan-  
neaux latéraux (D) et fixez-le en utilisant les quatre vis  
à tête ronde 1 de 6 x 25 mm : deux vis de chaque  
côté. Veillez à ce que les pédales et la partie qui dé-  
passe des supports inférieurs soient dirigées dans le  
même sens.  
Antes de instalar la caja de pedales, desate y alargue el  
cable enrollado unido a la parte inferior de la caja de  
pedales.  
Coloque la caja de pedales encima de bloques de ma-  
dera colocados en los paneles laterales (D), y una usan-  
do los cuatro tornillos de cabeza redonda de 6 x 25 mm  
1; dos tornillos en cada lado. Asegúrese de que los  
pedales se extienden en la misma dirección que las  
patas.  
CFixez le panneau central (B) aux panneaux  
latéraux (D)  
CMonte el panel central (B) en los paneles  
laterales (D).  
Le panneau central (B) doit être fixé aux ferrures verti-  
cales des panneaux latéraux (D) à l’aide des quatre vis  
à tête ronde 2 de 4 x 20 mm, comme illustré. Assu-  
rez-vous que le panneau central est fixé sur le côté des  
ferrures dirigé vers le pédalier  
El panel central (B) debe enroscarse a las ménsulas  
verticales de los paneles laterales (D) usando los cuatro  
tornillos de cabeza redonda de 4 x 20 mm 2, como se  
muestra en la ilustración. Asegúrese de que el panel  
central queda unido al lado de las ménsulas orientado a  
los pedales.  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Danger Zone  
Gefahrenzone  
Zones dangereuses  
Zona peligrosa  
A
A
6 x 18 mm flat-head screws  
Senkschrauben (6 x 18 mm)  
Vis à tête plate de 6 x 18 mm  
Tornillos de cabeza plana de  
6 x 18 mm  
3
D
D
A
VInstall the main unit (A).  
VDie Haupteinheit (A) montieren.  
Gently place the main unit (A) on the side panels (D)  
with the screws on its bottom panel (toward the rear of  
the main unit) just in front of the grooves in the brack-  
ets located at the top of the side panels. Then slide the  
main unit to the rear until it stops. WATCH YOUR  
FINGERS WHEN DOING THIS!!  
Align the holes on the bottom panel of the main unit  
with the holes in the brackets on the side panels (also  
center the main unit to produce an equal clearance on  
the left and right sides, as shown in the illustration),  
then screw in and securely tighten the six 6 x 18mm  
flat-head screws 3 (three screws for each side of the  
main unit).  
Setzen Sie die Haupteinheit (A) vorsichtig so auf die  
Seitenwände (D), daß die Schrauben an ihrer Unter-  
seite (hinten) vor den oberen Halterungen an den  
Seitenwänden zu liegen kommen. Schieben Sie die  
Haupteinheit dann nach hinten, bis die Schrauben bis  
zum Anschlag in den Halterungsschlitzen sitzen. VOR-  
SICHT! KLEMMEN SIE SICH DABEI NICHT  
DIE FINGER EIN!  
Bringen Sie nun die Bohrungen in den beiden seitli-  
chen Halterungen mit den Bohrungen an der Unterseite  
der Haupteinheit zur Deckung (achten Sie auch darauf,  
daß die Haupteinheit mittig positioniert ist, d.h. links  
und rechts gleichviel übersteht, wie in der Abbildung  
gezeigt), und schrauben Sie die Haupteinheit dann mit  
den sechs Senkschrauben (6 x 18 mm) 3 fest (jeweils  
drei Schrauben links und rechts).  
* Keep your fingers away from the area marked Danger Zonein  
the illustrations when lowering the main keyboard unit onto the  
stand assembly.  
* Halten Sie beim Aufsetzen der Haupteinheit auf die Ständer-  
baugruppe von dem in der Abbildung mit Gefahrenzonege-  
kennzeichneten Bereich fern.  
BConnect the pedal cord.  
Pass the pedal cord through the two cord holders on the  
side panel. Insert the connector on the free end of the  
cord into the corresponding socket on the underside of  
the main unit. Make sure that the protruding clip on the  
connector is facing the rear of the main unit. Close the  
clips of the two cord holders to keep the cord firmly in  
place.  
BDas Pedalkabel anschließen.  
Führen Sie das Pedalkabel durch die beiden  
Kabelhalter an der Seitenwand. Schließen Sie das Ka-  
bel danach an die Buchse auf der Unterseite der Haupt-  
einheit an. Der Stecker muß mit der Führungsnase in  
Richtung Rückseite (der Haupteinheit) in die Buchse  
gesteckt werden. Drücken Sie nun noch die Klemmen  
der Kabelhalter fest an, damit das Kabel sicher gehal-  
ten wird.  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
A
A
D
Cord holder  
Kabelhalter  
C
Support de cordon  
Soporte de cable  
VPosez le clavier (A)  
VMonte la unidad principal (A).  
Placez le clavier (A) sur les panneaux latéraux (D),  
Coloque con cuidado la unidad principal (A) en los  
paneles laterales (D) con los tornillos de su panel infe-  
rior (hacia la parte trasera de la unidad principal) junto  
delante de las ranuras situadas en la parte superior de  
los paneles laterales. Entonces, deslice la unidad prin-  
cipal hacia atrás hasta que haga tope. ¡CUANDO LO  
HAGA, TENGA CUIDADO CON LOS DEDOS!  
Alinee los orificios del panel inferior de la unidad prin-  
cipal con los de las ménsulas de los paneles laterales  
(centre también la unidad principal para producir una  
holgura igual en los lados izquierdo y derecho, como se  
muestra en la ilustración), y entonces enrosque y aprie-  
te bien los seis tornillos de cabeza plana de 6 x 18 mm  
3 (tres tornillos para cada lado de la unidad principal).  
avec les vis de son panneau inférieur (situées vers l’ar-  
rière du clavier) placées immédiatement derrière les  
fentes des ferrures situées à la partie supérieure des  
panneaux latéraux (D), puis faites glisser le clavier vers  
l’avant jusqu’à ce qu’il vienne en butée. FAITES AT-  
TENTION A VOS DOIGTS EN EXECUTANT  
CETTE OPERATION !!  
Alignez les trous du panneau inférieur du clavier sur  
les trous des ferrures des panneaux latéraux (centrez  
également le clavier de manière à avoir un jeu identi-  
que de chaque côté comme montré sur l’illustration)  
puis posez et serrez à fond les six vis à tête plate 3 de  
6 x 18 mm (trois vis de chaque côté du clavier).  
* Lorsque vous abaissez le clavier sur son support, ne placez  
pas les mains dans les zones marquées Zones dangereuses”  
sur lillustration.  
* Mantenga apartados los dedos de la parte marcada con Zona  
peligrosaen las ilustraciones cuando baje la unidad del tecla-  
do principal al conjunto del soporte.  
BConnectez le cordon du pédalier  
BConecte el cable de pedales.  
Faites passer le cordon du pédalier dans les deux sup-  
ports de cordon situés sur le panneau latéral. La prise  
doit être branchée au connecteur correspondant situé à  
la partie inférieure du clavier. Assurez-vous que la  
partie en saillie de la prise est dirigée vers l’arrière du  
clavier. Fermez soigneusement les deux supports pour  
maintenir le cordon bien en place.  
Pase el cable de pedales por los dos soportes de cable  
del panel lateral. Inserte el conector del extremo libre  
del cable en el receptáculo correspondiente de la parte  
inferior de la unidad principal. Asegúrese de que el  
conector deben insertarse con el retenedor saliente  
orientado a la parte trasera de la unidad principal.  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
A voltage selector is provided in some areas.  
A
Spannungswähler  
(nur in bestimmten Verkaufsgebieten)  
Un sélecteur de tension est prévu pour  
certaines régions  
2 4 0  
El selector de tensión está provisto para  
ciertos destinos.  
127  
NVoltage Selector  
NDen Spannungswähler einstellen.  
Bevor Sie nun das Netzkabel anschließen, müssen Sie  
den Spannungswähler (falls vorhanden) auf die örtliche  
Netzspannung einstellen. Zum Verstellen drehen Sie  
den Spannungswähler mit einem  
Before connecting the AC power cord, check the set-  
ting of the voltage selector which is provided in some  
areas. To set the selector for 110V, 127V, 220V or  
240V main voltages, use a “minus” screwdriver to ro-  
tate the selector dial so that the correct voltage for your  
region appears next to the pointer on the panel. The  
voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially  
shipped.  
Schlitzschraubendreher, bis der richtige Spannungswert  
(110, 127, 220 oder 240) an der Pfeilmarkierung steht.  
Bei der Auslieferung werden alle Instrumente mit  
Spannungswähler auf “240” voreingestellt.  
After the proper voltage has been selected connect the  
AC power cord. A plug adaptor may be also provided  
in some areas to match the pin configuration of the AC  
wall outlets in your area.  
Nachdem Sie den Spannungswähler richtig eingestellt  
haben, können Sie nun das Netzkabel anschließen. In  
manchen Gebieten wird ein Steckerdapter mitgeliefert,  
um den Anschluß an die evtl. unterschiedlich geformte  
Steckdose zu ermöglichen.  
MSet the adjuster.  
MDie Pedalstütze einstellen.  
For stability, an adjuster is provided on the bottom of  
the pedal box (C). Rotate the adjuster until it comes in  
firm contact with the floor surface. The adjuster en-  
sures stable pedal operation and facilitates pedal effect  
control. If the adjuster is not in firm contact with the  
floor surface, distorted sound may result.  
Für bessere Standfestigkeit ist unter dem Pedalkasten  
(C) eine verstellbare Pedalstütze vorgesehen. Nachdem  
Sie das Clavinova an seinem festen Standplatz aufge-  
stellt haben, drehen Sie diese Stütze heraus, bis sie fest  
auf dem Boden steht. Die Stütze sorgt beim Spielen für  
präzise Pedalbetätigung. Wenn die Pedalstütze nicht  
fest auf dem Boden aufsteht, können  
Klangverzerrungen auftreten.  
After assembling the Clavinova, check once more to make sure  
that all screws have been securely fastened.  
If the stand leans to the side, makes unusual noises, or otherwise  
seems unstable during use, check and tighten all screws while  
following the assembly instructions given above.  
Vergewissern Sie sich nach Zusammenbau und Aufstellung des  
Clavinova noch einmal davon, daß alle Schrauben fest angezogen  
sind.  
Wenn das Instrument schief steht, komische Geräusche erzeugt  
oder sich beim Spielen wackelig anfühlt, prüfen Sie gemäß den  
obigen Anweisungen, ob das Instrument richtig zusammengebaut  
wurde, und ziehen dabei die einzelnen Schrauben noch einmal  
nach.  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
C
NSélecteur de tension  
NSelector de tensión  
Avant de connecter le cordon d’alimentation, vérifiez  
le réglage du sélecteur de tension qui est prévu pour  
certaines régions. Pour régler le sélecteur sur 110 V,  
127 V, 220 V ou 240 V, utilisez un tournevis à lame  
plate pour tourner le cadran du sélecteur afin de mettre  
l’indication correspondant à la tension de votre région  
vis à vis du repère triangulaire situé sur le panneau. Le  
sélecteur de tension est réglé sur 240 V au départ  
d’usine.  
Antes de conectar el cable de alimentación de CA,  
compruebe el ajuste del selector de tensión que se in-  
corpora para ciertos destinos. Para ajustar el selector a  
110V, 127V, 220V ó 240V de la red de alimentación,  
emplee un destornillador de cabeza recta “-” para girar  
el selector de modo que la tensión correcta de su zona  
aparezca al lado del indicador del panel. El selector de  
tensión se ajusta a 240V cuando la unidad sale de fábri-  
ca.  
Une fois que vous avez réglé le sélecteur de tension,  
connectez le cordon d’alimentation. Un adaptateur de  
prise peut également être fourni dans certaines régions  
pour pouvoir brancher le cordon à la prise secteur mu-  
rale.  
Después de haber seleccionado la tensión correcta,  
enchufe el cable de alimentación. En algunas zonas  
puede suministrarse también un adaptador para adaptar  
la configuración de las patillas de los tomacorrientes de  
CA de su localidad.  
MRéglez la hauteur du pédalier  
MAjuste los reguladores.  
Pour assurer la stabilité, un dispositif de réglage a été  
prévu à la partie inférieure du pédalier (C). Tournez ce  
dispositif jusqu’à ce qu’il soit en contact ferme avec la  
surface du sol. Ce dispositif assure la stabilité du péda-  
lier lors de son utilisation et facilitent la commande au  
pied des effets. Si ce dispositif n’est pas en contact  
ferme avec le sol, il pourra se produire une distorsion  
du son.  
Para más estabilidad, se proporciona un regulador en la  
parte inferior de la caja de pedales (C). Gire el regula-  
dor hasta que haga buen contacto con la superficie del  
piso. El regulador asegura una operación estable de los  
pedales y facilita el control de los efectos con los peda-  
les. Si el ajustador no está en buen contacto con la  
superficie del piso, el sonido podría distorsionarse.  
Después de haber montado la Clavinova, compruebe una vez más  
que todos los tornillos se hayan apretado bien.  
Après avoir monté le Clavinova, vérifiez de nouveau que toutes les  
vis sont bien serrées à fond.  
Si el soporte se inclina a un lado, hace ruidos anormales, o parece  
inestable durante la utilización, compruebe y apriete todos los  
tornillos siguiendo las instrucciones de montaje anteriores.  
Si linstrument penche dun côté, sil fait un bruit inhabituel, ou sil  
paraît instable lorsque vous lutilisez, vérifiez que vous lavez as-  
semblé correctement et que toutes les vis sont bien serrées en  
suivant les instructions de montage données ici.  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A).  
Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference will  
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT!  
This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in  
this manual, meets FCC requirements. Modifications not expressly  
approved by Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to  
use the product.  
not occur in all installations. If this product is found to be the source of  
interference, which can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”,  
please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the following measures:  
Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the  
interference.  
2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to accessories and/or  
another product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied  
with this product MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions.  
Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to use  
this product in the USA.  
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or fuse)  
circuits or install AC line filter/s.  
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the antenna. If the  
antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead, change the lead-in to co-axial type  
cable.  
3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply with the  
requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital  
devices. Compliance with these requirements provides a reasonable  
level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential environ-  
ment will not result in harmful interference with other electronic devices.  
This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if not installed  
and used according to the instructions found in the users manual, may  
cause interference harmful to the operation of other electronic devices.  
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results, please  
contact the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of product. If you  
can not locate the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corporation  
of America, Electronic Service Division, 6600 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena  
Park, CA90620  
The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by  
Yamaha Corporation of America or its subsidiaries.  
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.  
IMPORTANT NOTICE FOR THE UNITED KINGDOM  
Connecting the Plug and Cord  
IMPORTANT. The wires in this mains lead are coloured in accordance  
with the following code:  
BLUE  
BROWN  
:
:
NEUTRAL  
LIVE  
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this apparatus may not  
correspond with the coloured makings identifying the terminals in your  
plug proceed as follows:  
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal  
which is marked with the letter N or coloured BLACK.  
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the terminal  
which is marked with the letter L or coloured RED.  
Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth terminal of the  
three pin plug.  
CANADA  
THIS DIGITAL APPARATUS DOES NOT EXCEED THE “CLASS B”  
LIMITS FOR RADIO NOISE EMISSIONS FROM DIGITAL APPARA-  
TUS SET OUT IN THE RADIO INTERFERENCE REGULATION OF  
THE CANADIAN DEPARTMENT OF COMMUNICATIONS.  
LE PRESENT APPAREIL NUMERIQUE N’EMET PAS DE BRUITS  
RADIOELECTRIQUES DEPASSANT LES LIMITES APPLICABLES  
AUX APPAREILS NUMERIQUES DE LA “CLASSE B” PRESCRITES  
DANS LE REGLEMENT SUR LE BROUILLAGE RADIOELECTRIQUE  
EDICTE PAR LE MINISTERE DES COMMUNICATIONS DU CANADA.  
CAUTION:  
TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH WIDE  
BLADE OF PLUG TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT.  
ATTENTION:  
POUR ÉVITER LES CHOCS ÉLECTRIQUES,  
INTRODUIRE LA LAME LA PLUS LARGE DE LA FICHE DANS LA  
BORNE CORRESPONDANTE DE LA PRISE ET POUSSER  
JUSQU’AU FOND.  
• This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha Canada Music Ltd.  
• Ceci ne s’applique qu’aux produits distribués par Yamaha Canada Musique Ltée.  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
INFORMATION RELATING TO PERSONAL INJURY, ELECTRICAL SHOCK,  
AND FIRE HAZARD POSSIBILITIES HAS BEEN INCLUDED IN THIS LIST.  
WARNING- When using any electrical or electronic prod-  
uct, basic precautions should always be followed. These pre-  
cautions include, but are not limited to, the following:  
8.  
This product was NOT designed for use in wet/damp loca-  
tions and should not be used near water or exposed to rain. Exam-  
ples of wet/damp locations are; near a swimming pool, spa, tub,  
sink, or wet basement.  
1.  
Read all Safety Instructions, Installation Instructions,  
Special Message Section items, and any Assembly Instructions  
found in this manual BEFORE marking any connections, in-  
cluding connection to the main supply.  
9.  
This product should be used only with the components  
supplied or; a cart, rack, or stand that is recommended by the  
manufacturer. If a cart, rack, or stand is used, please observe all  
safety markings and instructions that accompany the accessory  
product.  
2.  
Main Power Supply Verification: Yamaha products are  
manufactured specifically for the supply voltage in the area  
where they are to be sold. If you should move, or if any doubt  
exists about the supply voltage in your area, please contact  
your dealer for supply voltage verification and (if applicable)  
instructions. The required supply voltage is printed on the  
name plate. For name plate location, please refer to the graphic  
found in the Special Message Section of this manual.  
10.  
The power supply cord (plug) should be disconnected from  
the outlet when electronic products are to be left unused for ex-  
tended periods of time. Cords should also be disconnected when  
there is a high probability of lightening and/or electrical storm  
activity.  
11.  
Care should be taken that objects do not fall and liquids are  
not spilled into the enclosure through any openings that may exist.  
3.  
This product may be equipped with a polarized plug  
(one blade wider than the other). If you are unable to insert the  
plug into the outlet, turn the plug over and try again. If the  
problem persists, contact an electrician to have the obsolete  
outlet replaced. Do NOT defeat the safety purpose of the plug.  
12.  
Electrical/electronic products should be serviced by a  
qualified service person when:  
a. The power supply cord has been damaged; or  
b. Objects have fallen, been inserted, or liquids have been  
spilled into the enclosure through openings; or  
c. The product has been exposed to rain; or  
d. The product does not operate, exhibits a marked change  
in performance; or  
4.  
Some electronic products utilize external power sup-  
plies or adapters. Do NOT connect this type of product to any  
power supply or adapter other than one described in the owners  
manual, on the name plate, or specifically recommended by  
Yamaha.  
e. The product has been dropped, or the enclosure of the  
product has been damaged.  
5.  
WARNING: Do not place this product or any other  
objects on the power cord or place it in a position where any-  
one could walk on, trip over, or roll anything over power or  
connecting cords of any kind. The use of an extension cord is  
not recommended! If you must use an extension cord, the  
minimum wire size for a 25' cord (or less) is 18 AWG. NOTE:  
The smaller the AWG number, the larger the current handling  
capacity. For longer extension cords, consult a local electri-  
cian.  
13.  
Do not attempt to service this product beyond that de-  
scribed in the user-maintenance instructions. All other servicing  
should be referred to qualified service personnel.  
14.  
This product, either alone or in combination with an ampli-  
fier and headphones or speaker/s, may be capable of producing  
sound levels that could cause permanent hearing loss. DO NOT  
operate for a long period of time at a high volume level or at a  
level that is uncomfortable. If you experience any hearing loss or  
ringing in the ears, you should consult an audiologist.  
IMPORTANT: The louder the sound, the shorter the time period  
before damage occurs.  
6.  
Ventilation: Electronic products, unless specifically  
designed for enclosed installations, should be placed in loca-  
tions that do not interfere with proper ventilation. If instruc-  
tions for enclosed installations are not provided, it must be  
assumed that unobstructed ventilation is required.  
15.  
Some Yamaha products may have benches and/or accessory  
mounting fixtures that are either supplied as a part of the product  
or as optional accessories. Some of these items are designed to be  
dealer assembled or installed Please make sure that benches are  
stable and any optional fixtures (where applicable) are well se-  
cured BEFORE using. Benches supplied by Yamaha are designed  
for seating only. No other uses are recommended.  
7.  
Temperature considerations: Electronic products should  
be installed in locations that do not significantly contribute to  
their operating temperature. Placement of this product close to  
heat sources such as; radiators, heat registers and other devices  
that produce heat should be avoided.  
PLEASE KEEP THIS MANUAL  
92-469-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
M.D.G., EMI Division © 1995 Yamaha Corporation  
VT47770 507POCP4.3-02B0 Printed in Japan  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

West Bend Fryer L 5265 User Manual
Whirlpool Ventilation Hood 761883306 User Manual
Windsor Vacuum Cleaner 10052530 User Manual
Wolf Convection Oven WKEHC2 User Manual
Xantrex Technology Portable Generator FP 3000 12 User Manual
Xerox Scanner xerox documate 3115 User Manual
Yamaha Speaker System ATS 1010BL User Manual
Yamaha Stereo Receiver HTR 6080 User Manual
Zanussi Clothes Dryer TC 180 User Manual
ZETA Music Systems Musical Instrument PB 304 User Manual